* gdb.gdb/selftest.exp (do_steps_and_nexts): Add more matches.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
6@c %**start of header
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27@syncodeindex vr cp
28@syncodeindex fn cp
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
32@set EDITION Ninth
33
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40@c manuals to an info tree.
41@dircategory Software development
42@direntry
43* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44@end direntry
45
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
66this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
67developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
68@end ifinfo
69
70@titlepage
71@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73@sp 1
74@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76@page
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
84
85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
88Free Software Foundation, Inc.
89@sp 2
90Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9151 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
92Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
93ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
94
95Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
96under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
97any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
98Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
99Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
100and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
101
102(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
103this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
104developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
105@page
106This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
107Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
108software in general. We will miss him.
109@end titlepage
110@page
111
112@ifnottex
113@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
120@value{GDBVN}.
121
122Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126software in general. We will miss him.
127
128@menu
129* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136* Stack:: Examining the stack
137* Source:: Examining source files
138* Data:: Examining data
139* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146* Altering:: Altering execution
147* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
153* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158
159* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
160
161* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
162* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
163* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
164* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
165* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
166* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
167* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
168* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
169 @value{GDBN}
170* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
171 how you can copy and share GDB
172* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
173* Index:: Index
174@end menu
175
176@end ifnottex
177
178@contents
179
180@node Summary
181@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
182
183The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
184going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
185program was doing at the moment it crashed.
186
187@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
188these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
189
190@itemize @bullet
191@item
192Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
193
194@item
195Make your program stop on specified conditions.
196
197@item
198Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
199
200@item
201Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
202effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
203@end itemize
204
205You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
206For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
207For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
208
209@cindex Modula-2
210Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
211@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
212
213@cindex Pascal
214Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
215nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
216entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
217syntax.
218
219@cindex Fortran
220@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
221it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
222underscore.
223
224@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
225using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
226
227@menu
228* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
229* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
230@end menu
231
232@node Free Software
233@unnumberedsec Free Software
234
235@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
236General Public License
237(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
238program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
239freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
240the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
241Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
242Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
243
244Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
245you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
246from anyone else.
247
248@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
249
250The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
251the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
252include with the free software. Many of our most important
253programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
254texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
255when an important free software package does not come with a free
256manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
257gaps today.
258
259Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
260normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
261authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
262copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
263them from the free software world.
264
265That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
266from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
267manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
268only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
269contract to make it non-free.
270
271Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
272price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
273charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
274Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
275problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
276are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
277modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
278
279The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
280free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
281commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
282accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
283
284Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
285When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
286are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
287provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
288manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
289a changed version of the program is not really available to our
290community.
291
292Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
293acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
294author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
295authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
296to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
297may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
298with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
299are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
300of the manual.
301
302However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
303content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
304media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
305obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
306manual to replace it.
307
308Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
309lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
310free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
311the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
312realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
313the free software community.
314
315If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
316the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
317license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
318don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
319will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
320option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
321what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
322try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
323is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
324
325You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
326manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
327copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
328improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
329at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
330and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
331Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
332have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
333
334The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
335published by other publishers, at
336@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
337
338@node Contributors
339@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
340
341Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
342other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
343development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
344of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
345to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
346file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
347blow-by-blow account.
348
349Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
350
351@quotation
352@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
353or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
354omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
355@end quotation
356
357So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
358particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
359releases:
360Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
361Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
362Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
363Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
364Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
365Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
366John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
367Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
368and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
369
370Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
371Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
372
373Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
374in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
375Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
376demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
377much general update work leading to release 3.0).
378
379@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
380object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
381Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
382
383David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
384the original support for encapsulated COFF.
385
386Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
387
388Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
389Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
390support.
391Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
392Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
393Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
394David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
395Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
396Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
397Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
398Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
399Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
400Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
401Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
402Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
403Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
404Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
405Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
406Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
407
408Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
409
410Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
411libraries.
412
413Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
414about several machine instruction sets.
415
416Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
417remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
418contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
419and RDI targets, respectively.
420
421Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
422command-line editing and command history.
423
424Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
425Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
426
427Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
428He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
429symbols.
430
431Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
432H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
433
434NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
435
436Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
437processors.
438
439Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
440
441Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
442
443Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
444
445Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
446watchpoints.
447
448Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
449
450Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
451
452Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
453nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
454
455The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
456support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
457(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
458compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
459Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
460Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
461provided HP-specific information in this manual.
462
463DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
464Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
465
466Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
467development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
468fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
469Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
470Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
471Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
472Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
473addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
474JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
475Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
476Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
477Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
478Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
479Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
480Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
481
482Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
483Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
484
485Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
486Hat.
487
488Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
489people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
490Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
491Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
492Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
493with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
494
495Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
496unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
497frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
498Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
499libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
500trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
501complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
502Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
503Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
504Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
505Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
506Weigand.
507
508Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
509Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
510who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
511Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
512
513@node Sample Session
514@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
515
516You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
517However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
518debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
519
520@iftex
521In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
522to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
523@end iftex
524
525@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
526@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
527
528One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
529processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
530quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
531definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
532session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
533then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
534same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
535@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
536procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
537
538@smallexample
539$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
540$ @b{./m4}
541@b{define(foo,0000)}
542
543@b{foo}
5440000
545@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
546
547@b{bar}
5480000
549@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
550
551@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
552@b{baz}
553@b{Ctrl-d}
554m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
555@end smallexample
556
557@noindent
558Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
559
560@smallexample
561$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
562@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
563@c FIXME... format to come out better.
564@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
565 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
566 the conditions.
567There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
568 for details.
569
570@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
571(@value{GDBP})
572@end smallexample
573
574@noindent
575@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
576rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
577We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
578that examples fit in this manual.
579
580@smallexample
581(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
582@end smallexample
583
584@noindent
585We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
586Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
587@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
588@code{break} command.
589
590@smallexample
591(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
592Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
593@end smallexample
594
595@noindent
596Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
597control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
598subroutine, the program runs as usual:
599
600@smallexample
601(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
602Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
603@b{define(foo,0000)}
604
605@b{foo}
6060000
607@end smallexample
608
609@noindent
610To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
611suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
612context where it stops.
613
614@smallexample
615@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
616
617Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:879
619879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
620@end smallexample
621
622@noindent
623Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
624the next line of the current function.
625
626@smallexample
627(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
628882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
629 : nil,
630@end smallexample
631
632@noindent
633@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
634by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
635@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
636subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
637
638@smallexample
639(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
640set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
641 at input.c:530
642530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
643@end smallexample
644
645@noindent
646The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
647suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
648shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
649command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
650in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
651stack frame for each active subroutine.
652
653@smallexample
654(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
655#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
656 at input.c:530
657#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
658 at builtin.c:882
659#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
660#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
661 at macro.c:71
662#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
663#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
664@end smallexample
665
666@noindent
667We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
668times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
669falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
670
671@smallexample
672(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6730x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
674(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6750x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
676def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
677(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
678536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
679 : xstrdup(rq);
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
682@end smallexample
683
684@noindent
685The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
686@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
687and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
688(@code{print}) to see their values.
689
690@smallexample
691(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
692$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
693(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
694$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
695@end smallexample
696
697@noindent
698@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
699To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
700surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
701
702@smallexample
703(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
704533 xfree(rquote);
705534
706535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
707 : xstrdup (lq);
708536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
709 : xstrdup (rq);
710537
711538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
712539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
713540 @}
714541
715542 void
716@end smallexample
717
718@noindent
719Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
720@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
721
722@smallexample
723(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
724539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
725(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
726540 @}
727(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
728$3 = 9
729(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
730$4 = 7
731@end smallexample
732
733@noindent
734That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
735@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
736@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
737the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
738any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
739assignments.
740
741@smallexample
742(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
743$5 = 7
744(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
745$6 = 9
746@end smallexample
747
748@noindent
749Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
750@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
751executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
752example that caused trouble initially:
753
754@smallexample
755(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
756Continuing.
757
758@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
759
760baz
7610000
762@end smallexample
763
764@noindent
765Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
766problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
767lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
768
769@smallexample
770@b{Ctrl-d}
771Program exited normally.
772@end smallexample
773
774@noindent
775The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
776indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
777session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
778
779@smallexample
780(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
781@end smallexample
782
783@node Invocation
784@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
785
786This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
787The essentials are:
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
790type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
791@item
792type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
793@end itemize
794
795@menu
796* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
797* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
798* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
799* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
800@end menu
801
802@node Invoking GDB
803@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
804
805Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
806@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
807
808You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
809to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
810
811The command-line options described here are designed
812to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
813options may effectively be unavailable.
814
815The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
816specifying an executable program:
817
818@smallexample
819@value{GDBP} @var{program}
820@end smallexample
821
822@noindent
823You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
824specified:
825
826@smallexample
827@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
828@end smallexample
829
830You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
831to debug a running process:
832
833@smallexample
834@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
835@end smallexample
836
837@noindent
838would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
839named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
840
841Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
842complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
843debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
844``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
845will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
846
847You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
848executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
849option processing.
850@smallexample
851@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
852@end smallexample
853This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
854@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
855
856You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
857@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
858
859@smallexample
860@value{GDBP} -silent
861@end smallexample
862
863@noindent
864You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
865options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
866
867@noindent
868Type
869
870@smallexample
871@value{GDBP} -help
872@end smallexample
873
874@noindent
875to display all available options and briefly describe their use
876(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
877
878All options and command line arguments you give are processed
879in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
880@samp{-x} option is used.
881
882
883@menu
884* File Options:: Choosing files
885* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
886* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
887@end menu
888
889@node File Options
890@subsection Choosing Files
891
892When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
893specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
894the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
895@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
896first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
897equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
898second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
899equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
900If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
901first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
902to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
903a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
904prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
905
906If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
907such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
908argument and ignore it.
909
910Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
911following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
912them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
913(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
914than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
915
916@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
917@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
918@c it.
919
920@table @code
921@item -symbols @var{file}
922@itemx -s @var{file}
923@cindex @code{--symbols}
924@cindex @code{-s}
925Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
926
927@item -exec @var{file}
928@itemx -e @var{file}
929@cindex @code{--exec}
930@cindex @code{-e}
931Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
932and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
933
934@item -se @var{file}
935@cindex @code{--se}
936Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
937file.
938
939@item -core @var{file}
940@itemx -c @var{file}
941@cindex @code{--core}
942@cindex @code{-c}
943Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
944
945@item -pid @var{number}
946@itemx -p @var{number}
947@cindex @code{--pid}
948@cindex @code{-p}
949Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
950
951@item -command @var{file}
952@itemx -x @var{file}
953@cindex @code{--command}
954@cindex @code{-x}
955Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
956Files,, Command files}.
957
958@item -eval-command @var{command}
959@itemx -ex @var{command}
960@cindex @code{--eval-command}
961@cindex @code{-ex}
962Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
963
964This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
965also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
966
967@smallexample
968@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
969 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
970@end smallexample
971
972@item -directory @var{directory}
973@itemx -d @var{directory}
974@cindex @code{--directory}
975@cindex @code{-d}
976Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
977
978@item -r
979@itemx -readnow
980@cindex @code{--readnow}
981@cindex @code{-r}
982Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
983the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
984This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
985
986@end table
987
988@node Mode Options
989@subsection Choosing Modes
990
991You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
992batch mode or quiet mode.
993
994@table @code
995@item -nx
996@itemx -n
997@cindex @code{--nx}
998@cindex @code{-n}
999Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1000@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1001options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1002Files}.
1003
1004@item -quiet
1005@itemx -silent
1006@itemx -q
1007@cindex @code{--quiet}
1008@cindex @code{--silent}
1009@cindex @code{-q}
1010``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1011messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1012
1013@item -batch
1014@cindex @code{--batch}
1015Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1016command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1017initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1018nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1019in the command files.
1020
1021Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1022example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1023make this more useful, the message
1024
1025@smallexample
1026Program exited normally.
1027@end smallexample
1028
1029@noindent
1030(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1031@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1032mode.
1033
1034@item -batch-silent
1035@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1036Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1037@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1038unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1039for an interactive session.
1040
1041This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1042messages, for example.
1043
1044Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1045writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1046
1047@item -return-child-result
1048@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1049The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1050process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1051
1052@itemize @bullet
1053@item
1054@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1055internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1056without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1057@item
1058The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1059@item
1060The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1061the exit code will be -1.
1062@end itemize
1063
1064This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1065when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1066interface.
1067
1068@item -nowindows
1069@itemx -nw
1070@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1071@cindex @code{-nw}
1072``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1073(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1074interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1075
1076@item -windows
1077@itemx -w
1078@cindex @code{--windows}
1079@cindex @code{-w}
1080If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1081used if possible.
1082
1083@item -cd @var{directory}
1084@cindex @code{--cd}
1085Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1086instead of the current directory.
1087
1088@item -fullname
1089@itemx -f
1090@cindex @code{--fullname}
1091@cindex @code{-f}
1092@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1093subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1094number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1095displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1096recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1097the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1098and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1099@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1100frame.
1101
1102@item -epoch
1103@cindex @code{--epoch}
1104The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1105@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1106routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1107separate window.
1108
1109@item -annotate @var{level}
1110@cindex @code{--annotate}
1111This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1112effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1113(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1114information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1115expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1116normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1117@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1118that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1119
1120The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1121(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1122
1123@item --args
1124@cindex @code{--args}
1125Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1126executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1127This option stops option processing.
1128
1129@item -baud @var{bps}
1130@itemx -b @var{bps}
1131@cindex @code{--baud}
1132@cindex @code{-b}
1133Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1134interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1135
1136@item -l @var{timeout}
1137@cindex @code{-l}
1138Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1139for remote debugging.
1140
1141@item -tty @var{device}
1142@itemx -t @var{device}
1143@cindex @code{--tty}
1144@cindex @code{-t}
1145Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1146@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1147
1148@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1149@item -tui
1150@cindex @code{--tui}
1151Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1152Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1153source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1154(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1155Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1156@samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1157Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1158
1159@c @item -xdb
1160@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1161@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1162@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1163@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1164@c systems.
1165
1166@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1167@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1168Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1169program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1170communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1171@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1172
1173@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1174@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1175The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1176previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1177selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1178@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1179
1180@item -write
1181@cindex @code{--write}
1182Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1183is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1184(@pxref{Patching}).
1185
1186@item -statistics
1187@cindex @code{--statistics}
1188This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1189memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1190
1191@item -version
1192@cindex @code{--version}
1193This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1194no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1195
1196@end table
1197
1198@node Startup
1199@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1200@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1201
1202Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1203
1204@enumerate
1205@item
1206Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1207(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1208
1209@item
1210@cindex init file
1211Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1212DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1213@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1214that file.
1215
1216@item
1217Processes command line options and operands.
1218
1219@item
1220Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1221working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1222different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1223init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1224to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1225@value{GDBN}.
1226
1227@item
1228Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1229Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1230
1231@item
1232Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1233@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1234files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1235@end enumerate
1236
1237Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1238Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1239file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1240complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1241and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1242option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1243
1244@cindex init file name
1245@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1246@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1247The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1248The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1249the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1250ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1251@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1252the file to the standard name.
1253
1254
1255@node Quitting GDB
1256@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1257@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1258@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1259
1260@table @code
1261@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1262@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1263@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1264@itemx q
1265To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1266@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1267do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1268otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1269error code.
1270@end table
1271
1272@cindex interrupt
1273An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1274terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1275returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1276character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1277until a time when it is safe.
1278
1279If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1280device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1281(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1282
1283@node Shell Commands
1284@section Shell Commands
1285
1286If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1287debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1288just use the @code{shell} command.
1289
1290@table @code
1291@kindex shell
1292@cindex shell escape
1293@item shell @var{command string}
1294Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1295If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1296shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1297(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1298@end table
1299
1300The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1301You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1302@value{GDBN}:
1303
1304@table @code
1305@kindex make
1306@cindex calling make
1307@item make @var{make-args}
1308Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1309arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1310@end table
1311
1312@node Logging Output
1313@section Logging Output
1314@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1315@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1316
1317You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1318There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1319
1320@table @code
1321@kindex set logging
1322@item set logging on
1323Enable logging.
1324@item set logging off
1325Disable logging.
1326@cindex logging file name
1327@item set logging file @var{file}
1328Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1329@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1330By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1331you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1332@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1333By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1334Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1335@kindex show logging
1336@item show logging
1337Show the current values of the logging settings.
1338@end table
1339
1340@node Commands
1341@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1342
1343You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1344name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1345@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1346key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1347show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1348
1349@menu
1350* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1351* Completion:: Command completion
1352* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1353@end menu
1354
1355@node Command Syntax
1356@section Command Syntax
1357
1358A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1359how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1360arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1361command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1362step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1363with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1364
1365@cindex abbreviation
1366@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1367unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1368documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1369abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1370equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1371names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1372arguments to the @code{help} command.
1373
1374@cindex repeating commands
1375@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1376A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1377repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1378will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1379repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1380repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1381@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1382
1383The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1384@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1385exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1386
1387@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1388output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1389(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1390@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1391repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1392
1393@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1394@cindex comment
1395Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1396nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1397Files,,Command Files}).
1398
1399@cindex repeating command sequences
1400@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1401The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1402commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1403then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1404for editing.
1405
1406@node Completion
1407@section Command Completion
1408
1409@cindex completion
1410@cindex word completion
1411@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1412only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1413are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1414commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1415
1416Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1417of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1418word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1419enter it). For example, if you type
1420
1421@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1422@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1423@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1424@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1425@smallexample
1426(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1427@end smallexample
1428
1429@noindent
1430@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1431the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1432
1433@smallexample
1434(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1435@end smallexample
1436
1437@noindent
1438You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1439breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1440@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1441were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1442might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1443to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1444
1445If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1446@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1447characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1448@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1449example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1450begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1451just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1452function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1453example:
1454
1455@smallexample
1456(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1457@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1458make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1459make_abs_section make_function_type
1460make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1461make_cleanup make_reference_type
1462make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1463(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1464@end smallexample
1465
1466@noindent
1467After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1468partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1469command.
1470
1471If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1472can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1473means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1474key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1475one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1476
1477@cindex quotes in commands
1478@cindex completion of quoted strings
1479Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1480parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1481its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1482situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1483@value{GDBN} commands.
1484
1485The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1486name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1487overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1488by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1489may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1490that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1491that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1492word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1493@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1494@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1495when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1496
1497@smallexample
1498(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1499bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1500(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1501@end smallexample
1502
1503In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1504quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1505completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1506place:
1507
1508@smallexample
1509(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1510@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1511(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1512@end smallexample
1513
1514@noindent
1515In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1516you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1517completion on an overloaded symbol.
1518
1519For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1520Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1521overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1522see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1523
1524
1525@node Help
1526@section Getting Help
1527@cindex online documentation
1528@kindex help
1529
1530You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1531using the command @code{help}.
1532
1533@table @code
1534@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1535@item help
1536@itemx h
1537You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1538display a short list of named classes of commands:
1539
1540@smallexample
1541(@value{GDBP}) help
1542List of classes of commands:
1543
1544aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1545breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1546data -- Examining data
1547files -- Specifying and examining files
1548internals -- Maintenance commands
1549obscure -- Obscure features
1550running -- Running the program
1551stack -- Examining the stack
1552status -- Status inquiries
1553support -- Support facilities
1554tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1555 stopping the program
1556user-defined -- User-defined commands
1557
1558Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1559commands in that class.
1560Type "help" followed by command name for full
1561documentation.
1562Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1563(@value{GDBP})
1564@end smallexample
1565@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1566
1567@item help @var{class}
1568Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1569list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1570help display for the class @code{status}:
1571
1572@smallexample
1573(@value{GDBP}) help status
1574Status inquiries.
1575
1576List of commands:
1577
1578@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1579@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1580info -- Generic command for showing things
1581 about the program being debugged
1582show -- Generic command for showing things
1583 about the debugger
1584
1585Type "help" followed by command name for full
1586documentation.
1587Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1588(@value{GDBP})
1589@end smallexample
1590
1591@item help @var{command}
1592With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1593short paragraph on how to use that command.
1594
1595@kindex apropos
1596@item apropos @var{args}
1597The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1598commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1599@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1600
1601@smallexample
1602apropos reload
1603@end smallexample
1604
1605@noindent
1606results in:
1607
1608@smallexample
1609@c @group
1610set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1611 multiple times in one run
1612show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1613 multiple times in one run
1614@c @end group
1615@end smallexample
1616
1617@kindex complete
1618@item complete @var{args}
1619The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1620for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1621command you want completed. For example:
1622
1623@smallexample
1624complete i
1625@end smallexample
1626
1627@noindent results in:
1628
1629@smallexample
1630@group
1631if
1632ignore
1633info
1634inspect
1635@end group
1636@end smallexample
1637
1638@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1639@end table
1640
1641In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1642and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1643of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1644manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1645under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1646all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1647
1648@c @group
1649@table @code
1650@kindex info
1651@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1652@item info
1653This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1654program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1655with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1656registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1657You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1658@w{@code{help info}}.
1659
1660@kindex set
1661@item set
1662You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1663@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1664@code{set prompt $}.
1665
1666@kindex show
1667@item show
1668In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1669@value{GDBN} itself.
1670You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1671related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1672system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1673which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1674
1675@kindex info set
1676To display all the settable parameters and their current
1677values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1678@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1679@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1680@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1681@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1682@end table
1683@c @end group
1684
1685Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1686exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1687
1688@table @code
1689@kindex show version
1690@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1691@item show version
1692Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1693information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1694@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1695version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1696commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1697system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1698variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1699The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1700@value{GDBN}.
1701
1702@kindex show copying
1703@kindex info copying
1704@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1705@item show copying
1706@itemx info copying
1707Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1708
1709@kindex show warranty
1710@kindex info warranty
1711@item show warranty
1712@itemx info warranty
1713Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1714if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1715
1716@end table
1717
1718@node Running
1719@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1720
1721When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1722debugging information when you compile it.
1723
1724You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1725of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1726your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1727kill a child process.
1728
1729@menu
1730* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1731* Starting:: Starting your program
1732* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1733* Environment:: Your program's environment
1734
1735* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1736* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1737* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1738* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1739
1740* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1741* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1742* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1743@end menu
1744
1745@node Compilation
1746@section Compiling for Debugging
1747
1748In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1749debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1750is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1751variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1752and addresses in the executable code.
1753
1754To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1755the compiler.
1756
1757Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1758optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1759compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1760together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1761executables containing debugging information.
1762
1763@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1764without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1765recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1766program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1767in pushing your luck.
1768
1769@cindex optimized code, debugging
1770@cindex debugging optimized code
1771When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1772optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1773really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1774exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1775variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1776variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1777
1778Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1779@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1780doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1781please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1782@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1783
1784Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1785@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1786format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1787
1788@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1789expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1790about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1791the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1792Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1793provides macro information if you specify the options
1794@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1795debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1796``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1797ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1798@option{-g} alone.
1799
1800@need 2000
1801@node Starting
1802@section Starting your Program
1803@cindex starting
1804@cindex running
1805
1806@table @code
1807@kindex run
1808@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1809@item run
1810@itemx r
1811Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1812You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1813argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1814@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1815(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1816
1817@end table
1818
1819If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1820supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1821that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1822@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1823
1824The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1825receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1826information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1827can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1828your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1829divided into four categories:
1830
1831@table @asis
1832@item The @emph{arguments.}
1833Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1834@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1835is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1836(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1837the arguments.
1838In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1839@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1840@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1841
1842@item The @emph{environment.}
1843Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1844use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1845environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1846your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1847
1848@item The @emph{working directory.}
1849Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1850the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1851@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1852
1853@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1854Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1855standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1856in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1857set a different device for your program.
1858@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1859
1860@cindex pipes
1861@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1862pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1863program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1864wrong program.
1865@end table
1866
1867When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1868immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1869of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1870stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1871or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1872
1873If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1874time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1875table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1876your current breakpoints.
1877
1878@table @code
1879@kindex start
1880@item start
1881@cindex run to main procedure
1882The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1883With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1884other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1885main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1886execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1887procedure, depending on the language used.
1888
1889The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1890breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1891the @samp{run} command.
1892
1893@cindex elaboration phase
1894Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1895executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1896languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1897constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1898@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1899before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1900will remain to halt execution.
1901
1902Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1903@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1904underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1905reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1906@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1907
1908It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1909these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1910your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1911elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1912elaboration code before running your program.
1913@end table
1914
1915@node Arguments
1916@section Your Program's Arguments
1917
1918@cindex arguments (to your program)
1919The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1920@code{run} command.
1921They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1922performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1923@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1924@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1925the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1926
1927On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1928@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1929calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1930the program, not by the shell.
1931
1932@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1933@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1934
1935@table @code
1936@kindex set args
1937@item set args
1938Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1939@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1940with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1941using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1942it again without arguments.
1943
1944@kindex show args
1945@item show args
1946Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1947@end table
1948
1949@node Environment
1950@section Your Program's Environment
1951
1952@cindex environment (of your program)
1953The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1954their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1955your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1956path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1957the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1958debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1959environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1960
1961@table @code
1962@kindex path
1963@item path @var{directory}
1964Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1965(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1966The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1967You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1968system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1969MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1970is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1971
1972You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1973working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1974use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1975@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1976@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1977@var{directory} to the search path.
1978@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1979@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1980
1981@kindex show paths
1982@item show paths
1983Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1984environment variable).
1985
1986@kindex show environment
1987@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1988Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1989your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1990print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1991your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1992
1993@kindex set environment
1994@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1995Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1996changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1997be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1998any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1999parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2000null value.
2001@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2002@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2003
2004For example, this command:
2005
2006@smallexample
2007set env USER = foo
2008@end smallexample
2009
2010@noindent
2011tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2012@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2013are not actually required.)
2014
2015@kindex unset environment
2016@item unset environment @var{varname}
2017Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2018program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2019@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2020rather than assigning it an empty value.
2021@end table
2022
2023@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2024the shell indicated
2025by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2026@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2027that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2028@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2029your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2030files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2031@file{.profile}.
2032
2033@node Working Directory
2034@section Your Program's Working Directory
2035
2036@cindex working directory (of your program)
2037Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2038working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2039The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2040from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2041working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2042
2043The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2044that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2045Specify Files}.
2046
2047@table @code
2048@kindex cd
2049@cindex change working directory
2050@item cd @var{directory}
2051Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2052
2053@kindex pwd
2054@item pwd
2055Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2056@end table
2057
2058It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2059the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2060during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2061configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2062proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2063current working directory of the debuggee.
2064
2065@node Input/Output
2066@section Your Program's Input and Output
2067
2068@cindex redirection
2069@cindex i/o
2070@cindex terminal
2071By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2072the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2073to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2074modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2075running your program.
2076
2077@table @code
2078@kindex info terminal
2079@item info terminal
2080Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2081program is using.
2082@end table
2083
2084You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2085redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2086
2087@smallexample
2088run > outfile
2089@end smallexample
2090
2091@noindent
2092starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2093
2094@kindex tty
2095@cindex controlling terminal
2096Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2097with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2098argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2099commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2100process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2101
2102@smallexample
2103tty /dev/ttyb
2104@end smallexample
2105
2106@noindent
2107directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2108default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2109that as their controlling terminal.
2110
2111An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2112effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2113terminal.
2114
2115When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2116command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2117for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2118for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2119
2120@cindex inferior tty
2121@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2122You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2123display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2124program.
2125
2126@table @code
2127@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2128@kindex set inferior-tty
2129Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2130
2131@item show inferior-tty
2132@kindex show inferior-tty
2133Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2134@end table
2135
2136@node Attach
2137@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2138@kindex attach
2139@cindex attach
2140
2141@table @code
2142@item attach @var{process-id}
2143This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2144outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2145targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2146find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2147or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2148
2149@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2150executing the command.
2151@end table
2152
2153To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2154which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2155programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2156also have permission to send the process a signal.
2157
2158When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2159the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2160the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2161(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2162the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2163Specify Files}.
2164
2165The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2166process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2167with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2168you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2169can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2170process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2171attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2172
2173@table @code
2174@kindex detach
2175@item detach
2176When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2177@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2178the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2179that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2180are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2181@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2182executing the command.
2183@end table
2184
2185If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2186that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2187By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2188things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2189@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2190Messages}).
2191
2192@node Kill Process
2193@section Killing the Child Process
2194
2195@table @code
2196@kindex kill
2197@item kill
2198Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2199@end table
2200
2201This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2202running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2203is running.
2204
2205On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2206while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2207@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2208outside the debugger.
2209
2210The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2211relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2212executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2213next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2214reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2215breakpoint settings).
2216
2217@node Threads
2218@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2219
2220@cindex threads of execution
2221@cindex multiple threads
2222@cindex switching threads
2223In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2224may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2225of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2226the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2227that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2228modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2229registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2230
2231@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2232programs:
2233
2234@itemize @bullet
2235@item automatic notification of new threads
2236@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2237@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2238@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2239a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2240@item thread-specific breakpoints
2241@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2242messages on thread start and exit.
2243@end itemize
2244
2245@quotation
2246@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2247@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2248If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2249effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2250from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2251like this:
2252
2253@smallexample
2254(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2255(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2256Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2257see the IDs of currently known threads.
2258@end smallexample
2259@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2260@c doesn't support threads"?
2261@end quotation
2262
2263@cindex focus of debugging
2264@cindex current thread
2265The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2266threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2267control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2268This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2269program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2270
2271@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2272@cindex thread identifier (system)
2273@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2274@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2275@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2276Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2277the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2278form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2279whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2280@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2281
2282@smallexample
2283[New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2284@end smallexample
2285
2286@noindent
2287when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2288the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2289further qualifier.
2290
2291@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2292@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2293@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2294@c program?
2295@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2296@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2297@c threads ab initio?
2298
2299@cindex thread number
2300@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2301For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2302number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2303
2304@table @code
2305@kindex info threads
2306@item info threads
2307Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2308program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2309
2310@enumerate
2311@item
2312the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2313
2314@item
2315the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2316
2317@item
2318the current stack frame summary for that thread
2319@end enumerate
2320
2321@noindent
2322An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2323indicates the current thread.
2324
2325For example,
2326@end table
2327@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2328
2329@smallexample
2330(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2331 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2332 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2333* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2334 at threadtest.c:68
2335@end smallexample
2336
2337On HP-UX systems:
2338
2339@cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2340@cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2341For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2342number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2343thread in your program.
2344
2345@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2346@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2347@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2348@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2349@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2350Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2351both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2352form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2353whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2354HP-UX, you see
2355
2356@smallexample
2357[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2358@end smallexample
2359
2360@noindent
2361when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2362
2363@table @code
2364@kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2365@item info threads
2366Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2367program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2368
2369@enumerate
2370@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2371
2372@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2373
2374@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2375@end enumerate
2376
2377@noindent
2378An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2379indicates the current thread.
2380
2381For example,
2382@end table
2383@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2384
2385@smallexample
2386(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2387 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2388 at quicksort.c:137
2389 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2390 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2391 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2392 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2393@end smallexample
2394
2395On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2396Solaris-specific command:
2397
2398@table @code
2399@item maint info sol-threads
2400@kindex maint info sol-threads
2401@cindex thread info (Solaris)
2402Display info on Solaris user threads.
2403@end table
2404
2405@table @code
2406@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2407@item thread @var{threadno}
2408Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2409argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2410shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2411@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2412you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2413
2414@smallexample
2415@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2416(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2417[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
24180x34e5 in sigpause ()
2419@end smallexample
2420
2421@noindent
2422As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2423@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2424threads.
2425
2426@kindex thread apply
2427@cindex apply command to several threads
2428@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2429The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2430@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2431threads that you want affected with the command argument
2432@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2433shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2434could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2435command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2436
2437@kindex set print thread-events
2438@cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2439@item set print thread-events
2440@itemx set print thread-events on
2441@itemx set print thread-events off
2442The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2443disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2444started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2445be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2446Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2447
2448@kindex show print thread-events
2449@item show print thread-events
2450Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2451have started and exited.
2452@end table
2453
2454@cindex automatic thread selection
2455@cindex switching threads automatically
2456@cindex threads, automatic switching
2457Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2458signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2459signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2460message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2461thread.
2462
2463@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2464more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2465programs with multiple threads.
2466
2467@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2468watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2469
2470@node Processes
2471@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2472
2473@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2474@cindex multiple processes
2475@cindex processes, multiple
2476On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2477programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2478function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2479parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2480set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2481will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2482will cause it to terminate.
2483
2484However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2485which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2486the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2487only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2488so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2489on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2490get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2491@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2492the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2493the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2494
2495On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2496create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2497Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2498only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2499
2500By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2501the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2502
2503If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2504use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2505
2506@table @code
2507@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2508@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2509Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2510@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2511process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2512
2513@table @code
2514@item parent
2515The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2516unimpeded. This is the default.
2517
2518@item child
2519The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2520unimpeded.
2521
2522@end table
2523
2524@kindex show follow-fork-mode
2525@item show follow-fork-mode
2526Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2527@end table
2528
2529@cindex debugging multiple processes
2530On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2531command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2532
2533@table @code
2534@kindex set detach-on-fork
2535@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2536Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2537retain debugger control over them both.
2538
2539@table @code
2540@item on
2541The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2542@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2543independently. This is the default.
2544
2545@item off
2546Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2548@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2549is held suspended.
2550
2551@end table
2552
2553@kindex show detach-on-follow
2554@item show detach-on-follow
2555Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2556@end table
2557
2558If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2559@value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2560nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2561@value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2562from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2563
2564@table @code
2565@kindex info forks
2566@item info forks
2567Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2568The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2569position (program counter) of the process.
2570
2571
2572@kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2573@item fork @var{fork-id}
2574Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2575@var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2576as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2577
2578@end table
2579
2580To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2581from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2582run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2583@w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2584
2585@table @code
2586@kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2587@item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2588Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2589@var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2590allowed to run independently.
2591
2592@kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2593@item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2594Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2595and remove it from the fork list.
2596
2597@end table
2598
2599If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2600@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2601breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2602@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2603the child process's @code{main}.
2604
2605When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2606child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2607
2608If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2609call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2610use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2611argument.
2612
2613You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2614a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2615Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2616
2617@node Checkpoint/Restart
2618@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2619
2620@cindex checkpoint
2621@cindex restart
2622@cindex bookmark
2623@cindex snapshot of a process
2624@cindex rewind program state
2625
2626On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2627@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2628program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2629later.
2630
2631Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2632happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2633includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2634system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2635moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2636
2637Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2638getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2639a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2640the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2641from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2642start again from there.
2643
2644This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2645steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2646
2647To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2648
2649@table @code
2650@kindex checkpoint
2651@item checkpoint
2652Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2653The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2654is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2655
2656@kindex info checkpoints
2657@item info checkpoints
2658List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2659session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2660listed:
2661
2662@table @code
2663@item Checkpoint ID
2664@item Process ID
2665@item Code Address
2666@item Source line, or label
2667@end table
2668
2669@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2670@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2671Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2672@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2673etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2674was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2675in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2676
2677Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2678are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2679only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2680the debugger.
2681
2682@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2683@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2684Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2685
2686@end table
2687
2688Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2689of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2690(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2691a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2692so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2693opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2694previously read data can be read again.
2695
2696Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2697external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2698from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2699but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2700be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2701been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2702
2703However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2704program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2705again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2706different execution path this time.
2707
2708@cindex checkpoints and process id
2709Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2710different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2711id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2712and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2713If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2714potentially pose a problem.
2715
2716@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2717
2718On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2719is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2720difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2721absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2722absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2723next.
2724
2725A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2726Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2727and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2728process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2729your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2730
2731@node Stopping
2732@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2733
2734The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2735program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2736trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2737
2738Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2739such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2740@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2741change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2742continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2743ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2744explicitly request this information at any time.
2745
2746@table @code
2747@kindex info program
2748@item info program
2749Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2750running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2751@end table
2752
2753@menu
2754* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2755* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2756* Signals:: Signals
2757* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2758@end menu
2759
2760@node Breakpoints
2761@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2762
2763@cindex breakpoints
2764A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2765the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2766control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2767breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2768Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2769should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2770program.
2771
2772On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2773the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2774you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2775in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2776(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2777call).
2778
2779@cindex watchpoints
2780@cindex data breakpoints
2781@cindex memory tracing
2782@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2783@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2784A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2785when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2786of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2787combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2788@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2789watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2790from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2791enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2792same commands.
2793
2794You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2795whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2796Automatic Display}.
2797
2798@cindex catchpoints
2799@cindex breakpoint on events
2800A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2801when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2802exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2803different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2804Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2805other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2806@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2807
2808@cindex breakpoint numbers
2809@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2810@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2811catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2812starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2813features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2814breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2815@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2816enable it again.
2817
2818@cindex breakpoint ranges
2819@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2820Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2821operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2822@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2823hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2824all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2825
2826@menu
2827* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2828* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2829* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2830* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2831* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2832* Conditions:: Break conditions
2833* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2834* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2835* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2836* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2837@end menu
2838
2839@node Set Breaks
2840@subsection Setting Breakpoints
2841
2842@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2843@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2844@c
2845@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2846
2847@kindex break
2848@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2849@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2850@cindex latest breakpoint
2851Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2852@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2853number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2854Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2855convenience variables.
2856
2857@table @code
2858@item break @var{location}
2859Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
2860function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
2861(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
2862specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
2863before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
2864
2865When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2866C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2867@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2868
2869@item break
2870When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2871the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2872(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2873innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2874returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2875@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2876that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2877@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2878the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2879inside loops.
2880
2881@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2882least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2883would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2884breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2885existed when your program stopped.
2886
2887@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2888Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2889@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2890value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2891@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2892above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2893,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2894
2895@kindex tbreak
2896@item tbreak @var{args}
2897Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2898same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2899way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2900program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2901
2902@kindex hbreak
2903@cindex hardware breakpoints
2904@item hbreak @var{args}
2905Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2906@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2907breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2908have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2909debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2910changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2911provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2912will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2913address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2914breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2915example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2916@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2917or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2918(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2919@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2920For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2921breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2922hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2923
2924@kindex thbreak
2925@item thbreak @var{args}
2926Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2927are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2928the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2929the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2930first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2931command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2932may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2933See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2934
2935@kindex rbreak
2936@cindex regular expression
2937@cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2938@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2939@item rbreak @var{regex}
2940Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2941@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2942matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2943breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2944the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2945them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2946
2947The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2948like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2949shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2950an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2951@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2952match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2953
2954@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2955When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2956breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2957classes.
2958
2959@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2960The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2961@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2962
2963@smallexample
2964(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2965@end smallexample
2966
2967@kindex info breakpoints
2968@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2969@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2970@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2971@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2972Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2973not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2974about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2975each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2976
2977@table @emph
2978@item Breakpoint Numbers
2979@item Type
2980Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2981@item Disposition
2982Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2983@item Enabled or Disabled
2984Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2985that are not enabled. An optional @samp{(p)} suffix marks pending
2986breakpoints---breakpoints for which address is either not yet
2987resolved, pending load of a shared library, or for which address was
2988in a shared library that was since unloaded. Such breakpoint won't
2989fire until a shared library that has the symbol or line referred by
2990breakpoint is loaded. See below for details.
2991@item Address
2992Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
2993pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
2994contain @samp{<PENDING>}. A breakpoint with several locations will
2995have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
2996@item What
2997Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2998line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2999the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3000the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3001@end table
3002
3003@noindent
3004If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3005the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3006are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3007specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3008library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3009valid location.
3010
3011@noindent
3012@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3013number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3014convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3015the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3016listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3017
3018@noindent
3019@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3020has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3021@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3022hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3023was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3024will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3025@end table
3026
3027@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3028your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3029the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3030(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3031
3032It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3033in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3034
3035@itemize @bullet
3036
3037@item
3038For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3039instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3040
3041@item
3042For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3043correspond to any number of instantiations.
3044
3045@item
3046For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3047several places where that function is inlined.
3048
3049@end itemize
3050
3051In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3052the relevant locations.
3053
3054A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3055table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3056each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3057address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3058addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3059locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3060@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3061
3062For example:
3063
3064@smallexample
3065Num Type Disp Enb Address What
30661 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3067 stop only if i==1
3068 breakpoint already hit 1 time
30691.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
30701.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3071@end smallexample
3072
3073Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3074@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3075@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3076delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3077entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3078the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3079the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3080the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3081that belong to that breakpoint.
3082
3083@cindex pending breakpoints
3084It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3085Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3086and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3087this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3088any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3089set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3090debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3091symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3092breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3093a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3094is not yet resolved.
3095
3096After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3097@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3098shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3099pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3100ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3101that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3102
3103This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3104example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3105a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3106a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3107
3108Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3109differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3110enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3111
3112@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3113happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3114address specification to an address:
3115
3116@kindex set breakpoint pending
3117@kindex show breakpoint pending
3118@table @code
3119@item set breakpoint pending auto
3120This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3121location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3122
3123@item set breakpoint pending on
3124This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3125result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3126
3127@item set breakpoint pending off
3128This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3129unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3130not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3131
3132@item show breakpoint pending
3133Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3134@end table
3135
3136The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3137variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3138as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3139
3140@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3141For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3142software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3143breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3144breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3145breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3146breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3147breakpoints.
3148
3149You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3150
3151@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3152@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3153@table @code
3154@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3155This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3156will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3157breakpoint must be used.
3158
3159@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3160This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3161type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3162trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3163@end table
3164
3165
3166@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3167@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3168@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3169special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3170programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3171starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3172You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3173@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3174
3175
3176@node Set Watchpoints
3177@subsection Setting Watchpoints
3178
3179@cindex setting watchpoints
3180You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3181expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3182this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3183The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3184as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3185
3186@itemize @bullet
3187@item
3188A reference to the value of a single variable.
3189
3190@item
3191An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3192@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3193address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3194
3195@item
3196An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3197expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3198language (@pxref{Languages}).
3199@end itemize
3200
3201@cindex software watchpoints
3202@cindex hardware watchpoints
3203Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3204hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3205program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3206times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3207catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3208culprit.)
3209
3210On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3211x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3212watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3213
3214@table @code
3215@kindex watch
3216@item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3217Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3218expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3219changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3220to watch the value of a single variable:
3221
3222@smallexample
3223(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3224@end smallexample
3225
3226If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3227clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3228@var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3229change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3230that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3231with Hardware Watchpoints.
3232
3233@kindex rwatch
3234@item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3235Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3236by the program.
3237
3238@kindex awatch
3239@item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3240Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3241or written into by the program.
3242
3243@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3244@item info watchpoints
3245This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3246it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3247@end table
3248
3249@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3250watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3251value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3252cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3253executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3254@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3255
3256@cindex use only software watchpoints
3257You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3258@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3259zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3260the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3261watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3262@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3263mechanism of watching expression values.)
3264
3265@table @code
3266@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3267@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3268Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3269
3270@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3271@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3272Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3273@end table
3274
3275For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3276watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3277hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3278
3279When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3280
3281@smallexample
3282Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3283@end smallexample
3284
3285@noindent
3286if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3287
3288Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3289hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3290value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3291every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3292that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3293hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3294will print a message like this:
3295
3296@smallexample
3297Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3298@end smallexample
3299
3300Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3301data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3302watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3303can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3304cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3305double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3306wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3307into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3308
3309If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3310to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3311Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3312time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3313able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3314warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3315
3316@smallexample
3317Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3318@end smallexample
3319
3320@noindent
3321If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3322
3323Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3324exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3325That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3326expression with separately allocated resources.
3327
3328The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3329or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3330data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3331hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3332both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3333watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3334@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3335watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3336@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3337Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3338
3339If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3340any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3341kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3342
3343@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3344(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3345they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3346which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3347being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3348and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3349rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3350way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3351@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3352
3353@cindex watchpoints and threads
3354@cindex threads and watchpoints
3355In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3356watched expression from every thread.
3357
3358@quotation
3359@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3360have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3361watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3362single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3363change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3364confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3365software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3366when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3367watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3368@end quotation
3369
3370@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3371
3372@node Set Catchpoints
3373@subsection Setting Catchpoints
3374@cindex catchpoints, setting
3375@cindex exception handlers
3376@cindex event handling
3377
3378You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3379kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3380shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3381
3382@table @code
3383@kindex catch
3384@item catch @var{event}
3385Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3386@table @code
3387@item throw
3388@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3389The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3390
3391@item catch
3392The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3393
3394@item exception
3395@cindex Ada exception catching
3396@cindex catch Ada exceptions
3397An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3398at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3399the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3400Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3401
3402@item exception unhandled
3403An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3404
3405@item assert
3406A failed Ada assertion.
3407
3408@item exec
3409@cindex break on fork/exec
3410A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3411
3412@item fork
3413A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3414
3415@item vfork
3416A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3417
3418@item load
3419@itemx load @var{libname}
3420@cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3421The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3422@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3423
3424@item unload
3425@itemx unload @var{libname}
3426The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3427of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3428@end table
3429
3430@item tcatch @var{event}
3431Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3432automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3433
3434@end table
3435
3436Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3437
3438There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3439(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3440
3441@itemize @bullet
3442@item
3443If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3444control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3445raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3446returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3447simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3448that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3449you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3450disabled within interactive calls.
3451
3452@item
3453You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3454
3455@item
3456You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3457@end itemize
3458
3459@cindex raise exceptions
3460Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3461if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3462stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3463can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3464breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3465out where the exception was raised.
3466
3467To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3468knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3469raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3470which has the following ANSI C interface:
3471
3472@smallexample
3473 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3474 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3475 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3476@end smallexample
3477
3478@noindent
3479To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3480unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3481(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3482
3483With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3484that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3485a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3486breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3487raised.
3488
3489
3490@node Delete Breaks
3491@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3492
3493@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3494@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3495It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3496catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3497to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3498breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3499
3500With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3501where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3502delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3503their breakpoint numbers.
3504
3505It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3506automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3507when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3508
3509@table @code
3510@kindex clear
3511@item clear
3512Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3513selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3514the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3515breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3516
3517@item clear @var{location}
3518Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3519@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3520most useful ones are listed below:
3521
3522@table @code
3523@item clear @var{function}
3524@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3525Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3526
3527@item clear @var{linenum}
3528@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3529Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3530@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3531@end table
3532
3533@cindex delete breakpoints
3534@kindex delete
3535@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3536@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3537Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3538ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3539breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3540confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3541@end table
3542
3543@node Disabling
3544@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3545
3546@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3547Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3548prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3549it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3550that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3551
3552You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3553the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3554or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3555@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3556catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3557
3558Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3559affects all of its locations.
3560
3561A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3562states of enablement:
3563
3564@itemize @bullet
3565@item
3566Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3567with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3568@item
3569Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3570@item
3571Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3572disabled.
3573@item
3574Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3575immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3576set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3577@end itemize
3578
3579You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3580watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3581
3582@table @code
3583@kindex disable
3584@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3585@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3586Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3587listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3588options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3589case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3590@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3591
3592@kindex enable
3593@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3594Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3595become effective once again in stopping your program.
3596
3597@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3598Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3599of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3600
3601@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3602Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3603deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3604Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3605@end table
3606
3607@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3608@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3609Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3610,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3611subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3612the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3613breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3614breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3615Stepping}.)
3616
3617@node Conditions
3618@subsection Break Conditions
3619@cindex conditional breakpoints
3620@cindex breakpoint conditions
3621
3622@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3623@c in particular for a watchpoint?
3624The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3625specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3626breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3627programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3628a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3629and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3630
3631This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3632situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3633when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3634by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3635@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3636
3637Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3638since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3639it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3640and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3641one.
3642
3643Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3644your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3645that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3646format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3647unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3648that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3649program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3650breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3651conditions for the
3652purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3653(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3654
3655Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3656@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3657Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3658with the @code{condition} command.
3659
3660You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3661The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3662@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3663catchpoint.
3664
3665@table @code
3666@kindex condition
3667@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3668Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3669watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3670breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3671@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3672@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3673syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3674referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3675symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3676prints an error message:
3677
3678@smallexample
3679No symbol "foo" in current context.
3680@end smallexample
3681
3682@noindent
3683@value{GDBN} does
3684not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3685command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3686@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3687
3688@item condition @var{bnum}
3689Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3690an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3691@end table
3692
3693@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3694A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3695breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3696useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3697count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3698is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3699therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3700ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3701the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3702value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3703your program reaches it.
3704
3705@table @code
3706@kindex ignore
3707@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3708Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3709The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3710execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3711takes no action.
3712
3713To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3714a count of zero.
3715
3716When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3717breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3718@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3719Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3720
3721If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3722condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3723@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3724
3725You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3726as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3727is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3728Variables}.
3729@end table
3730
3731Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3732
3733
3734@node Break Commands
3735@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3736
3737@cindex breakpoint commands
3738You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3739commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3740example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3741enable other breakpoints.
3742
3743@table @code
3744@kindex commands
3745@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3746@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3747@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3748@itemx end
3749Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3750themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3751@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3752
3753To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3754follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3755
3756With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3757breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3758recently encountered).
3759@end table
3760
3761Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3762disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3763
3764You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3765use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3766that resumes execution.
3767
3768Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3769execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3770(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3771another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3772ambiguities about which list to execute.
3773
3774@kindex silent
3775If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3776usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3777be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3778then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3779see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3780meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3781
3782The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3783print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3784breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3785
3786For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3787value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3788
3789@smallexample
3790break foo if x>0
3791commands
3792silent
3793printf "x is %d\n",x
3794cont
3795end
3796@end smallexample
3797
3798One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3799you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3800of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3801erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3802to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3803so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3804command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3805
3806@smallexample
3807break 403
3808commands
3809silent
3810set x = y + 4
3811cont
3812end
3813@end smallexample
3814
3815@node Breakpoint Menus
3816@subsection Breakpoint Menus
3817@cindex overloading
3818@cindex symbol overloading
3819
3820Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3821single function name
3822to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3823This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3824@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3825a breakpoint. You can use explicit signature of the function, as in
3826@samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})}, to specify which
3827particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3828you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3829waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3830options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3831sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3832@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3833breakpoints.
3834
3835For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3836breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3837We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3838
3839@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3840@smallexample
3841@group
3842(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3843[0] cancel
3844[1] all
3845[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3846[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3847[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3848[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3849[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3850[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3851> 2 4 6
3852Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3853Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3854Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3855Multiple breakpoints were set.
3856Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3857 breakpoints.
3858(@value{GDBP})
3859@end group
3860@end smallexample
3861
3862@c @ifclear BARETARGET
3863@node Error in Breakpoints
3864@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3865@c
3866@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3867@c
3868Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3869any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3870attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3871@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3872
3873@smallexample
3874Cannot insert breakpoints.
3875The same program may be running in another process.
3876@end smallexample
3877
3878When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3879
3880@enumerate
3881@item
3882Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3883
3884@item
3885Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3886name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3887that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3888Then start your program again.
3889
3890@item
3891Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3892linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3893to nonsharable executables.
3894@end enumerate
3895@c @end ifclear
3896
3897A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3898hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3899
3900@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3901@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3902@smallexample
3903Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3904You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3905@end smallexample
3906
3907@noindent
3908This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3909only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3910watchpoints it needs to insert.
3911
3912When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3913hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3914
3915@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3916@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3917@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3918
3919Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3920which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3921@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3922with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3923
3924One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3925a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3926bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3927constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3928bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3929honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3930first in the bundle.
3931
3932It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3933instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3934a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3935another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3936breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3937printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3938is hit.
3939
3940A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3941that's been subject to address adjustment:
3942
3943@smallexample
3944warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3945@end smallexample
3946
3947Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3948internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3949verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3950desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3951other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3952E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3953instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3954cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3955
3956@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3957adjusted breakpoints:
3958
3959@smallexample
3960warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3961to 0x00010410.
3962@end smallexample
3963
3964When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3965action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3966frequently than expected.
3967
3968@node Continuing and Stepping
3969@section Continuing and Stepping
3970
3971@cindex stepping
3972@cindex continuing
3973@cindex resuming execution
3974@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3975completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3976one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3977line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3978particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3979your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3980it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3981@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3982
3983@table @code
3984@kindex continue
3985@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3986@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3987@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3988@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3989@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3990Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3991any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3992@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3993ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3994@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3995
3996The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3997stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3998@code{continue} is ignored.
3999
4000The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4001debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4002purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4003@code{continue}.
4004@end table
4005
4006To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4007(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4008calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4009Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4010
4011A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4012(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4013beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4014is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4015and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4016interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4017
4018@table @code
4019@kindex step
4020@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4021@item step
4022Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4023line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4024abbreviated @code{s}.
4025
4026@quotation
4027@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4028@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4029@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4030@c distinction here.
4031@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4032within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4033execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4034debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4035is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4036without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4037below.
4038@end quotation
4039
4040The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4041line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4042@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4043to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4044the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4045called within the line.
4046
4047Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4048number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4049@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4050on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4051was any debugging information about the routine.
4052
4053@item step @var{count}
4054Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4055breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4056@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4057
4058@kindex next
4059@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4060@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4061Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4062This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4063the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4064control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4065that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4066is abbreviated @code{n}.
4067
4068An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4069
4070
4071@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4072@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4073@c
4074@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4075@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4076@c function are executed without stopping.
4077
4078The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4079source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4080@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4081
4082@kindex set step-mode
4083@item set step-mode
4084@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4085@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4086@itemx set step-mode on
4087The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4088stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4089information rather than stepping over it.
4090
4091This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4092machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4093want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4094
4095@item set step-mode off
4096Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4097debug information. This is the default.
4098
4099@item show step-mode
4100Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4101source line debug information.
4102
4103@kindex finish
4104@item finish
4105Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4106returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4107
4108Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4109,Returning from a Function}).
4110
4111@kindex until
4112@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4113@cindex run until specified location
4114@item until
4115@itemx u
4116Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4117current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4118stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4119command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4120automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4121than the address of the jump.
4122
4123This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4124though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4125exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4126simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4127through the next iteration.
4128
4129@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4130stack frame.
4131
4132@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4133of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4134example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4135(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4136@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4137
4138@smallexample
4139(@value{GDBP}) f
4140#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4141206 expand_input();
4142(@value{GDBP}) until
4143195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4144@end smallexample
4145
4146This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4147generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4148start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4149written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4150to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4151expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4152statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4153
4154@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4155instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4156argument.
4157
4158@item until @var{location}
4159@itemx u @var{location}
4160Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4161reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4162the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4163This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4164hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4165location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4166implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4167invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4168line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4169line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4170invocations have returned.
4171
4172@smallexample
417394 int factorial (int value)
417495 @{
417596 if (value > 1) @{
417697 value *= factorial (value - 1);
417798 @}
417899 return (value);
4179100 @}
4180@end smallexample
4181
4182
4183@kindex advance @var{location}
4184@itemx advance @var{location}
4185Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4186required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4187@ref{Specify Location}.
4188Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4189frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4190not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4191have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4192
4193
4194@kindex stepi
4195@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4196@item stepi
4197@itemx stepi @var{arg}
4198@itemx si
4199Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4200
4201It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4202instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4203instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4204Display,, Automatic Display}.
4205
4206An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4207
4208@need 750
4209@kindex nexti
4210@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4211@item nexti
4212@itemx nexti @var{arg}
4213@itemx ni
4214Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4215proceed until the function returns.
4216
4217An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4218@end table
4219
4220@node Signals
4221@section Signals
4222@cindex signals
4223
4224A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4225operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4226kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4227signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4228@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4229memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4230the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4231requested an alarm).
4232
4233@cindex fatal signals
4234Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4235functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4236errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4237program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4238@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4239fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4240
4241@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4242program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4243signal.
4244
4245@cindex handling signals
4246Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4247@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4248(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4249but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4250You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4251
4252@table @code
4253@kindex info signals
4254@kindex info handle
4255@item info signals
4256@itemx info handle
4257Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4258handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4259the defined types of signals.
4260
4261@item info signals @var{sig}
4262Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4263
4264@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4265
4266@kindex handle
4267@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4268Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4269can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4270@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4271@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4272known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4273say what change to make.
4274@end table
4275
4276@c @group
4277The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4278Their full names are:
4279
4280@table @code
4281@item nostop
4282@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4283still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4284
4285@item stop
4286@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4287the @code{print} keyword as well.
4288
4289@item print
4290@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4291
4292@item noprint
4293@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4294implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4295
4296@item pass
4297@itemx noignore
4298@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4299can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4300and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4301
4302@item nopass
4303@itemx ignore
4304@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4305@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4306@end table
4307@c @end group
4308
4309When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4310program until you
4311continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4312effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4313after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4314command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4315program sees that signal when you continue.
4316
4317The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4318non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4319@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4320erroneous signals.
4321
4322You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4323seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4324or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4325due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4326values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4327execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4328a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4329you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4330Program a Signal}.
4331
4332@node Thread Stops
4333@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4334
4335When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4336Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4337breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4338
4339@table @code
4340@cindex breakpoints and threads
4341@cindex thread breakpoints
4342@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4343@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4344@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4345@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4346writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4347specify some source line.
4348
4349Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4350to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4351particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4352numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4353column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4354
4355If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4356breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4357program.
4358
4359You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4360well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4361breakpoint condition, like this:
4362
4363@smallexample
4364(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4365@end smallexample
4366
4367@end table
4368
4369@cindex stopped threads
4370@cindex threads, stopped
4371Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4372@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4373allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4374switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4375underfoot.
4376
4377@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4378@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4379@cindex premature return from system calls
4380There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4381breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4382system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4383consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4384that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4385stop execution.
4386
4387To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4388each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4389style anyways.
4390
4391For example, do not write code like this:
4392
4393@smallexample
4394 sleep (10);
4395@end smallexample
4396
4397The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4398at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4399
4400Instead, write this:
4401
4402@smallexample
4403 int unslept = 10;
4404 while (unslept > 0)
4405 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4406@end smallexample
4407
4408A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4409conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4410multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4411@value{GDBN}.
4412
4413Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4414monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4415When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4416prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4417
4418@cindex continuing threads
4419@cindex threads, continuing
4420Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4421executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4422like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4423
4424In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4425Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4426system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4427execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4428single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4429statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4430stops.
4431
4432You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4433continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4434thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4435first thread completes whatever you requested.
4436
4437On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4438thread to run.
4439
4440@table @code
4441@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4442@cindex scheduler locking mode
4443@cindex lock scheduler
4444Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4445locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4446current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4447mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4448``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4449stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4450when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4451function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4452like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4453thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4454@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4455
4456@item show scheduler-locking
4457Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4458@end table
4459
4460
4461@node Stack
4462@chapter Examining the Stack
4463
4464When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4465stopped and how it got there.
4466
4467@cindex call stack
4468Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4469is generated.
4470That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4471the arguments of the call,
4472and the local variables of the function being called.
4473The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4474The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4475stack}.
4476
4477When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4478stack allow you to see all of this information.
4479
4480@cindex selected frame
4481One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4482@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4483particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4484your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4485special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4486interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4487
4488When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4489currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4490@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4491
4492@menu
4493* Frames:: Stack frames
4494* Backtrace:: Backtraces
4495* Selection:: Selecting a frame
4496* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4497
4498@end menu
4499
4500@node Frames
4501@section Stack Frames
4502
4503@cindex frame, definition
4504@cindex stack frame
4505The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4506frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4507with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4508to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4509which the function is executing.
4510
4511@cindex initial frame
4512@cindex outermost frame
4513@cindex innermost frame
4514When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4515function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4516@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4517made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4518is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4519the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4520actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4521recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4522
4523@cindex frame pointer
4524Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4525stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4526kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4527address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4528in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4529(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4530
4531@cindex frame number
4532@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4533zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4534and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4535they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4536frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4537
4538@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4539@c underflow problems.
4540@cindex frameless execution
4541Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4542without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4543@smallexample
4544@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4545@end smallexample
4546generates functions without a frame.)
4547This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4548the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4549with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4550has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4551it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4552correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4553no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4554
4555@table @code
4556@kindex frame@r{, command}
4557@cindex current stack frame
4558@item frame @var{args}
4559The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4560and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4561address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4562@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4563
4564@kindex select-frame
4565@cindex selecting frame silently
4566@item select-frame
4567The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4568to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4569@code{frame}.
4570@end table
4571
4572@node Backtrace
4573@section Backtraces
4574
4575@cindex traceback
4576@cindex call stack traces
4577A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4578line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4579frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4580stack.
4581
4582@table @code
4583@kindex backtrace
4584@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4585@item backtrace
4586@itemx bt
4587Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4588frames in the stack.
4589
4590You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4591character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4592
4593@item backtrace @var{n}
4594@itemx bt @var{n}
4595Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4596
4597@item backtrace -@var{n}
4598@itemx bt -@var{n}
4599Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4600
4601@item backtrace full
4602@itemx bt full
4603@itemx bt full @var{n}
4604@itemx bt full -@var{n}
4605Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4606number of frames to print, as described above.
4607@end table
4608
4609@kindex where
4610@kindex info stack
4611The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4612are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4613
4614@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4615In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4616backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4617several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4618(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4619apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4620the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4621multi-threaded program.
4622
4623Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4624The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4625print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4626line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4627counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4628line number.
4629
4630Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4631@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4632
4633@smallexample
4634@group
4635#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4636 at builtin.c:993
4637#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4638#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4639 at macro.c:71
4640(More stack frames follow...)
4641@end group
4642@end smallexample
4643
4644@noindent
4645The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4646value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4647code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4648
4649@cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4650@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4651If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4652optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4653never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4654passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4655in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4656arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4657such a backtrace might look like:
4658
4659@smallexample
4660@group
4661#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4662 at builtin.c:993
4663#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4664#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4665 at macro.c:71
4666(More stack frames follow...)
4667@end group
4668@end smallexample
4669
4670@noindent
4671The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4672shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4673
4674If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4675either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4676you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4677
4678@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4679@cindex program entry point
4680@cindex startup code, and backtrace
4681Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4682libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4683@code{main}@footnote{
4684Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4685environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4686entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4687When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4688it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4689system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4690
4691If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4692in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4693
4694@table @code
4695@item set backtrace past-main
4696@itemx set backtrace past-main on
4697@kindex set backtrace
4698Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4699
4700@item set backtrace past-main off
4701Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4702default.
4703
4704@item show backtrace past-main
4705@kindex show backtrace
4706Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4707
4708@item set backtrace past-entry
4709@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4710Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4711This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4712and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4713
4714@item set backtrace past-entry off
4715Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4716application. This is the default.
4717
4718@item show backtrace past-entry
4719Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4720
4721@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4722@itemx set backtrace limit 0
4723@cindex backtrace limit
4724Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4725unlimited.
4726
4727@item show backtrace limit
4728Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4729@end table
4730
4731@node Selection
4732@section Selecting a Frame
4733
4734Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4735whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4736selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4737of the stack frame just selected.
4738
4739@table @code
4740@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4741@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4742@item frame @var{n}
4743@itemx f @var{n}
4744Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4745(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4746innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4747@code{main}.
4748
4749@item frame @var{addr}
4750@itemx f @var{addr}
4751Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4752chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4753impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4754addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4755switches between them.
4756
4757On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4758select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4759
4760On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4761pointer and a program counter.
4762
4763On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4764pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4765
4766@kindex up
4767@item up @var{n}
4768Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4769advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4770that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4771
4772@kindex down
4773@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4774@item down @var{n}
4775Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4776advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4777that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4778abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4779@end table
4780
4781All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4782frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4783arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4784frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4785
4786@need 1000
4787For example:
4788
4789@smallexample
4790@group
4791(@value{GDBP}) up
4792#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4793 at env.c:10
479410 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4795@end group
4796@end smallexample
4797
4798After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4799prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4800You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4801editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4802@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4803for details.
4804
4805@table @code
4806@kindex down-silently
4807@kindex up-silently
4808@item up-silently @var{n}
4809@itemx down-silently @var{n}
4810These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4811respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4812causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4813in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4814distracting.
4815@end table
4816
4817@node Frame Info
4818@section Information About a Frame
4819
4820There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4821stack frame.
4822
4823@table @code
4824@item frame
4825@itemx f
4826When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4827frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4828selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4829argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4830@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4831
4832@kindex info frame
4833@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4834@item info frame
4835@itemx info f
4836This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4837including:
4838
4839@itemize @bullet
4840@item
4841the address of the frame
4842@item
4843the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4844@item
4845the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4846@item
4847the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4848@item
4849the address of the frame's arguments
4850@item
4851the address of the frame's local variables
4852@item
4853the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4854@item
4855which registers were saved in the frame
4856@end itemize
4857
4858@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4859something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4860the usual conventions.
4861
4862@item info frame @var{addr}
4863@itemx info f @var{addr}
4864Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4865selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4866command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4867architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4868@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4869
4870@kindex info args
4871@item info args
4872Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4873
4874@item info locals
4875@kindex info locals
4876Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4877line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4878accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4879
4880@kindex info catch
4881@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4882@cindex exception handlers, how to list
4883@item info catch
4884Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4885current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4886exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4887@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4888@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4889
4890@end table
4891
4892
4893@node Source
4894@chapter Examining Source Files
4895
4896@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4897information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4898used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4899the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4900(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4901execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4902source files by explicit command.
4903
4904If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4905prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4906@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4907
4908@menu
4909* List:: Printing source lines
4910* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
4911* Edit:: Editing source files
4912* Search:: Searching source files
4913* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4914* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4915@end menu
4916
4917@node List
4918@section Printing Source Lines
4919
4920@kindex list
4921@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4922To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4923(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4924There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
4925print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
4926
4927Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4928
4929@table @code
4930@item list @var{linenum}
4931Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4932current source file.
4933
4934@item list @var{function}
4935Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4936@var{function}.
4937
4938@item list
4939Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4940@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4941printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4942as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4943Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4944
4945@item list -
4946Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4947@end table
4948
4949@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4950By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4951the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4952
4953@table @code
4954@kindex set listsize
4955@item set listsize @var{count}
4956Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4957the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4958
4959@kindex show listsize
4960@item show listsize
4961Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4962@end table
4963
4964Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4965so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4966than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4967argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4968each repetition moves up in the source file.
4969
4970In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4971@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4972of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
4973to specify some source line.
4974
4975Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4976
4977@table @code
4978@item list @var{linespec}
4979Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4980
4981@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4982Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4983linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
4984source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
4985the same source file as the first linespec.
4986
4987@item list ,@var{last}
4988Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4989
4990@item list @var{first},
4991Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4992
4993@item list +
4994Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4995
4996@item list -
4997Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4998
4999@item list
5000As described in the preceding table.
5001@end table
5002
5003@node Specify Location
5004@section Specifying a Location
5005@cindex specifying location
5006@cindex linespec
5007
5008Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5009of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5010debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5011for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5012
5013Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5014@value{GDBN} understands:
5015
5016@table @code
5017@item @var{linenum}
5018Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5019
5020@item -@var{offset}
5021@itemx +@var{offset}
5022Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5023line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5024printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5025execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5026(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5027used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5028this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5029linespec.
5030
5031@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5032Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5033
5034@item @var{function}
5035Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5036For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5037
5038@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5039Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5040in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5041function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5042functions in different source files.
5043
5044@item *@var{address}
5045Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5046commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5047line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5048breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5049parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5050source files.
5051
5052Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5053language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5054address. As a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the semantics of
5055expressions used in locations to cover the situations that frequently
5056happen during debugging. Here are the various forms of @var{address}:
5057
5058@table @code
5059@item @var{expression}
5060Any expression valid in the current working language.
5061
5062@item @var{funcaddr}
5063An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5064C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5065simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5066of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5067@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5068(although the Pascal form also works).
5069
5070This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5071before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5072
5073@item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5074Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5075file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5076specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5077functions with identical names in different source files.
5078@end table
5079
5080@end table
5081
5082
5083@node Edit
5084@section Editing Source Files
5085@cindex editing source files
5086
5087@kindex edit
5088@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5089To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5090The editing program of your choice
5091is invoked with the current line set to
5092the active line in the program.
5093Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5094want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5095
5096@table @code
5097@item edit @var{location}
5098Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5099that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5100specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5101of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5102command most commonly used:
5103
5104@table @code
5105@item edit @var{number}
5106Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5107
5108@item edit @var{function}
5109Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5110@end table
5111
5112@end table
5113
5114@subsection Choosing your Editor
5115You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5116@footnote{
5117The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5118following command-line syntax:
5119@smallexample
5120ex +@var{number} file
5121@end smallexample
5122The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5123the file where to start editing.}.
5124By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5125by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5126@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5127@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5128@smallexample
5129EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5130export EDITOR
5131gdb @dots{}
5132@end smallexample
5133or in the @code{csh} shell,
5134@smallexample
5135setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5136gdb @dots{}
5137@end smallexample
5138
5139@node Search
5140@section Searching Source Files
5141@cindex searching source files
5142
5143There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5144regular expression.
5145
5146@table @code
5147@kindex search
5148@kindex forward-search
5149@item forward-search @var{regexp}
5150@itemx search @var{regexp}
5151The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5152starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5153@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5154synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5155@code{fo}.
5156
5157@kindex reverse-search
5158@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5159The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5160with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5161for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5162this command as @code{rev}.
5163@end table
5164
5165@node Source Path
5166@section Specifying Source Directories
5167
5168@cindex source path
5169@cindex directories for source files
5170Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5171files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5172the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5173session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5174this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5175it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5176in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5177
5178For example, suppose an executable references the file
5179@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5180@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5181fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5182fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5183message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5184source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5185Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5186the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5187@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5188@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5189
5190Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5191names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5192instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5193is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5194@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5195that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5196
5197Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5198source files.
5199
5200Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5201any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5202each line is in the file.
5203
5204@kindex directory
5205@kindex dir
5206When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5207and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5208To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5209
5210The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5211script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5212
5213In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5214that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5215rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5216debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5217directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5218two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5219the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5220In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5221@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5222of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5223source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5224name to look up the sources.
5225
5226Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5227moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5228@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5229@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5230@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5231of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5232substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5233(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5234
5235To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5236@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5237For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5238@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5239not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5240is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5241not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5242
5243In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5244command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5245the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5246subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5247subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5248preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5249allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5250command.
5251
5252@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5253The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5254longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5255the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5256for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5257located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5258method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5259
5260@table @code
5261@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5262@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5263Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5264directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5265(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5266part of absolute file names) or
5267whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5268path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5269
5270@kindex cdir
5271@kindex cwd
5272@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5273@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5274@cindex compilation directory
5275@cindex current directory
5276@cindex working directory
5277@cindex directory, current
5278@cindex directory, compilation
5279You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5280directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5281working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5282tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5283session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5284directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5285
5286@item directory
5287Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5288
5289@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5290@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5291
5292@item show directories
5293@kindex show directories
5294Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5295
5296@anchor{set substitute-path}
5297@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5298@kindex set substitute-path
5299Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5300current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5301@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5302
5303For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5304@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5305
5306@smallexample
5307(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5308@end smallexample
5309
5310@noindent
5311will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5312@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5313@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5314
5315In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5316the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5317defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5318the substitution.
5319
5320For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5321
5322@smallexample
5323(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5324(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5325@end smallexample
5326
5327@noindent
5328@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5329@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5330use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5331@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5332
5333
5334@item unset substitute-path [path]
5335@kindex unset substitute-path
5336If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5337for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5338A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5339
5340If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5341
5342@item show substitute-path [path]
5343@kindex show substitute-path
5344If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5345which would rewrite that path, if any.
5346
5347If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5348rules.
5349
5350@end table
5351
5352If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5353interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5354versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5355
5356@enumerate
5357@item
5358Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5359
5360@item
5361Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5362directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5363directories in one command.
5364@end enumerate
5365
5366@node Machine Code
5367@section Source and Machine Code
5368@cindex source line and its code address
5369
5370You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5371addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5372a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5373mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5374line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5375well as hex.
5376
5377@table @code
5378@kindex info line
5379@item info line @var{linespec}
5380Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5381source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5382the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5383@end table
5384
5385For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5386the object code for the first line of function
5387@code{m4_changequote}:
5388
5389@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5390@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5391@smallexample
5392(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5393Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5394@end smallexample
5395
5396@noindent
5397@cindex code address and its source line
5398We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5399@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5400@smallexample
5401(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5402Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5403@end smallexample
5404
5405@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5406@cindex @code{x} command, default address
5407@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5408After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5409is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5410sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5411,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5412convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5413Variables}).
5414
5415@table @code
5416@kindex disassemble
5417@cindex assembly instructions
5418@cindex instructions, assembly
5419@cindex machine instructions
5420@cindex listing machine instructions
5421@item disassemble
5422This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5423instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5424program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5425command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5426surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5427(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5428@end table
5429
5430The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5431HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5432
5433@smallexample
5434(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5435Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
54360x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
54370x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
54380x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
54390x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
54400x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
54410x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
54420x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
54430x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5444End of assembler dump.
5445@end smallexample
5446
5447Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5448mnemonics or other syntax.
5449
5450For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5451instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5452libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5453location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5454might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5455
5456@table @code
5457@kindex set disassembly-flavor
5458@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5459@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5460@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5461Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5462program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5463
5464Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5465can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5466The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5467assemblers for x86-based targets.
5468
5469@kindex show disassembly-flavor
5470@item show disassembly-flavor
5471Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5472@end table
5473
5474
5475@node Data
5476@chapter Examining Data
5477
5478@cindex printing data
5479@cindex examining data
5480@kindex print
5481@kindex inspect
5482@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5483@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5484@c different window or something like that.
5485The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5486command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5487evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5488program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5489Different Languages}).
5490
5491@table @code
5492@item print @var{expr}
5493@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5494@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5495value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5496you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5497@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5498Formats}.
5499
5500@item print
5501@itemx print /@var{f}
5502@cindex reprint the last value
5503If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5504@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5505conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5506@end table
5507
5508A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5509It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5510specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5511
5512If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5513fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5514command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5515Table}.
5516
5517@menu
5518* Expressions:: Expressions
5519* Variables:: Program variables
5520* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5521* Output Formats:: Output formats
5522* Memory:: Examining memory
5523* Auto Display:: Automatic display
5524* Print Settings:: Print settings
5525* Value History:: Value history
5526* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5527* Registers:: Registers
5528* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5529* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5530* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5531* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5532* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5533* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5534* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5535 character set than GDB does
5536* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5537@end menu
5538
5539@node Expressions
5540@section Expressions
5541
5542@cindex expressions
5543@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5544compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5545by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5546@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5547casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5548you compiled your program to include this information; see
5549@ref{Compilation}.
5550
5551@cindex arrays in expressions
5552@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5553the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5554you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5555memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5556
5557Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5558this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5559Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5560languages.
5561
5562In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5563expressions regardless of your programming language.
5564
5565@cindex casts, in expressions
5566Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5567useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5568at that address in memory.
5569@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5570
5571@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5572to programming languages:
5573
5574@table @code
5575@item @@
5576@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5577@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5578
5579@item ::
5580@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5581function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5582
5583@cindex @{@var{type}@}
5584@cindex type casting memory
5585@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5586@cindex casts, to view memory
5587@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5588Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5589memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5590pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5591a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5592normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5593@end table
5594
5595@node Variables
5596@section Program Variables
5597
5598The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5599in your program.
5600
5601Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5602(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5603
5604@itemize @bullet
5605@item
5606global (or file-static)
5607@end itemize
5608
5609@noindent or
5610
5611@itemize @bullet
5612@item
5613visible according to the scope rules of the
5614programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5615@end itemize
5616
5617@noindent This means that in the function
5618
5619@smallexample
5620foo (a)
5621 int a;
5622@{
5623 bar (a);
5624 @{
5625 int b = test ();
5626 bar (b);
5627 @}
5628@}
5629@end smallexample
5630
5631@noindent
5632you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5633executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5634examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5635the block where @code{b} is declared.
5636
5637@cindex variable name conflict
5638There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5639scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5640in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5641function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5642happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5643you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5644using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5645
5646@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5647@ifnotinfo
5648@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5649@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5650@end ifnotinfo
5651@smallexample
5652@var{file}::@var{variable}
5653@var{function}::@var{variable}
5654@end smallexample
5655
5656@noindent
5657Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5658static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5659make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5660to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5661
5662@smallexample
5663(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5664@end smallexample
5665
5666@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5667This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5668use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5669scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5670@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5671@c conflict?? --mew
5672
5673@cindex wrong values
5674@cindex variable values, wrong
5675@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5676@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5677@quotation
5678@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5679wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5680scope, and just before exit.
5681@end quotation
5682You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5683This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5684set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5685stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5686values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5687also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5688after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5689variable definitions may be gone.
5690
5691This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5692To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5693when compiling.
5694
5695@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5696Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5697unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5698opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5699offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5700might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5701happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5702
5703@smallexample
5704No symbol "foo" in current context.
5705@end smallexample
5706
5707To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5708different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5709formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5710usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5711produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5712COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5713an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5714for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5715Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5716@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5717that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5718
5719If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5720@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5721by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5722type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5723
5724Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5725signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5726printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5727@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5728defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5729For program code
5730
5731@smallexample
5732char var0[] = "A";
5733signed char var1[] = "A";
5734@end smallexample
5735
5736You get during debugging
5737@smallexample
5738(gdb) print var0
5739$1 = "A"
5740(gdb) print var1
5741$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5742@end smallexample
5743
5744@node Arrays
5745@section Artificial Arrays
5746
5747@cindex artificial array
5748@cindex arrays
5749@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5750It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5751same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5752dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5753program.
5754
5755You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5756@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5757operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5758and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5759of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5760the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5761argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5762following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5763example. If a program says
5764
5765@smallexample
5766int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5767@end smallexample
5768
5769@noindent
5770you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5771
5772@smallexample
5773p *array@@len
5774@end smallexample
5775
5776The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5777with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5778subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5779Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5780(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5781
5782Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5783This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5784The value need not be in memory:
5785@smallexample
5786(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5787$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5788@end smallexample
5789
5790As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5791@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5792the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5793@smallexample
5794(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5795$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5796@end smallexample
5797
5798Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5799moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5800actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5801of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5802to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5803Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5804interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5805instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5806structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5807in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5808
5809@smallexample
5810set $i = 0
5811p dtab[$i++]->fv
5812@key{RET}
5813@key{RET}
5814@dots{}
5815@end smallexample
5816
5817@node Output Formats
5818@section Output Formats
5819
5820@cindex formatted output
5821@cindex output formats
5822By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5823this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5824in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5825at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5826these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5827
5828The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5829already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5830@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5831letters supported are:
5832
5833@table @code
5834@item x
5835Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5836hexadecimal.
5837
5838@item d
5839Print as integer in signed decimal.
5840
5841@item u
5842Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5843
5844@item o
5845Print as integer in octal.
5846
5847@item t
5848Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5849@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5850used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5851see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5852
5853@item a
5854@cindex unknown address, locating
5855@cindex locate address
5856Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5857the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5858where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5859
5860@smallexample
5861(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5862$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5863@end smallexample
5864
5865@noindent
5866The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5867@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5868
5869@item c
5870Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5871prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5872character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5873for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5874
5875Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
5876@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
5877constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
5878data.
5879
5880@item f
5881Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5882using typical floating point syntax.
5883
5884@item s
5885@cindex printing strings
5886@cindex printing byte arrays
5887Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
5888data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
5889are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
5890natural types.
5891
5892Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
5893@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
5894strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
5895array.
5896@end table
5897
5898For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5899
5900@smallexample
5901p/x $pc
5902@end smallexample
5903
5904@noindent
5905Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5906names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5907
5908To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5909you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5910expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5911
5912@node Memory
5913@section Examining Memory
5914
5915You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5916any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5917
5918@cindex examining memory
5919@table @code
5920@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5921@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5922@itemx x @var{addr}
5923@itemx x
5924Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5925@end table
5926
5927@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5928much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5929expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5930If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5931Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5932
5933@table @r
5934@item @var{n}, the repeat count
5935The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5936how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5937@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5938@c 4.1.2.
5939
5940@item @var{f}, the display format
5941The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5942(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5943@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
5944The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
5945each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
5946
5947@item @var{u}, the unit size
5948The unit size is any of
5949
5950@table @code
5951@item b
5952Bytes.
5953@item h
5954Halfwords (two bytes).
5955@item w
5956Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5957@item g
5958Giant words (eight bytes).
5959@end table
5960
5961Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5962default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5963@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5964
5965@item @var{addr}, starting display address
5966@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5967memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5968it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5969@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5970@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5971other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5972the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5973starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5974a value from memory).
5975@end table
5976
5977For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5978(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5979starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5980words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5981@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5982
5983Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5984letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5985unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5986specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5987(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5988
5989Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5990and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5991@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5992including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
5993the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
5994slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
5995follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
5996@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
5997instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5998
5999All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6000easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6001you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6002instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6003with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6004the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6005for successive uses of @code{x}.
6006
6007@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6008The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6009in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6010would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6011subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6012@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6013examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6014@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6015the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6016
6017If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6018are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6019address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6020
6021@cindex remote memory comparison
6022@cindex verify remote memory image
6023When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6024(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6025remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6026the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6027situations.
6028
6029@table @code
6030@kindex compare-sections
6031@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6032Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6033executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6034the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6035arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6036availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6037remote request.
6038@end table
6039
6040@node Auto Display
6041@section Automatic Display
6042@cindex automatic display
6043@cindex display of expressions
6044
6045If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6046(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6047display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6048Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6049to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6050The automatic display looks like this:
6051
6052@smallexample
60532: foo = 38
60543: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6055@end smallexample
6056
6057@noindent
6058This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6059displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6060specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6061whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6062specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6063or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6064
6065@table @code
6066@kindex display
6067@item display @var{expr}
6068Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6069each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6070
6071@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6072
6073@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6074For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6075count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6076arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6077@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6078
6079@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6080For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6081number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6082be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6083doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6084@end table
6085
6086For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6087instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6088is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6089
6090@table @code
6091@kindex delete display
6092@kindex undisplay
6093@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6094@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6095Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6096
6097@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6098(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6099
6100@kindex disable display
6101@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6102Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6103item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6104enabled again later.
6105
6106@kindex enable display
6107@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6108Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6109again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6110
6111@item display
6112Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6113done when your program stops.
6114
6115@kindex info display
6116@item info display
6117Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6118automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6119values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6120It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6121because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6122@end table
6123
6124@cindex display disabled out of scope
6125If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6126sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6127expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6128variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6129@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6130@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6131continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6132there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6133automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6134is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6135
6136@node Print Settings
6137@section Print Settings
6138
6139@cindex format options
6140@cindex print settings
6141@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6142and symbols are printed.
6143
6144@noindent
6145These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6146
6147@table @code
6148@kindex set print
6149@item set print address
6150@itemx set print address on
6151@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6152@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6153traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6154even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6155is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6156@code{set print address on}:
6157
6158@smallexample
6159@group
6160(@value{GDBP}) f
6161#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6162 at input.c:530
6163530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6164@end group
6165@end smallexample
6166
6167@item set print address off
6168Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6169this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6170
6171@smallexample
6172@group
6173(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6174(@value{GDBP}) f
6175#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6176530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6177@end group
6178@end smallexample
6179
6180You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6181dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6182@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6183all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6184
6185@kindex show print
6186@item show print address
6187Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6188@end table
6189
6190When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6191closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6192identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6193source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6194@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6195you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6196it prints a symbolic address:
6197
6198@table @code
6199@item set print symbol-filename on
6200@cindex source file and line of a symbol
6201@cindex symbol, source file and line
6202Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6203symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6204
6205@item set print symbol-filename off
6206Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6207default.
6208
6209@item show print symbol-filename
6210Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6211line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6212@end table
6213
6214Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6215numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6216number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6217
6218Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6219printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6220
6221@table @code
6222@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6223@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6224Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6225offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6226@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6227to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6228
6229@item show print max-symbolic-offset
6230Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6231symbolic address.
6232@end table
6233
6234@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6235@cindex pointer, finding referent
6236If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6237@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6238and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6239@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6240For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6241at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6242
6243@smallexample
6244(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6245(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6246$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6247@end smallexample
6248
6249@quotation
6250@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6251does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6252the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6253@end quotation
6254
6255Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6256
6257@table @code
6258@item set print array
6259@itemx set print array on
6260@cindex pretty print arrays
6261Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6262but uses more space. The default is off.
6263
6264@item set print array off
6265Return to compressed format for arrays.
6266
6267@item show print array
6268Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6269arrays.
6270
6271@cindex print array indexes
6272@item set print array-indexes
6273@itemx set print array-indexes on
6274Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6275convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6276index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6277
6278@item set print array-indexes off
6279Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6280
6281@item show print array-indexes
6282Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6283arrays.
6284
6285@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6286@cindex number of array elements to print
6287@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6288Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6289If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6290printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6291This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6292When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6293Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6294
6295@item show print elements
6296Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6297If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6298
6299@item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6300@cindex printing frame argument values
6301@cindex print all frame argument values
6302@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6303@cindex do not print frame argument values
6304This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6305when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6306values are:
6307
6308@table @code
6309@item all
6310The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6311
6312@item scalars
6313Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6314complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6315by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6316
6317@smallexample
6318#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6319 at frame-args.c:23
6320@end smallexample
6321
6322@item none
6323None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6324is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6325
6326@smallexample
6327#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6328 at frame-args.c:23
6329@end smallexample
6330@end table
6331
6332By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
6333can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
6334the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
6335more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
6336when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
6337can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
6338Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
6339avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
6340
6341@item show print frame-arguments
6342Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
6343
6344@item set print repeats
6345@cindex repeated array elements
6346Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6347elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6348array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6349@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6350identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6351themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6352be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6353
6354@item show print repeats
6355Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6356elements.
6357
6358@item set print null-stop
6359@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6360Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6361@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6362contain only short strings.
6363The default is off.
6364
6365@item show print null-stop
6366Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6367@sc{null} character.
6368
6369@item set print pretty on
6370@cindex print structures in indented form
6371@cindex indentation in structure display
6372Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6373per line, like this:
6374
6375@smallexample
6376@group
6377$1 = @{
6378 next = 0x0,
6379 flags = @{
6380 sweet = 1,
6381 sour = 1
6382 @},
6383 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6384@}
6385@end group
6386@end smallexample
6387
6388@item set print pretty off
6389Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6390
6391@smallexample
6392@group
6393$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6394meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6395@end group
6396@end smallexample
6397
6398@noindent
6399This is the default format.
6400
6401@item show print pretty
6402Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6403
6404@item set print sevenbit-strings on
6405@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6406@cindex octal escapes in strings
6407Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6408@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6409character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6410best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6411high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6412
6413@item set print sevenbit-strings off
6414Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6415international character sets, and is the default.
6416
6417@item show print sevenbit-strings
6418Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6419
6420@item set print union on
6421@cindex unions in structures, printing
6422Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6423and other unions. This is the default setting.
6424
6425@item set print union off
6426Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6427structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6428instead.
6429
6430@item show print union
6431Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6432structures and other unions.
6433
6434For example, given the declarations
6435
6436@smallexample
6437typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6438typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6439typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6440 Bug_forms;
6441
6442struct thing @{
6443 Species it;
6444 union @{
6445 Tree_forms tree;
6446 Bug_forms bug;
6447 @} form;
6448@};
6449
6450struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6451@end smallexample
6452
6453@noindent
6454with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6455
6456@smallexample
6457$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6458@end smallexample
6459
6460@noindent
6461and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6462
6463@smallexample
6464$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6465@end smallexample
6466
6467@noindent
6468@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6469and in Pascal.
6470@end table
6471
6472@need 1000
6473@noindent
6474These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6475
6476@table @code
6477@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6478@item set print demangle
6479@itemx set print demangle on
6480Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6481(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6482linkage. The default is on.
6483
6484@item show print demangle
6485Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6486
6487@item set print asm-demangle
6488@itemx set print asm-demangle on
6489Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6490in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6491The default is off.
6492
6493@item show print asm-demangle
6494Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6495or demangled form.
6496
6497@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6498@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6499@kindex set demangle-style
6500@item set demangle-style @var{style}
6501Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6502represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6503
6504@table @code
6505@item auto
6506Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6507
6508@item gnu
6509Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6510This is the default.
6511
6512@item hp
6513Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6514
6515@item lucid
6516Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6517
6518@item arm
6519Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6520@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6521debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6522require further enhancement to permit that.
6523
6524@end table
6525If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6526
6527@item show demangle-style
6528Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6529
6530@item set print object
6531@itemx set print object on
6532@cindex derived type of an object, printing
6533@cindex display derived types
6534When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6535(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6536the virtual function table.
6537
6538@item set print object off
6539Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6540virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6541
6542@item show print object
6543Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6544
6545@item set print static-members
6546@itemx set print static-members on
6547@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6548Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6549
6550@item set print static-members off
6551Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6552
6553@item show print static-members
6554Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6555
6556@item set print pascal_static-members
6557@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6558@cindex static members of Pascal objects
6559@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6560Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6561
6562@item set print pascal_static-members off
6563Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6564
6565@item show print pascal_static-members
6566Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6567
6568@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6569@item set print vtbl
6570@itemx set print vtbl on
6571@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6572@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6573@cindex VTBL display
6574Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6575(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6576ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6577
6578@item set print vtbl off
6579Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6580
6581@item show print vtbl
6582Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6583@end table
6584
6585@node Value History
6586@section Value History
6587
6588@cindex value history
6589@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6590Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6591@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6592Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6593(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6594When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6595since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6596symbol table.
6597
6598@cindex @code{$}
6599@cindex @code{$$}
6600@cindex history number
6601The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6602refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6603@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6604printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6605history number.
6606
6607To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6608history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6609remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6610the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6611@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6612is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6613@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6614
6615For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6616want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6617
6618@smallexample
6619p *$
6620@end smallexample
6621
6622If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6623to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6624
6625@smallexample
6626p *$.next
6627@end smallexample
6628
6629@noindent
6630You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6631command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6632
6633Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6634@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6635
6636@smallexample
6637print x
6638set x=5
6639@end smallexample
6640
6641@noindent
6642then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6643remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6644
6645@table @code
6646@kindex show values
6647@item show values
6648Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6649This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6650values} does not change the history.
6651
6652@item show values @var{n}
6653Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6654
6655@item show values +
6656Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6657values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6658@end table
6659
6660Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6661same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6662
6663@node Convenience Vars
6664@section Convenience Variables
6665
6666@cindex convenience variables
6667@cindex user-defined variables
6668@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6669@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6670exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6671setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6672of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6673
6674Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6675@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6676the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6677(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6678by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6679
6680You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6681expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6682For example:
6683
6684@smallexample
6685set $foo = *object_ptr
6686@end smallexample
6687
6688@noindent
6689would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6690@code{object_ptr}.
6691
6692Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6693value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6694value with another assignment at any time.
6695
6696Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6697variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6698that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6699variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6700
6701@table @code
6702@kindex show convenience
6703@cindex show all user variables
6704@item show convenience
6705Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6706Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6707
6708@kindex init-if-undefined
6709@cindex convenience variables, initializing
6710@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6711Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6712for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6713to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6714convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6715override default values used in a command script.
6716
6717If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6718any side-effects do not occur.
6719@end table
6720
6721One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6722incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6723a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6724
6725@smallexample
6726set $i = 0
6727print bar[$i++]->contents
6728@end smallexample
6729
6730@noindent
6731Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6732
6733Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6734values likely to be useful.
6735
6736@table @code
6737@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6738@item $_
6739The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6740the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6741commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6742set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6743and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6744except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6745to the type of @code{$__}.
6746
6747@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6748@item $__
6749The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6750to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6751to match the format in which the data was printed.
6752
6753@item $_exitcode
6754@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6755The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6756the program being debugged terminates.
6757@end table
6758
6759On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6760begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6761name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6762
6763@node Registers
6764@section Registers
6765
6766@cindex registers
6767You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6768with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6769for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6770your machine.
6771
6772@table @code
6773@kindex info registers
6774@item info registers
6775Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6776and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6777
6778@kindex info all-registers
6779@cindex floating point registers
6780@item info all-registers
6781Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6782and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6783
6784@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6785Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6786As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6787the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6788the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6789@end table
6790
6791@cindex stack pointer register
6792@cindex program counter register
6793@cindex process status register
6794@cindex frame pointer register
6795@cindex standard registers
6796@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6797expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6798architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6799@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6800the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6801pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6802register that contains the processor status. For example,
6803you could print the program counter in hex with
6804
6805@smallexample
6806p/x $pc
6807@end smallexample
6808
6809@noindent
6810or print the instruction to be executed next with
6811
6812@smallexample
6813x/i $pc
6814@end smallexample
6815
6816@noindent
6817or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6818one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6819memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6820stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6821stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6822regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6823see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6824
6825@smallexample
6826set $sp += 4
6827@end smallexample
6828
6829Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6830your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6831so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6832shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6833registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6834can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6835is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6836
6837@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6838integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6839special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6840registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6841to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6842(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6843@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6844
6845Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6846means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6847the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6848sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6849coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6850programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6851cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6852that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6853prints the data in both formats.
6854
6855@cindex SSE registers (x86)
6856@cindex MMX registers (x86)
6857Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6858in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6859have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6860together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6861registers in @code{struct} notation:
6862
6863@smallexample
6864(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6865$1 = @{
6866 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6867 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6868 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6869 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6870 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6871 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6872 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6873@}
6874@end smallexample
6875
6876@noindent
6877To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6878view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6879value to a @code{struct} member:
6880
6881@smallexample
6882 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6883@end smallexample
6884
6885Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6886(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6887value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6888were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6889true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6890frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6891
6892However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6893code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6894@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6895frame makes no difference.
6896
6897@node Floating Point Hardware
6898@section Floating Point Hardware
6899@cindex floating point
6900
6901Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6902you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6903
6904@table @code
6905@kindex info float
6906@item info float
6907Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6908point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6909floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6910the ARM and x86 machines.
6911@end table
6912
6913@node Vector Unit
6914@section Vector Unit
6915@cindex vector unit
6916
6917Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6918more information about the status of the vector unit.
6919
6920@table @code
6921@kindex info vector
6922@item info vector
6923Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6924layout vary depending on the hardware.
6925@end table
6926
6927@node OS Information
6928@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6929@cindex OS information
6930
6931@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6932you debug your program.
6933
6934@cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6935@cindex @code{struct user} contents
6936When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6937machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6938system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6939called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6940command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6941structure.
6942
6943@table @code
6944@item info udot
6945@kindex info udot
6946Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6947kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6948contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6949the @code{examine} command.
6950@end table
6951
6952@cindex auxiliary vector
6953@cindex vector, auxiliary
6954Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6955startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6956specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6957binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6958hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6959identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6960Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6961@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6962targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6963support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6964@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6965
6966@table @code
6967@kindex info auxv
6968@item info auxv
6969Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6970live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6971numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6972tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6973pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6974most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6975an unrecognized tag.
6976@end table
6977
6978
6979@node Memory Region Attributes
6980@section Memory Region Attributes
6981@cindex memory region attributes
6982
6983@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6984required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6985attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6986accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6987target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6988fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6989user can override the fetched regions.
6990
6991Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6992memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6993accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6994been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6995all memory.
6996
6997When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6998to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6999
7000@table @code
7001@kindex mem
7002@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7003Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7004attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7005monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7006case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7007(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7008
7009@item mem auto
7010Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7011regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7012
7013@kindex delete mem
7014@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7015Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7016monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7017
7018@kindex disable mem
7019@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7020Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7021A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7022It may be enabled again later.
7023
7024@kindex enable mem
7025@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7026Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7027
7028@kindex info mem
7029@item info mem
7030Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7031for each region:
7032
7033@table @emph
7034@item Memory Region Number
7035@item Enabled or Disabled.
7036Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7037Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7038
7039@item Lo Address
7040The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7041
7042@item Hi Address
7043The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7044
7045@item Attributes
7046The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7047@end table
7048@end table
7049
7050
7051@subsection Attributes
7052
7053@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7054The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7055write accesses to a memory region.
7056
7057While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7058memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7059etc.@: from accessing memory.
7060
7061@table @code
7062@item ro
7063Memory is read only.
7064@item wo
7065Memory is write only.
7066@item rw
7067Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7068@end table
7069
7070@subsubsection Memory Access Size
7071The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7072accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7073require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7074specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7075
7076@table @code
7077@item 8
7078Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7079@item 16
7080Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7081@item 32
7082Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7083@item 64
7084Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7085@end table
7086
7087@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7088@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7089@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7090@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7091@c
7092@c @table @code
7093@c @item hwbreak
7094@c Always use hardware breakpoints
7095@c @item swbreak (default)
7096@c @end table
7097
7098@subsubsection Data Cache
7099The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7100memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7101protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7102does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7103registers.
7104
7105@table @code
7106@item cache
7107Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7108@item nocache
7109Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7110@end table
7111
7112@subsection Memory Access Checking
7113@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7114not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7115regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7116better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7117
7118@table @code
7119@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7120@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7121If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7122explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7123to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7124memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7125treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7126The default value is @code{on}.
7127@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7128@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7129Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7130@end table
7131
7132
7133@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7134@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7135@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7136@c
7137@c @table @code
7138@c @item verify
7139@c @item noverify (default)
7140@c @end table
7141
7142@node Dump/Restore Files
7143@section Copy Between Memory and a File
7144@cindex dump/restore files
7145@cindex append data to a file
7146@cindex dump data to a file
7147@cindex restore data from a file
7148
7149You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7150@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7151@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7152@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7153memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7154Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7155files.
7156
7157@table @code
7158
7159@kindex dump
7160@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7161@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7162Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7163or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7164
7165The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7166@table @code
7167@item binary
7168Raw binary form.
7169@item ihex
7170Intel hex format.
7171@item srec
7172Motorola S-record format.
7173@item tekhex
7174Tektronix Hex format.
7175@end table
7176
7177@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7178@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7179@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7180form.
7181
7182@kindex append
7183@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7184@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7185Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7186or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7187(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7188
7189@kindex restore
7190@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7191Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7192@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7193file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7194must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7195
7196If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7197contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7198they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7199a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7200from that location.
7201
7202If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7203file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7204These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7205the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7206
7207@end table
7208
7209@node Core File Generation
7210@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7211@cindex dump core from inferior
7212
7213A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7214image of a running process and its process status (register values
7215etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7216crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7217automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7218the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7219the post-mortem debugging mode.
7220
7221Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7222are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7223@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7224
7225@table @code
7226@kindex gcore
7227@kindex generate-core-file
7228@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7229@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7230Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7231@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7232specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7233@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7234
7235Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7236this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7237@end table
7238
7239@node Character Sets
7240@section Character Sets
7241@cindex character sets
7242@cindex charset
7243@cindex translating between character sets
7244@cindex host character set
7245@cindex target character set
7246
7247If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7248represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7249@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7250you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7251character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7252@dfn{target character set}.
7253
7254For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7255uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7256remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7257running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7258then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7259@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7260target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7261@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7262character and string literals in expressions.
7263
7264@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7265the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7266target-charset} command, described below.
7267
7268Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7269support:
7270
7271@table @code
7272@item set target-charset @var{charset}
7273@kindex set target-charset
7274Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7275character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7276@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7277list the target character sets it supports.
7278@end table
7279
7280@table @code
7281@item set host-charset @var{charset}
7282@kindex set host-charset
7283Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7284
7285By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7286system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7287@code{set host-charset} command.
7288
7289@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7290set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7291indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7292@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7293list the host character sets it supports.
7294
7295@item set charset @var{charset}
7296@kindex set charset
7297Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7298above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7299@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7300for both host and target.
7301
7302
7303@item show charset
7304@kindex show charset
7305Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7306
7307@itemx show host-charset
7308@kindex show host-charset
7309Show the name of the current host charset.
7310
7311@itemx show target-charset
7312@kindex show target-charset
7313Show the name of the current target charset.
7314
7315@end table
7316
7317@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7318sets:
7319
7320@table @code
7321
7322@item ASCII
7323@cindex ASCII character set
7324Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7325character set.
7326
7327@item ISO-8859-1
7328@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7329@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7330The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7331characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7332this as its host character set.
7333
7334@item EBCDIC-US
7335@itemx IBM1047
7336@cindex EBCDIC character set
7337@cindex IBM1047 character set
7338Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7339mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7340@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7341
7342@end table
7343
7344Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7345@value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7346encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7347
7348Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7349Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7350@file{charset-test.c}:
7351
7352@smallexample
7353#include <stdio.h>
7354
7355char ascii_hello[]
7356 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7357 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7358char ibm1047_hello[]
7359 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7360 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7361
7362main ()
7363@{
7364 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7365@}
7366@end smallexample
7367
7368In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7369containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7370encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7371
7372We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7373
7374@smallexample
7375$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7376$ gdb -nw charset-test
7377GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7378Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7379@dots{}
7380(@value{GDBP})
7381@end smallexample
7382
7383We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7384@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7385strings:
7386
7387@smallexample
7388(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7389The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7390(@value{GDBP})
7391@end smallexample
7392
7393For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7394initial character set:
7395@smallexample
7396(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7397(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7398The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7399(@value{GDBP})
7400@end smallexample
7401
7402Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7403host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7404characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7405them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7406@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7407
7408@smallexample
7409(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7410$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7411(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7412$2 = 72 'H'
7413(@value{GDBP})
7414@end smallexample
7415
7416@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7417literals you use in expressions:
7418
7419@smallexample
7420(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7421$3 = 43 '+'
7422(@value{GDBP})
7423@end smallexample
7424
7425The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7426character.
7427
7428@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7429target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7430character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7431
7432@smallexample
7433(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7434$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7435(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7436$5 = 200 '\310'
7437(@value{GDBP})
7438@end smallexample
7439
7440If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7441@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7442
7443@smallexample
7444(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7445ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7446(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7447@end smallexample
7448
7449We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7450program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7451@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7452target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7453@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7454
7455@smallexample
7456(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7457(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7458The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7459The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7460(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7461$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7462(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7463$7 = 72 '\110'
7464(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7465$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7466(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7467$9 = 200 'H'
7468(@value{GDBP})
7469@end smallexample
7470
7471As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7472string literals you use in expressions:
7473
7474@smallexample
7475(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7476$10 = 78 '+'
7477(@value{GDBP})
7478@end smallexample
7479
7480The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7481character.
7482
7483@node Caching Remote Data
7484@section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7485@cindex caching data of remote targets
7486
7487@value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7488remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7489performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7490bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7491@value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7492registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7493volatile registers are in use.
7494
7495@table @code
7496@kindex set remotecache
7497@item set remotecache on
7498@itemx set remotecache off
7499Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7500caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7501
7502@kindex show remotecache
7503@item show remotecache
7504Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7505
7506@kindex info dcache
7507@item info dcache
7508Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7509information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7510each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7511state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7512the data cache operation.
7513@end table
7514
7515
7516@node Macros
7517@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7518
7519Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7520``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7521@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7522the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7523where it was defined.
7524
7525You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7526with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7527include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7528with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7529
7530A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7531and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7532points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7533no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7534uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7535@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7536see @ref{List}.
7537
7538At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7539token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7540variable-arity macros.
7541
7542Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7543macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7544the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7545
7546@table @code
7547
7548@kindex macro expand
7549@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7550@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7551@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7552@item macro expand @var{expression}
7553@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7554Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7555@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7556not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7557it can be any string of tokens.
7558
7559@kindex macro exp1
7560@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7561@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7562@cindex expand macro once
7563@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7564expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7565@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7566left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7567particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7568expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7569parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7570can be any string of tokens.
7571
7572@kindex info macro
7573@cindex macro definition, showing
7574@cindex definition, showing a macro's
7575@item info macro @var{macro}
7576Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7577source location where that definition was established.
7578
7579@kindex macro define
7580@cindex user-defined macros
7581@cindex defining macros interactively
7582@cindex macros, user-defined
7583@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7584@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7585@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7586preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7587by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7588command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7589second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7590given in @var{arglist}.
7591
7592A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7593evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7594undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7595definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7596well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7597
7598@kindex macro undef
7599@item macro undef @var{macro}
7600@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7601definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7602definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7603above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7604debugged.
7605
7606@kindex macro list
7607@item macro list
7608@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7609defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7610@end table
7611
7612@cindex macros, example of debugging with
7613Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7614show our source files:
7615
7616@smallexample
7617$ cat sample.c
7618#include <stdio.h>
7619#include "sample.h"
7620
7621#define M 42
7622#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7623
7624main ()
7625@{
7626#define N 28
7627 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7628#undef N
7629 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7630#define N 1729
7631 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7632@}
7633$ cat sample.h
7634#define Q <
7635$
7636@end smallexample
7637
7638Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7639We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7640compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7641information.
7642
7643@smallexample
7644$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7645$
7646@end smallexample
7647
7648Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7649
7650@smallexample
7651$ gdb -nw sample
7652GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7653Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7654GDB is free software, @dots{}
7655(@value{GDBP})
7656@end smallexample
7657
7658We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7659program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7660to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7661
7662@smallexample
7663(@value{GDBP}) list main
76643
76654 #define M 42
76665 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
76676
76687 main ()
76698 @{
76709 #define N 28
767110 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
767211 #undef N
767312 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7674(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7675Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7676#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7677(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7678Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7679 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7680#define Q <
7681(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7682expands to: (42 + 1)
7683(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7684expands to: once (M + 1)
7685(@value{GDBP})
7686@end smallexample
7687
7688In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7689the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7690@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7691which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7692
7693Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7694force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7695
7696@smallexample
7697(@value{GDBP}) break main
7698Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7699(@value{GDBP}) run
7700Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7701
7702Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
770310 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7704(@value{GDBP})
7705@end smallexample
7706
7707At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7708
7709@smallexample
7710(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7711Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7712#define N 28
7713(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7714expands to: 28 < 42
7715(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7716$1 = 1
7717(@value{GDBP})
7718@end smallexample
7719
7720As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7721give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7722thereof) in force at each point:
7723
7724@smallexample
7725(@value{GDBP}) next
7726Hello, world!
772712 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7728(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7729The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7730at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7731(@value{GDBP}) next
7732We're so creative.
773314 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7734(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7735Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7736#define N 1729
7737(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7738expands to: 1729 < 42
7739(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7740$2 = 0
7741(@value{GDBP})
7742@end smallexample
7743
7744
7745@node Tracepoints
7746@chapter Tracepoints
7747@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7748@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7749
7750@cindex tracepoints
7751In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7752the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7753anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7754depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7755might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7756fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7757to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7758
7759Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7760specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7761arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7762Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7763those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7764expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7765for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7766a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7767in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7768values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7769unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7770
7771The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7772targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7773how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7774remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7775support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7776packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7777Packets}.
7778
7779This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7780
7781@menu
7782* Set Tracepoints::
7783* Analyze Collected Data::
7784* Tracepoint Variables::
7785@end menu
7786
7787@node Set Tracepoints
7788@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7789
7790Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7791tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7792tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7793breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7794one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7795tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7796work on.
7797
7798For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7799of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7800it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7801local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7802commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7803tracepoint was hit.
7804
7805This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7806conditions and actions.
7807
7808@menu
7809* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7810* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7811* Tracepoint Passcounts::
7812* Tracepoint Actions::
7813* Listing Tracepoints::
7814* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7815@end menu
7816
7817@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7818@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7819
7820@table @code
7821@cindex set tracepoint
7822@kindex trace
7823@item trace
7824The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7825Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7826the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7827defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7828debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7829program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7830doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7831cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7832running.
7833
7834Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7835
7836@smallexample
7837(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7838
7839(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7840
7841(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7842
7843(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7844
7845(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7846@end smallexample
7847
7848@noindent
7849You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7850
7851@vindex $tpnum
7852@cindex last tracepoint number
7853@cindex recent tracepoint number
7854@cindex tracepoint number
7855The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7856of the most recently set tracepoint.
7857
7858@kindex delete tracepoint
7859@cindex tracepoint deletion
7860@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7861Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7862default is to delete all tracepoints.
7863
7864Examples:
7865
7866@smallexample
7867(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7868
7869(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7870@end smallexample
7871
7872@noindent
7873You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7874@end table
7875
7876@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7877@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7878
7879@table @code
7880@kindex disable tracepoint
7881@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7882Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7883@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7884the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7885a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7886
7887@kindex enable tracepoint
7888@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7889Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7890tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7891run.
7892@end table
7893
7894@node Tracepoint Passcounts
7895@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7896
7897@table @code
7898@kindex passcount
7899@cindex tracepoint pass count
7900@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7901Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7902automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7903@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7904the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7905@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7906passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7907given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7908user.
7909
7910Examples:
7911
7912@smallexample
7913(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7914@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7915
7916(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7917@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7918(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7919(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7920(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7921(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7922(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7923(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7924@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7925@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7926@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7927@end smallexample
7928@end table
7929
7930@node Tracepoint Actions
7931@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7932
7933@table @code
7934@kindex actions
7935@cindex tracepoint actions
7936@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7937This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7938tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7939specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7940recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7941@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7942actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7943terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7944far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7945@code{while-stepping}.
7946
7947@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7948To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7949and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7950
7951@smallexample
7952(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7953
7954(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7955
7956(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7957@end smallexample
7958
7959In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7960commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7961hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7962following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7963followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7964@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7965@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7966@code{end} command.
7967
7968@smallexample
7969(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7970(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7971Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7972> collect bar,baz
7973> collect $regs
7974> while-stepping 12
7975 > collect $fp, $sp
7976 > end
7977end
7978@end smallexample
7979
7980@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7981@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7982Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7983This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7984In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7985special arguments are supported:
7986
7987@table @code
7988@item $regs
7989collect all registers
7990
7991@item $args
7992collect all function arguments
7993
7994@item $locals
7995collect all local variables.
7996@end table
7997
7998You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7999with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8000arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8001
8002The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8003particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8004
8005@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8006@item while-stepping @var{n}
8007Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8008new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8009followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8010its own @code{end} command):
8011
8012@smallexample
8013> while-stepping 12
8014 > collect $regs, myglobal
8015 > end
8016>
8017@end smallexample
8018
8019@noindent
8020You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8021@code{stepping}.
8022@end table
8023
8024@node Listing Tracepoints
8025@subsection Listing Tracepoints
8026
8027@table @code
8028@kindex info tracepoints
8029@kindex info tp
8030@cindex information about tracepoints
8031@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8032Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8033a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8034defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8035shown:
8036
8037@itemize @bullet
8038@item
8039its number
8040@item
8041whether it is enabled or disabled
8042@item
8043its address
8044@item
8045its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8046@item
8047its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8048@item
8049where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8050@item
8051its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8052@end itemize
8053
8054@smallexample
8055(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8056Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
80571 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
80582 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
80593 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8060(@value{GDBP})
8061@end smallexample
8062
8063@noindent
8064This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8065@end table
8066
8067@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8068@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8069
8070@table @code
8071@kindex tstart
8072@cindex start a new trace experiment
8073@cindex collected data discarded
8074@item tstart
8075This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8076begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8077the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8078experiment.
8079
8080@kindex tstop
8081@cindex stop a running trace experiment
8082@item tstop
8083This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8084stops collecting data.
8085
8086@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8087automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8088(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8089
8090@kindex tstatus
8091@cindex status of trace data collection
8092@cindex trace experiment, status of
8093@item tstatus
8094This command displays the status of the current trace data
8095collection.
8096@end table
8097
8098Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8099
8100@smallexample
8101(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8102(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8103Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8104> collect $regs,$locals,$args
8105> while-stepping 11
8106 > collect $regs
8107 > end
8108> end
8109(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8110 [time passes @dots{}]
8111(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8112@end smallexample
8113
8114
8115@node Analyze Collected Data
8116@section Using the Collected Data
8117
8118After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8119for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8120collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8121snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8122consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8123examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8124specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8125snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8126registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8127rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8128debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8129(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8130behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8131when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8132the buffer will fail.
8133
8134@menu
8135* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8136* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8137* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8138@end menu
8139
8140@node tfind
8141@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8142
8143@kindex tfind
8144@cindex select trace snapshot
8145@cindex find trace snapshot
8146The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8147@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8148counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8149snapshot is selected.
8150
8151Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8152
8153@table @code
8154@item tfind start
8155Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8156@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8157
8158@item tfind none
8159Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8160
8161@item tfind end
8162Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8163
8164@item tfind
8165No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8166
8167@item tfind -
8168Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8169retracing earlier steps.
8170
8171@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8172Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8173proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8174argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8175for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8176
8177@item tfind pc @var{addr}
8178Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8179program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8180snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8181snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8182
8183@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8184Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8185addresses.
8186
8187@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8188Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8189@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8190
8191@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8192Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8193the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8194that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8195trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8196next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8197@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8198stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8199@end table
8200
8201The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8202designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8203instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8204snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8205trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8206simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8207snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8208@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8209The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8210for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8211no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8212(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8213no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8214tracepoint as the current one.
8215
8216In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8217these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8218scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8219you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8220registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8221
8222@smallexample
8223(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8224(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8225> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8226 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8227> tfind
8228> end
8229
8230Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8231Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8232Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8233Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8234Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8235Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8236Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8237Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8238Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8239Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8240Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8241@end smallexample
8242
8243Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8244the buffer:
8245
8246@smallexample
8247(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8248(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8249> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8250> tfind line
8251> end
8252
8253Frame 0, X = 1
8254Frame 7, X = 2
8255Frame 13, X = 255
8256@end smallexample
8257
8258@node tdump
8259@subsection @code{tdump}
8260@kindex tdump
8261@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8262@cindex tracepoint data, display
8263
8264This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8265the current trace snapshot.
8266
8267@smallexample
8268(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8269(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8270Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8271> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8272> end
8273
8274(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8275
8276(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8277#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8278at gdb_test.c:444
8279444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8280
8281(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8282Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8283d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8284d1 0x18 24
8285d2 0x80 128
8286d3 0x33 51
8287d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8288d5 0x22 34
8289d6 0xe0 224
8290d7 0x380035 3670069
8291a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8292a1 0x3000668 50333288
8293a2 0x100 256
8294a3 0x322000 3284992
8295a4 0x3000698 50333336
8296a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8297fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8298sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8299ps 0x0 0
8300pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8301fpcontrol 0x0 0
8302fpstatus 0x0 0
8303fpiaddr 0x0 0
8304p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8305p1 = (void *) 0x11
8306p2 = (void *) 0x22
8307p3 = (void *) 0x33
8308p4 = (void *) 0x44
8309p5 = (void *) 0x55
8310p6 = (void *) 0x66
8311gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8312
8313(@value{GDBP})
8314@end smallexample
8315
8316@node save-tracepoints
8317@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8318@kindex save-tracepoints
8319@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8320
8321This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8322their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8323suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8324tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8325Files}).
8326
8327@node Tracepoint Variables
8328@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8329@cindex tracepoint variables
8330@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8331
8332@table @code
8333@vindex $trace_frame
8334@item (int) $trace_frame
8335The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8336snapshot is selected.
8337
8338@vindex $tracepoint
8339@item (int) $tracepoint
8340The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8341
8342@vindex $trace_line
8343@item (int) $trace_line
8344The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8345
8346@vindex $trace_file
8347@item (char []) $trace_file
8348The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8349
8350@vindex $trace_func
8351@item (char []) $trace_func
8352The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8353@end table
8354
8355Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8356use @code{output} instead.
8357
8358Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8359stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8360data.
8361
8362@smallexample
8363(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8364
8365(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8366> output $trace_file
8367> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8368> tfind
8369> end
8370@end smallexample
8371
8372@node Overlays
8373@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8374@cindex overlays
8375
8376If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8377memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8378problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8379use overlays.
8380
8381@menu
8382* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8383* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8384* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8385 mapped by asking the inferior.
8386* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8387@end menu
8388
8389@node How Overlays Work
8390@section How Overlays Work
8391@cindex mapped overlays
8392@cindex unmapped overlays
8393@cindex load address, overlay's
8394@cindex mapped address
8395@cindex overlay area
8396
8397Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8398kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8399other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8400management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8401adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8402
8403One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8404independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8405@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8406their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8407instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8408largest overlay as well.
8409
8410Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8411overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8412for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8413there.
8414
8415@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8416@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8417@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8418
8419@smallexample
8420@group
8421 Data Instruction Larger
8422Address Space Address Space Address Space
8423+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8424| | | | | |
8425+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8426| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8427| variables | | program | | +-----------+
8428| and heap | | | | | |
8429+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8430| | +-----------+ | | | load address
8431+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8432 | | | | | |
8433 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8434 address | | | | | |
8435 | overlay | <-' | | |
8436 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8437 | | <---. | | load address
8438 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8439 | | | |
8440 +-----------+ | |
8441 +-----------+
8442 | |
8443 +-----------+
8444
8445 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8446@end group
8447@end smallexample
8448
8449The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8450and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8451its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8452Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8453may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8454data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8455program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8456program and the overlay area.
8457
8458An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8459@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8460instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8461in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8462is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8463the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8464called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8465
8466Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8467program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8468global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8469
8470@itemize @bullet
8471
8472@item
8473Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8474must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8475return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8476overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8477
8478@item
8479If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8480will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8481your program's performance.
8482
8483@item
8484The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8485overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8486mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8487and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8488You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8489addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8490ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8491
8492@item
8493The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8494to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8495instruction and data spaces.
8496
8497@end itemize
8498
8499The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8500improved in many ways:
8501
8502@itemize @bullet
8503
8504@item
8505If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8506hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8507contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8508This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8509area in the usual way.
8510
8511@item
8512If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8513overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8514
8515@item
8516You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8517general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8518code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8519return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8520the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8521must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8522different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8523
8524@end itemize
8525
8526
8527@node Overlay Commands
8528@section Overlay Commands
8529
8530To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8531correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8532virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8533mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8534@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8535variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8536
8537@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8538you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8539
8540@table @code
8541@item overlay off
8542@kindex overlay
8543Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8544disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8545always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8546overlay support is disabled.
8547
8548@item overlay manual
8549@cindex manual overlay debugging
8550Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8551relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8552using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8553commands described below.
8554
8555@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8556@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8557@cindex map an overlay
8558Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8559be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8560overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8561functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8562that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8563@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8564
8565@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8566@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8567@cindex unmap an overlay
8568Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8569must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8570When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8571overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8572
8573@item overlay auto
8574Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8575consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8576to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8577Overlay Debugging}.
8578
8579@item overlay load-target
8580@itemx overlay load
8581@cindex reloading the overlay table
8582Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8583re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8584stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8585overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8586useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8587
8588@item overlay list-overlays
8589@itemx overlay list
8590@cindex listing mapped overlays
8591Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8592addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8593
8594@end table
8595
8596Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8597of the function the address falls in:
8598
8599@smallexample
8600(@value{GDBP}) print main
8601$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8602@end smallexample
8603@noindent
8604When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8605unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8606asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8607unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8608
8609@smallexample
8610(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8611No sections are mapped.
8612(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8613$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8614@end smallexample
8615@noindent
8616When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8617name normally:
8618
8619@smallexample
8620(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8621Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8622 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8623(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8624$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8625@end smallexample
8626
8627When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8628address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8629overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8630@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8631code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8632
8633@itemize @bullet
8634@item
8635@cindex breakpoints in overlays
8636@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8637You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8638@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8639@item
8640@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8641unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8642overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8643you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8644breakpoints properly.
8645@end itemize
8646
8647
8648@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8649@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8650@cindex automatic overlay debugging
8651
8652@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8653are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8654inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8655@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8656looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8657current state of the overlays.
8658
8659Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8660@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8661
8662@table @asis
8663
8664@item @code{_ovly_table}:
8665This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8666
8667@smallexample
8668struct
8669@{
8670 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8671 unsigned long vma;
8672
8673 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8674 unsigned long size;
8675
8676 /* The overlay's load address. */
8677 unsigned long lma;
8678
8679 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8680 zero otherwise. */
8681 unsigned long mapped;
8682@}
8683@end smallexample
8684
8685@item @code{_novlys}:
8686This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8687number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8688
8689@end table
8690
8691To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8692looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8693@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8694executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8695the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8696currently mapped.
8697
8698In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8699@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8700will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8701calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8702will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8703are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8704in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8705overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8706are not being executed.
8707
8708@node Overlay Sample Program
8709@section Overlay Sample Program
8710@cindex overlay example program
8711
8712When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8713at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8714addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8715Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8716since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8717architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8718portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8719
8720However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8721program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8722suite. The program consists of the following files from
8723@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8724
8725@table @file
8726@item overlays.c
8727The main program file.
8728@item ovlymgr.c
8729A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8730@item foo.c
8731@itemx bar.c
8732@itemx baz.c
8733@itemx grbx.c
8734Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8735@item d10v.ld
8736@itemx m32r.ld
8737Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8738and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8739@end table
8740
8741You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8742cross-compiler like this:
8743
8744@smallexample
8745$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8746$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8747$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8748$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8749$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8750$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8751$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8752 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8753@end smallexample
8754
8755The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8756you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8757target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8758
8759
8760@node Languages
8761@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8762@cindex languages
8763
8764Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8765rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8766dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8767Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8768represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8769@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8770
8771@cindex working language
8772Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8773allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8774native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8775consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8776language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8777language}.
8778
8779@menu
8780* Setting:: Switching between source languages
8781* Show:: Displaying the language
8782* Checks:: Type and range checks
8783* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8784* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8785@end menu
8786
8787@node Setting
8788@section Switching Between Source Languages
8789
8790There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8791set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8792@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8793defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8794used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8795are printed, etc.
8796
8797In addition to the working language, every source file that
8798@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8799file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8800source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8801language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8802controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8803show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8804set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8805set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8806Displaying the Language}.
8807
8808This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8809as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8810another language. In that case, make the
8811program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8812@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8813program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8814
8815@menu
8816* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8817* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8818* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8819@end menu
8820
8821@node Filenames
8822@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8823
8824If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8825@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8826
8827@table @file
8828@item .ada
8829@itemx .ads
8830@itemx .adb
8831@itemx .a
8832Ada source file.
8833
8834@item .c
8835C source file
8836
8837@item .C
8838@itemx .cc
8839@itemx .cp
8840@itemx .cpp
8841@itemx .cxx
8842@itemx .c++
8843C@t{++} source file
8844
8845@item .m
8846Objective-C source file
8847
8848@item .f
8849@itemx .F
8850Fortran source file
8851
8852@item .mod
8853Modula-2 source file
8854
8855@item .s
8856@itemx .S
8857Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8858@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8859@end table
8860
8861In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8862extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8863
8864@node Manually
8865@subsection Setting the Working Language
8866
8867If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8868expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8869your program.
8870
8871@kindex set language
8872If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8873command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8874a language, such as
8875@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8876For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8877
8878Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8879language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8880to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8881source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8882languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8883source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8884command such as:
8885
8886@smallexample
8887print a = b + c
8888@end smallexample
8889
8890@noindent
8891might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8892@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8893printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8894@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8895
8896@node Automatically
8897@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8898
8899To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8900@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8901then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8902frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8903working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8904frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8905or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8906does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8907not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8908
8909This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8910entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8911written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8912a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8913case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8914
8915@node Show
8916@section Displaying the Language
8917
8918The following commands help you find out which language is the
8919working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8920
8921@table @code
8922@item show language
8923@kindex show language
8924Display the current working language. This is the
8925language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8926build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8927
8928@item info frame
8929@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8930Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8931working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8932@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8933information listed here.
8934
8935@item info source
8936@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8937Display the source language of this source file.
8938@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8939information listed here.
8940@end table
8941
8942In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8943not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8944with a language explicitly:
8945
8946@table @code
8947@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8948@kindex set extension-language
8949Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8950assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8951
8952@item info extensions
8953@kindex info extensions
8954List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8955@end table
8956
8957@node Checks
8958@section Type and Range Checking
8959
8960@quotation
8961@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8962checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8963section documents the intended facilities.
8964@end quotation
8965@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8966
8967Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8968errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8969checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8970sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8971these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8972by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8973errors when your program is running.
8974
8975@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8976Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8977it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8978evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8979working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8980automatically based on your program's source language.
8981@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8982settings of supported languages.
8983
8984@menu
8985* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8986* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8987@end menu
8988
8989@cindex type checking
8990@cindex checks, type
8991@node Type Checking
8992@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8993
8994Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8995arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8996otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8997errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8998
8999@smallexample
90001 + 2 @result{} 3
9001@exdent but
9002@error{} 1 + 2.3
9003@end smallexample
9004
9005The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9006type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9007
9008For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9009@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9010to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9011or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9012but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9013these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9014also issues a warning.
9015
9016Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9017related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9018For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9019a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9020with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9021the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9022
9023Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9024instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9025operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9026represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9027operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9028details on specific languages.
9029
9030@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9031
9032@kindex set check type
9033@kindex show check type
9034@table @code
9035@item set check type auto
9036Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9037@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9038each language.
9039
9040@item set check type on
9041@itemx set check type off
9042Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9043current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9044match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9045evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9046message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9047
9048@item set check type warn
9049Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9050evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9051be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9052numbers and structures.
9053
9054@item show type
9055Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9056is setting it automatically.
9057@end table
9058
9059@cindex range checking
9060@cindex checks, range
9061@node Range Checking
9062@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9063
9064In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9065bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9066checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9067computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9068not exceed the bounds of the array.
9069
9070For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9071@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9072always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9073warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9074
9075A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9076array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9077of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9078error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9079result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9080the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9081
9082@smallexample
9083@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9084@end smallexample
9085
9086This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9087specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9088Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9089
9090@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9091
9092@kindex set check range
9093@kindex show check range
9094@table @code
9095@item set check range auto
9096Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9097@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9098each language.
9099
9100@item set check range on
9101@itemx set check range off
9102Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9103current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9104match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9105then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9106
9107@item set check range warn
9108Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9109but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9110expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9111memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9112systems).
9113
9114@item show range
9115Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9116being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9117@end table
9118
9119@node Supported Languages
9120@section Supported Languages
9121
9122@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9123assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9124@c This is false ...
9125Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9126language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9127and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9128,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9129language.
9130
9131The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9132supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9133tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9134@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9135formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9136books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9137language reference or tutorial.
9138
9139@menu
9140* C:: C and C@t{++}
9141* Objective-C:: Objective-C
9142* Fortran:: Fortran
9143* Pascal:: Pascal
9144* Modula-2:: Modula-2
9145* Ada:: Ada
9146@end menu
9147
9148@node C
9149@subsection C and C@t{++}
9150
9151@cindex C and C@t{++}
9152@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9153
9154Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9155to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9156together.
9157
9158@cindex C@t{++}
9159@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9160@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9161The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9162compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9163effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9164C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9165compiler (@code{aCC}).
9166
9167For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9168format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9169format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9170command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9171@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9172gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9173
9174@menu
9175* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9176* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9177* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9178* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9179* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9180* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9181* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9182* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9183@end menu
9184
9185@node C Operators
9186@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9187
9188@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9189
9190Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9191@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9192often defined on groups of types.
9193
9194For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9195
9196@itemize @bullet
9197
9198@item
9199@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9200specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9201
9202@item
9203@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9204@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9205
9206@item
9207@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9208
9209@item
9210@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9211
9212@end itemize
9213
9214@noindent
9215The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9216in order of increasing precedence:
9217
9218@table @code
9219@item ,
9220The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9221are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9222expression being the last expression evaluated.
9223
9224@item =
9225Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9226assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9227
9228@item @var{op}=
9229Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9230and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9231@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9232@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9233@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9234
9235@item ?:
9236The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9237of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9238integral type.
9239
9240@item ||
9241Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9242
9243@item &&
9244Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9245
9246@item |
9247Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9248
9249@item ^
9250Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9251
9252@item &
9253Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9254
9255@item ==@r{, }!=
9256Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9257expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9258
9259@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9260Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9261Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9262and non-zero for true.
9263
9264@item <<@r{, }>>
9265left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9266
9267@item @@
9268The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9269
9270@item +@r{, }-
9271Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9272pointer types.
9273
9274@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9275Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9276defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9277integral types.
9278
9279@item ++@r{, }--
9280Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9281operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9282when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9283operation takes place.
9284
9285@item *
9286Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9287@code{++}.
9288
9289@item &
9290Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9291
9292For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9293allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9294to examine the address
9295where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9296stored.
9297
9298@item -
9299Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9300precedence as @code{++}.
9301
9302@item !
9303Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9304@code{++}.
9305
9306@item ~
9307Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9308@code{++}.
9309
9310
9311@item .@r{, }->
9312Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9313@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9314pointer based on the stored type information.
9315Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9316
9317@item .*@r{, }->*
9318Dereferences of pointers to members.
9319
9320@item []
9321Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9322@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9323
9324@item ()
9325Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9326
9327@item ::
9328C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9329and @code{class} types.
9330
9331@item ::
9332Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9333(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9334above.
9335@end table
9336
9337If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9338attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9339predefined meaning.
9340
9341@node C Constants
9342@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9343
9344@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9345
9346@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9347following ways:
9348
9349@itemize @bullet
9350@item
9351Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9352specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9353by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9354@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9355@code{long} value.
9356
9357@item
9358Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9359point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9360exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9361@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9362sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9363A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9364@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9365the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9366a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9367constant.
9368
9369@item
9370Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9371integral equivalents.
9372
9373@item
9374Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9375(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9376(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9377be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9378the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9379of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9380@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9381@samp{\n} for newline.
9382
9383@item
9384String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9385double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9386above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9387a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9388characters.
9389
9390@item
9391Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9392to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9393
9394@item
9395Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9396and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9397integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9398and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9399@end itemize
9400
9401@node C Plus Plus Expressions
9402@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9403
9404@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9405@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9406
9407@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9408@cindex C@t{++} compilers
9409@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9410@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9411@quotation
9412@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9413proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9414works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9415@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9416@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9417stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9418stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9419specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9420are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9421C@t{++} code.
9422@end quotation
9423
9424@enumerate
9425
9426@cindex member functions
9427@item
9428Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9429
9430@smallexample
9431count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9432@end smallexample
9433
9434@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9435@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9436@item
9437While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9438expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9439that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9440pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9441
9442@cindex call overloaded functions
9443@cindex overloaded functions, calling
9444@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9445@item
9446You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9447call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9448perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9449calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9450in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9451default arguments.
9452
9453It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9454promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9455class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9456functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9457number of function arguments.
9458
9459Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9460@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9461,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9462
9463You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9464explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9465@smallexample
9466p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9467@end smallexample
9468
9469The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9470see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9471
9472@cindex reference declarations
9473@item
9474@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9475them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9476dereferenced.
9477
9478In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9479reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9480avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9481The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9482you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9483
9484@item
9485@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9486expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9487one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9488necessary, for example in an expression like
9489@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9490resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9491debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9492@end enumerate
9493
9494In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9495calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9496objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9497invoking user-defined operators.
9498
9499@node C Defaults
9500@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9501
9502@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9503
9504If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9505both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9506C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9507selects the working language.
9508
9509If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9510recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9511@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9512these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9513@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9514for further details.
9515
9516@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9517@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9518@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9519
9520@node C Checks
9521@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9522
9523@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9524
9525By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9526is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9527considers two variables type equivalent if:
9528
9529@itemize @bullet
9530@item
9531The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9532enumerated tag.
9533
9534@item
9535The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9536declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9537
9538@ignore
9539@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9540@c FIXME--beers?
9541@item
9542The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9543declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9544compilers.)
9545@end ignore
9546@end itemize
9547
9548Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9549indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9550that is not itself an array.
9551
9552@node Debugging C
9553@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9554
9555The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9556the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9557inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9558appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9559
9560The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9561with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9562,Expressions}.
9563
9564@node Debugging C Plus Plus
9565@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9566
9567@cindex commands for C@t{++}
9568
9569Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9570designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9571
9572@table @code
9573@cindex break in overloaded functions
9574@item @r{breakpoint menus}
9575When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9576@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9577you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9578
9579@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9580@item rbreak @var{regex}
9581Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9582breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9583classes.
9584@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9585
9586@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9587@item catch throw
9588@itemx catch catch
9589Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9590Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9591
9592@cindex inheritance
9593@item ptype @var{typename}
9594Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9595@var{typename}.
9596@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9597
9598@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9599@item set print demangle
9600@itemx show print demangle
9601@itemx set print asm-demangle
9602@itemx show print asm-demangle
9603Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9604displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9605@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9606
9607@item set print object
9608@itemx show print object
9609Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9610@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9611
9612@item set print vtbl
9613@itemx show print vtbl
9614Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9615@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9616(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9617ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9618
9619@kindex set overload-resolution
9620@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9621@item set overload-resolution on
9622Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9623is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9624and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9625using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9626Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9627If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9628
9629@item set overload-resolution off
9630Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9631overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9632chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9633symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9634overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9635searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9636argument types.
9637
9638@kindex show overload-resolution
9639@item show overload-resolution
9640Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9641
9642@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9643You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9644the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9645@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9646also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9647available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9648@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9649@end table
9650
9651@node Decimal Floating Point
9652@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
9653@cindex decimal floating point format
9654
9655@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
9656decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
9657@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
9658specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
9659
9660There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
9661Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
9662PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
9663target.
9664
9665Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
9666to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
9667(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
9668
9669In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
9670point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
9671underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
9672
9673@node Objective-C
9674@subsection Objective-C
9675
9676@cindex Objective-C
9677This section provides information about some commands and command
9678options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9679@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9680few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9681
9682@menu
9683* Method Names in Commands::
9684* The Print Command with Objective-C::
9685@end menu
9686
9687@node Method Names in Commands
9688@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9689
9690The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9691names as line specifications:
9692
9693@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9694@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9695@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9696@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9697@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9698@itemize
9699@item @code{clear}
9700@item @code{break}
9701@item @code{info line}
9702@item @code{jump}
9703@item @code{list}
9704@end itemize
9705
9706A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9707
9708@smallexample
9709-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9710@end smallexample
9711
9712where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9713plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9714name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9715brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9716source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9717instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9718debugged, enter:
9719
9720@smallexample
9721break -[Fruit create]
9722@end smallexample
9723
9724To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9725enter:
9726
9727@smallexample
9728list +[NSText initialize]
9729@end smallexample
9730
9731In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9732required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9733sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9734is also possible to specify just a method name:
9735
9736@smallexample
9737break create
9738@end smallexample
9739
9740You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9741your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9742you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9743method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9744none apply.
9745
9746As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9747@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9748
9749@smallexample
9750clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9751@end smallexample
9752
9753@node The Print Command with Objective-C
9754@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9755@cindex Objective-C, print objects
9756@kindex print-object
9757@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9758
9759The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9760
9761@smallexample
9762print -[@var{object} hash]
9763@end smallexample
9764
9765@cindex print an Objective-C object description
9766@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9767@noindent
9768will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9769and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9770@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9771the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9772with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9773function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9774
9775@node Fortran
9776@subsection Fortran
9777@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9778
9779@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9780currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9781
9782@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9783Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9784among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9785functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9786will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9787underscore.
9788
9789@menu
9790* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9791* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9792* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9793@end menu
9794
9795@node Fortran Operators
9796@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9797
9798@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9799
9800Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9801@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9802arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9803
9804@table @code
9805@item **
9806The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9807of the second one.
9808
9809@item :
9810The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9811represent a section of array.
9812@end table
9813
9814@node Fortran Defaults
9815@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9816
9817@cindex Fortran Defaults
9818
9819Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9820default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9821change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9822@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9823
9824@node Special Fortran Commands
9825@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9826
9827@cindex Special Fortran commands
9828
9829@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9830such as displaying common blocks.
9831
9832@table @code
9833@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9834@kindex info common
9835@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9836This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9837block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9838all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9839printed.
9840@end table
9841
9842@node Pascal
9843@subsection Pascal
9844
9845@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9846Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9847nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9848entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9849syntax.
9850
9851The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9852controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9853@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9854
9855@node Modula-2
9856@subsection Modula-2
9857
9858@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9859
9860The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9861output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9862developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9863attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9864to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9865table.
9866
9867@cindex expressions in Modula-2
9868@menu
9869* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9870* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9871* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9872* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9873* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9874* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9875* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9876* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9877* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9878@end menu
9879
9880@node M2 Operators
9881@subsubsection Operators
9882@cindex Modula-2 operators
9883
9884Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9885@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9886often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9887following definitions hold:
9888
9889@itemize @bullet
9890
9891@item
9892@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9893their subranges.
9894
9895@item
9896@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9897
9898@item
9899@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9900
9901@item
9902@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9903@var{type}}.
9904
9905@item
9906@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9907
9908@item
9909@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9910
9911@item
9912@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9913@end itemize
9914
9915@noindent
9916The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9917increasing precedence:
9918
9919@table @code
9920@item ,
9921Function argument or array index separator.
9922
9923@item :=
9924Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9925@var{value}.
9926
9927@item <@r{, }>
9928Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9929types.
9930
9931@item <=@r{, }>=
9932Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9933on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9934set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9935
9936@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9937Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9938Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9939available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9940comment character.
9941
9942@item IN
9943Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9944Same precedence as @code{<}.
9945
9946@item OR
9947Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9948
9949@item AND@r{, }&
9950Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9951
9952@item @@
9953The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9954
9955@item +@r{, }-
9956Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9957and difference on set types.
9958
9959@item *
9960Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9961on set types.
9962
9963@item /
9964Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9965types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9966
9967@item DIV@r{, }MOD
9968Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9969precedence as @code{*}.
9970
9971@item -
9972Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9973
9974@item ^
9975Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9976
9977@item NOT
9978Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9979@code{^}.
9980
9981@item .
9982@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9983precedence as @code{^}.
9984
9985@item []
9986Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9987
9988@item ()
9989Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9990as @code{^}.
9991
9992@item ::@r{, }.
9993@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9994@end table
9995
9996@quotation
9997@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9998treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9999@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10000@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10001@end quotation
10002
10003
10004@node Built-In Func/Proc
10005@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10006@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10007
10008Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10009In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10010
10011@table @var
10012
10013@item a
10014represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10015
10016@item c
10017represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10018
10019@item i
10020represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10021
10022@item m
10023represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10024same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10025be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10026
10027@item n
10028represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10029
10030@item r
10031represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10032
10033@item t
10034represents a type.
10035
10036@item v
10037represents a variable.
10038
10039@item x
10040represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10041explanation of the function for details.
10042@end table
10043
10044All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10045
10046@table @code
10047@item ABS(@var{n})
10048Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10049
10050@item CAP(@var{c})
10051If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10052equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10053
10054@item CHR(@var{i})
10055Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10056
10057@item DEC(@var{v})
10058Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10059
10060@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10061Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10062new value.
10063
10064@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10065Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10066set.
10067
10068@item FLOAT(@var{i})
10069Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10070
10071@item HIGH(@var{a})
10072Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10073
10074@item INC(@var{v})
10075Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10076
10077@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10078Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10079new value.
10080
10081@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10082Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10083there. Returns the new set.
10084
10085@item MAX(@var{t})
10086Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10087
10088@item MIN(@var{t})
10089Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10090
10091@item ODD(@var{i})
10092Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10093
10094@item ORD(@var{x})
10095Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10096value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10097@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10098integral, character and enumerated types.
10099
10100@item SIZE(@var{x})
10101Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10102
10103@item TRUNC(@var{r})
10104Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10105
10106@item TSIZE(@var{x})
10107Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10108
10109@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10110Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10111@end table
10112
10113@quotation
10114@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10115@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10116an error.
10117@end quotation
10118
10119@cindex Modula-2 constants
10120@node M2 Constants
10121@subsubsection Constants
10122
10123@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10124ways:
10125
10126@itemize @bullet
10127
10128@item
10129Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10130expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10131rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10132trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10133
10134@item
10135Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10136decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10137then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10138@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10139digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10140digits.
10141
10142@item
10143Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10144like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10145also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10146followed by a @samp{C}.
10147
10148@item
10149String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10150pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10151Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10152Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10153sequences.
10154
10155@item
10156Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10157
10158@item
10159Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10160@code{FALSE}.
10161
10162@item
10163Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10164
10165@item
10166Set constants are not yet supported.
10167@end itemize
10168
10169@node M2 Types
10170@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10171@cindex Modula-2 types
10172
10173Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10174syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10175types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10176print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10177This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10178sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10179
10180The first example contains the following section of code:
10181
10182@smallexample
10183VAR
10184 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10185 r: [20..40] ;
10186@end smallexample
10187
10188@noindent
10189and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10190@code{r} and @code{s}.
10191
10192@smallexample
10193(@value{GDBP}) print s
10194@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10195(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10196SET OF CHAR
10197(@value{GDBP}) print r
1019821
10199(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10200[20..40]
10201@end smallexample
10202
10203@noindent
10204Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10205
10206@smallexample
10207VAR
10208 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10209@end smallexample
10210
10211@noindent
10212then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10213
10214@smallexample
10215(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10216type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10217@end smallexample
10218
10219@noindent
10220Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10221expressions using the debugger.
10222
10223The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10224and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10225
10226@smallexample
10227VAR
10228 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10229@end smallexample
10230
10231@smallexample
10232(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10233ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10234@end smallexample
10235
10236Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10237is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10238arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10239above.
10240
10241Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10242
10243@smallexample
10244TYPE
10245 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10246 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10247VAR
10248 s: t ;
10249BEGIN
10250 s := blue ;
10251@end smallexample
10252
10253@noindent
10254The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10255and value of a variable.
10256
10257@smallexample
10258(@value{GDBP}) print s
10259$1 = blue
10260(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10261type = [blue..yellow]
10262@end smallexample
10263
10264@noindent
10265In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10266displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10267their @code{C} counterparts.
10268
10269@smallexample
10270VAR
10271 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10272BEGIN
10273 s[1] := 1 ;
10274@end smallexample
10275
10276@smallexample
10277(@value{GDBP}) print s
10278$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10279(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10280type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10281@end smallexample
10282
10283The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10284pointer types as shown in this example:
10285
10286@smallexample
10287VAR
10288 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10289BEGIN
10290 NEW(s) ;
10291 s^[1] := 1 ;
10292@end smallexample
10293
10294@noindent
10295and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10296
10297@smallexample
10298(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10299type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10300@end smallexample
10301
10302@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10303Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10304types:
10305
10306@smallexample
10307TYPE
10308 foo = RECORD
10309 f1: CARDINAL ;
10310 f2: CHAR ;
10311 f3: myarray ;
10312 END ;
10313
10314 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10315 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10316VAR
10317 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10318@end smallexample
10319
10320@noindent
10321and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10322below.
10323
10324@smallexample
10325(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10326type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10327 f1 : CARDINAL;
10328 f2 : CHAR;
10329 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10330END
10331@end smallexample
10332
10333@node M2 Defaults
10334@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10335@cindex Modula-2 defaults
10336
10337If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10338both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10339Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10340selected the working language.
10341
10342If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10343code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10344working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10345Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10346
10347@node Deviations
10348@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10349@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10350
10351A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10352This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10353
10354@itemize @bullet
10355@item
10356Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10357integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10358debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10359pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10360through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10361returned a pointer.)
10362
10363@item
10364C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10365non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10366escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10367printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10368
10369@item
10370The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10371argument.
10372
10373@item
10374All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10375@end itemize
10376
10377@node M2 Checks
10378@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10379@cindex Modula-2 checks
10380
10381@quotation
10382@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10383range checking.
10384@end quotation
10385@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10386
10387@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10388
10389@itemize @bullet
10390@item
10391They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10392@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10393
10394@item
10395They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10396@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10397@end itemize
10398
10399As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10400whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10401
10402Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10403index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10404
10405@node M2 Scope
10406@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10407@cindex scope
10408@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10409@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10410@ifinfo
10411@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10412@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10413@end ifinfo
10414@iftex
10415@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10416@end iftex
10417
10418There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10419(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10420similar syntax:
10421
10422@smallexample
10423
10424@var{module} . @var{id}
10425@var{scope} :: @var{id}
10426@end smallexample
10427
10428@noindent
10429where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10430@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10431identifier within your program, except another module.
10432
10433Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10434specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10435found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10436enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10437
10438Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10439the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10440definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10441an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10442module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10443@var{module}.
10444
10445@node GDB/M2
10446@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10447
10448Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10449Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10450specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10451@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10452apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10453analogue in Modula-2.
10454
10455The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10456with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10457intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10458created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10459address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10460@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10461
10462@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10463In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10464interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10465
10466@node Ada
10467@subsection Ada
10468@cindex Ada
10469
10470The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10471output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10472Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10473attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10474to be difficult.
10475
10476
10477@cindex expressions in Ada
10478@menu
10479* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10480 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10481 in @value{GDBN}.
10482* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10483* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10484* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10485* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10486@end menu
10487
10488@node Ada Mode Intro
10489@subsubsection Introduction
10490@cindex Ada mode, general
10491
10492The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10493syntax, with some extensions.
10494The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10495
10496@itemize @bullet
10497@item
10498That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10499arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10500leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10501program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10502
10503@item
10504That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10505are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10506
10507@item
10508That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10509@end itemize
10510
10511Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10512implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10513packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10514their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10515@value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10516
10517The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10518As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10519was translated from an Ada source file.
10520
10521While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10522mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10523(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10524middle (to allow based literals).
10525
10526The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10527the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10528actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10529the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10530procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10531functions to procedures elsewhere.
10532
10533@node Omissions from Ada
10534@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10535@cindex Ada, omissions from
10536
10537Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10538
10539@itemize @bullet
10540@item
10541Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10542
10543@itemize @minus
10544@item
10545@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10546 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10547
10548@item
10549@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10550
10551@item
10552@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10553
10554@item
10555@t{'Tag}.
10556
10557@item
10558@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10559operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10560
10561@item
10562@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10563@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10564
10565@item
10566@t{'Address}.
10567@end itemize
10568
10569@item
10570The names in
10571@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10572concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10573not currently available.
10574
10575@item
10576Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10577equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10578for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10579They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10580types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10581(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10582zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10583indeterminate values.
10584
10585@item
10586The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10587@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10588are not implemented.
10589
10590@item
10591@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10592@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10593@cindex aggregates (Ada)
10594There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10595permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10596
10597@smallexample
10598set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10599set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10600set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10601set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10602set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10603set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10604@end smallexample
10605
10606Changing a
10607discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10608undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10609However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10610them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10611aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10612declared to have a type such as:
10613
10614@smallexample
10615type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10616 Id : Integer;
10617 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10618end record;
10619@end smallexample
10620
10621you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10622assignments:
10623
10624@smallexample
10625set A_Rec.Len := 4
10626set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10627@end smallexample
10628
10629As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10630rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10631components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10632component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10633original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10634indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10635redundant component associations, although which component values are
10636assigned in such cases is not defined.
10637
10638@item
10639Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10640
10641@item
10642The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10643than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10644which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10645looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10646function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10647the proper resolution.
10648
10649@item
10650The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10651
10652@item
10653Entry calls are not implemented.
10654
10655@item
10656Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10657formats are not supported.
10658
10659@item
10660It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10661@end itemize
10662
10663@node Additions to Ada
10664@subsubsection Additions to Ada
10665@cindex Ada, deviations from
10666
10667As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10668extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10669
10670@itemize @bullet
10671@item
10672If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10673a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10674then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10675@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10676Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10677in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10678Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10679which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10680
10681@item
10682@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10683appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10684you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10685
10686@item
10687The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10688@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10689
10690@item
10691A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10692(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10693@end itemize
10694
10695In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10696additions specific to Ada:
10697
10698@itemize @bullet
10699@item
10700The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10701its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10702
10703@smallexample
10704set x := y + 3
10705print A(tmp := y + 1)
10706@end smallexample
10707
10708@item
10709The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10710the value of its right-hand operand.
10711This allows, for example,
10712complex conditional breaks:
10713
10714@smallexample
10715break f
10716condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10717@end smallexample
10718
10719@item
10720Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10721characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10722which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10723@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10724(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10725sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10726in strings. For example,
10727@smallexample
10728 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10729@end smallexample
10730@noindent
10731contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10732after each period.
10733
10734@item
10735The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10736@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10737to write
10738
10739@smallexample
10740print 'max(x, y)
10741@end smallexample
10742
10743@item
10744When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10745array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10746For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10747of 3 might print as
10748
10749@smallexample
10750(3 => 10, 17, 1)
10751@end smallexample
10752
10753@noindent
10754That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10755clause.
10756
10757@item
10758You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10759multi-character subsequence of
10760their names (an exact match gets preference).
10761For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10762in place of @t{a'length}.
10763
10764@item
10765@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10766Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10767to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10768some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10769For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10770enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10771For example,
10772@smallexample
10773@value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10774@end smallexample
10775
10776@item
10777Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10778access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10779specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10780selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10781object.
10782
10783@end itemize
10784
10785@node Stopping Before Main Program
10786@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10787
10788@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10789It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10790before reaching the main procedure.
10791As defined in the Ada Reference
10792Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10793@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10794elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10795@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10796
10797@node Ada Glitches
10798@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10799@cindex Ada, problems
10800
10801Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10802we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10803@value{GDBN},
10804some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10805and the GNU Ada compiler.
10806
10807@itemize @bullet
10808@item
10809Currently, the debugger
10810has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10811pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10812Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10813to get it printed properly.
10814
10815@item
10816Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10817storage are invisible to the debugger.
10818
10819@item
10820Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10821argument lists are treated as positional).
10822
10823@item
10824Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10825
10826@item
10827Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10828floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10829the host machine.
10830
10831@item
10832The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10833
10834@item
10835The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10836the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10837this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10838look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10839symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10840defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10841local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10842GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10843you can usually resolve the confusion
10844by qualifying the problematic names with package
10845@code{Standard} explicitly.
10846@end itemize
10847
10848@node Unsupported Languages
10849@section Unsupported Languages
10850
10851@cindex unsupported languages
10852@cindex minimal language
10853In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10854@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10855It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10856of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10857This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10858an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10859
10860If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10861select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10862language.
10863
10864@node Symbols
10865@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10866
10867The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10868symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10869program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10870does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10871program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10872(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10873file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10874
10875@cindex symbol names
10876@cindex names of symbols
10877@cindex quoting names
10878Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10879characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10880most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10881source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10882are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10883ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10884@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10885@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10886
10887@smallexample
10888p 'foo.c'::x
10889@end smallexample
10890
10891@noindent
10892looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10893
10894@table @code
10895@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10896@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10897@kindex set case-sensitive
10898@item set case-sensitive on
10899@itemx set case-sensitive off
10900@itemx set case-sensitive auto
10901Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10902with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10903Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10904case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10905case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10906you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10907suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10908matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10909case-insensitive matches.
10910
10911@kindex show case-sensitive
10912@item show case-sensitive
10913This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10914lookups.
10915
10916@kindex info address
10917@cindex address of a symbol
10918@item info address @var{symbol}
10919Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10920variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10921local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10922is always stored.
10923
10924Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10925at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10926the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10927
10928@kindex info symbol
10929@cindex symbol from address
10930@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10931@item info symbol @var{addr}
10932Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10933If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10934nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10935
10936@smallexample
10937(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10938_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10939@end smallexample
10940
10941@noindent
10942This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10943it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10944
10945@kindex whatis
10946@item whatis [@var{arg}]
10947Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10948a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10949last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10950not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10951assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10952@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10953for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10954@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10955@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10956@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10957
10958@kindex ptype
10959@item ptype [@var{arg}]
10960@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10961detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10962@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10963
10964For example, for this variable declaration:
10965
10966@smallexample
10967struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10968@end smallexample
10969
10970@noindent
10971the two commands give this output:
10972
10973@smallexample
10974@group
10975(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10976type = struct complex
10977(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10978type = struct complex @{
10979 double real;
10980 double imag;
10981@}
10982@end group
10983@end smallexample
10984
10985@noindent
10986As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10987the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10988
10989@cindex incomplete type
10990Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10991of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10992program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10993the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10994given these declarations:
10995
10996@smallexample
10997 struct foo;
10998 struct foo *fooptr;
10999@end smallexample
11000
11001@noindent
11002but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11003
11004@smallexample
11005 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11006 $1 = <incomplete type>
11007@end smallexample
11008
11009@noindent
11010``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
11011completely specified.
11012
11013@kindex info types
11014@item info types @var{regexp}
11015@itemx info types
11016Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
11017expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
11018no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
11019complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
11020types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
11021@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
11022name is @code{value}.
11023
11024This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
11025@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
11026lists all source files where a type is defined.
11027
11028@kindex info scope
11029@cindex local variables
11030@item info scope @var{location}
11031List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
11032accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
11033an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
11034to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
11035details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
11036
11037@smallexample
11038(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
11039Scope for command_line_handler:
11040Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
11041Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
11042Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
11043Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
11044Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
11045Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
11046Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
11047@end smallexample
11048
11049@noindent
11050This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
11051during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
11052collect}.
11053
11054@kindex info source
11055@item info source
11056Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
11057the function containing the current point of execution:
11058@itemize @bullet
11059@item
11060the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
11061@item
11062the directory it was compiled in,
11063@item
11064its length, in lines,
11065@item
11066which programming language it is written in,
11067@item
11068whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
11069if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
11070@item
11071whether the debugging information includes information about
11072preprocessor macros.
11073@end itemize
11074
11075
11076@kindex info sources
11077@item info sources
11078Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
11079debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
11080have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
11081
11082@kindex info functions
11083@item info functions
11084Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
11085
11086@item info functions @var{regexp}
11087Print the names and data types of all defined functions
11088whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
11089Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
11090include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
11091start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
11092that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
11093@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
11094
11095@kindex info variables
11096@item info variables
11097Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
11098outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
11099
11100@item info variables @var{regexp}
11101Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
11102variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
11103@var{regexp}.
11104
11105@kindex info classes
11106@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
11107@item info classes
11108@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
11109Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
11110(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11111expression.
11112
11113@kindex info selectors
11114@item info selectors
11115@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
11116Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
11117(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
11118expression.
11119
11120@ignore
11121This was never implemented.
11122@kindex info methods
11123@item info methods
11124@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
11125The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
11126methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
11127specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
11128C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
11129from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
11130@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
11131which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
11132@end ignore
11133
11134@cindex reloading symbols
11135Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
11136be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
11137in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
11138running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
11139@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
11140
11141@table @code
11142@kindex set symbol-reloading
11143@item set symbol-reloading on
11144Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
11145object file with a particular name is seen again.
11146
11147@item set symbol-reloading off
11148Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
11149same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
11150running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
11151should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
11152may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
11153several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
11154name.
11155
11156@kindex show symbol-reloading
11157@item show symbol-reloading
11158Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
11159@end table
11160
11161@cindex opaque data types
11162@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
11163@item set opaque-type-resolution on
11164Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
11165declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
11166@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
11167source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
11168another source file. The default is on.
11169
11170A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
11171the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
11172
11173@item set opaque-type-resolution off
11174Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
11175is printed as follows:
11176@smallexample
11177@{<no data fields>@}
11178@end smallexample
11179
11180@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
11181@item show opaque-type-resolution
11182Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
11183
11184@kindex maint print symbols
11185@cindex symbol dump
11186@kindex maint print psymbols
11187@cindex partial symbol dump
11188@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
11189@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
11190@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
11191Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
11192These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
11193symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
11194symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
11195collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
11196only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
11197command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
11198use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
11199symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
11200files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
11201@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11202required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11203@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11204@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11205
11206@kindex maint info symtabs
11207@kindex maint info psymtabs
11208@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11209@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11210@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11211@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11212@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11213@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11214
11215List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11216structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11217given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11218copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11219structure in more detail. For example:
11220
11221@smallexample
11222(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11223@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11224 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11225 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11226 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11227 readin no
11228 fullname (null)
11229 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11230 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11231 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11232 dependencies (none)
11233 @}
11234@}
11235(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11236(@value{GDBP})
11237@end smallexample
11238@noindent
11239We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11240the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11241and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11242If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11243read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11244
11245@smallexample
11246(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11247Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11248line 1574.
11249(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11250@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11251 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11252 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11253 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11254 dirname (null)
11255 fullname (null)
11256 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11257 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
11258 debugformat DWARF 2
11259 @}
11260@}
11261(@value{GDBP})
11262@end smallexample
11263@end table
11264
11265
11266@node Altering
11267@chapter Altering Execution
11268
11269Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11270find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11271correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11272experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11273program.
11274
11275For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11276locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11277address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11278
11279@menu
11280* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11281* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11282* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11283* Returning:: Returning from a function
11284* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11285* Patching:: Patching your program
11286@end menu
11287
11288@node Assignment
11289@section Assignment to Variables
11290
11291@cindex assignment
11292@cindex setting variables
11293To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11294@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11295
11296@smallexample
11297print x=4
11298@end smallexample
11299
11300@noindent
11301stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11302value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11303@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11304information on operators in supported languages.
11305
11306@kindex set variable
11307@cindex variables, setting
11308If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11309@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11310really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11311not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11312,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11313
11314If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11315appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11316variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11317to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11318program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11319a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11320command @code{set width}:
11321
11322@smallexample
11323(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11324type = double
11325(@value{GDBP}) p width
11326$4 = 13
11327(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11328Invalid syntax in expression.
11329@end smallexample
11330
11331@noindent
11332The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11333order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11334
11335@smallexample
11336(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11337@end smallexample
11338
11339Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11340with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11341@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11342your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11343to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11344the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11345
11346@smallexample
11347@group
11348(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11349type = double
11350(@value{GDBP}) p g
11351$1 = 1
11352(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11353(@value{GDBP}) p g
11354$2 = 1
11355(@value{GDBP}) r
11356The program being debugged has been started already.
11357Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11358Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11359"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11360 Invalid bfd target.
11361(@value{GDBP}) show g
11362The current BFD target is "=4".
11363@end group
11364@end smallexample
11365
11366@noindent
11367The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11368@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11369@code{g}, use
11370
11371@smallexample
11372(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11373@end smallexample
11374
11375@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11376freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11377and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11378same length or shorter.
11379@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11380@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11381
11382To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11383construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11384(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11385to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11386and representation in memory), and
11387
11388@smallexample
11389set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11390@end smallexample
11391
11392@noindent
11393stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11394
11395@node Jumping
11396@section Continuing at a Different Address
11397
11398Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11399it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11400an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11401
11402@table @code
11403@kindex jump
11404@item jump @var{linespec}
11405@itemx jump @var{location}
11406Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
11407@var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
11408breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
11409different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
11410practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
11411@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
11412
11413The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11414the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11415register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11416a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11417be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11418of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11419confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11420executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11421well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11422@end table
11423
11424@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11425On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11426command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11427difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11428changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11429example,
11430
11431@smallexample
11432set $pc = 0x485
11433@end smallexample
11434
11435@noindent
11436makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11437address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11438@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11439
11440The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11441up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11442that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11443detail.
11444
11445@c @group
11446@node Signaling
11447@section Giving your Program a Signal
11448@cindex deliver a signal to a program
11449
11450@table @code
11451@kindex signal
11452@item signal @var{signal}
11453Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11454signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11455signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11456SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11457
11458Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11459giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11460a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11461@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11462signal.
11463
11464@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11465after executing the command.
11466@end table
11467@c @end group
11468
11469Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11470@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11471causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11472the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11473passes the signal directly to your program.
11474
11475
11476@node Returning
11477@section Returning from a Function
11478
11479@table @code
11480@cindex returning from a function
11481@kindex return
11482@item return
11483@itemx return @var{expression}
11484You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11485command. If you give an
11486@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11487value.
11488@end table
11489
11490When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11491(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11492discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11493be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11494
11495This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11496Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11497innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11498specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11499of functions.
11500
11501The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11502program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11503returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11504and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11505selected stack frame returns naturally.
11506
11507@node Calling
11508@section Calling Program Functions
11509
11510@table @code
11511@cindex calling functions
11512@cindex inferior functions, calling
11513@item print @var{expr}
11514Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11515@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11516debugged.
11517
11518@kindex call
11519@item call @var{expr}
11520Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11521returned values.
11522
11523You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11524execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11525(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11526with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11527print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11528value history.
11529@end table
11530
11531It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11532@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11533the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11534in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11535
11536@table @code
11537@item set unwindonsignal
11538@kindex set unwindonsignal
11539@cindex unwind stack in called functions
11540@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11541Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11542that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11543@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11544the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11545default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11546received.
11547
11548@item show unwindonsignal
11549@kindex show unwindonsignal
11550Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11551@value{GDBN}.
11552@end table
11553
11554@cindex weak alias functions
11555Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11556for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11557the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11558which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11559As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11560even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11561function instead.
11562
11563@node Patching
11564@section Patching Programs
11565
11566@cindex patching binaries
11567@cindex writing into executables
11568@cindex writing into corefiles
11569
11570By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11571executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11572alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11573patching your program's binary.
11574
11575If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11576explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11577want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11578repairs.
11579
11580@table @code
11581@kindex set write
11582@item set write on
11583@itemx set write off
11584If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11585core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11586off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11587
11588If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11589@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11590write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11591
11592@item show write
11593@kindex show write
11594Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11595as well as reading.
11596@end table
11597
11598@node GDB Files
11599@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11600
11601@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11602both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11603program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11604@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11605
11606@menu
11607* Files:: Commands to specify files
11608* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11609* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11610@end menu
11611
11612@node Files
11613@section Commands to Specify Files
11614
11615@cindex symbol table
11616@cindex core dump file
11617
11618You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11619way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11620@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11621Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11622
11623Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11624@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11625specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11626via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11627Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11628new files are useful.
11629
11630@table @code
11631@cindex executable file
11632@kindex file
11633@item file @var{filename}
11634Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11635symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11636executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11637directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11638@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11639directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11640to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11641and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11642
11643@cindex unlinked object files
11644@cindex patching object files
11645You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11646the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11647file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11648if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11649@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11650that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11651case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11652the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11653
11654@item file
11655@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11656has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11657
11658@kindex exec-file
11659@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11660Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11661in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11662if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11663discard information on the executable file.
11664
11665@kindex symbol-file
11666@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11667Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11668searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11669table and program to run from the same file.
11670
11671@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11672program's symbol table.
11673
11674The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11675some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11676contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11677which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11678@value{GDBN}.
11679
11680@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11681executing it once.
11682
11683When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11684understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11685generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11686other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11687Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11688using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11689optimized code.
11690
11691For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11692using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11693symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11694quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11695details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11696
11697The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11698start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11699occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11700file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11701pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11702Warnings and Messages}.)
11703
11704We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11705symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11706symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11707still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11708in stabs format.
11709
11710@kindex readnow
11711@cindex reading symbols immediately
11712@cindex symbols, reading immediately
11713@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11714@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11715You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11716tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11717load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11718entire symbol table available.
11719
11720@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11721@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11722@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11723@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11724@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11725@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11726@c files.
11727
11728@kindex core-file
11729@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11730@itemx core
11731Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11732of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11733address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11734executable file itself for other parts.
11735
11736@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11737to be used.
11738
11739Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11740under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11741wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11742the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11743(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11744
11745@kindex add-symbol-file
11746@cindex dynamic linking
11747@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11748@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11749@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11750The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11751information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11752when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11753into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11754address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11755this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11756of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11757section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11758@var{address} as an expression.
11759
11760The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11761originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11762@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11763thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11764instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11765
11766@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11767@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11768@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11769@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11770@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11771Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11772executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11773relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11774information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11775
11776@itemize @bullet
11777@item
11778the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11779that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11780@item
11781every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11782been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11783@item
11784you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11785provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11786@end itemize
11787
11788@noindent
11789Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11790relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11791typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11792important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11793procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11794assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11795general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11796relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11797as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11798way.
11799
11800@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11801
11802@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11803@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11804@cindex load symbols from memory
11805@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11806Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11807object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11808For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11809process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11810some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11811evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11812For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11813@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11814
11815@kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11816@kindex assf
11817@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11818@itemx assf @var{library-file}
11819The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11820in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11821alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11822@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11823@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11824@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11825library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11826@code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11827
11828@kindex section
11829@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11830The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11831@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11832exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11833@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11834itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11835@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11836their addresses.
11837
11838@kindex info files
11839@kindex info target
11840@item info files
11841@itemx info target
11842@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11843current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11844including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11845use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11846command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11847current ones.
11848
11849@kindex maint info sections
11850@item maint info sections
11851Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11852is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11853displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11854offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11855@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11856may be arbitrarily combined):
11857
11858@table @code
11859@item ALLOBJ
11860Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11861@item @var{sections}
11862Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11863@item @var{section-flags}
11864Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11865The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11866@table @code
11867@item ALLOC
11868Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11869Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11870@item LOAD
11871Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11872Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11873@item RELOC
11874Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11875@item READONLY
11876Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11877@item CODE
11878Section contains executable code only.
11879@item DATA
11880Section contains data only (no executable code).
11881@item ROM
11882Section will reside in ROM.
11883@item CONSTRUCTOR
11884Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11885@item HAS_CONTENTS
11886Section is not empty.
11887@item NEVER_LOAD
11888An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11889@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11890A notification to the linker that the section contains
11891COFF shared library information.
11892@item IS_COMMON
11893Section contains common symbols.
11894@end table
11895@end table
11896@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11897@cindex read-only sections
11898@item set trust-readonly-sections on
11899Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11900really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11901In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11902out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11903For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11904enhancement to debugging performance.
11905
11906The default is off.
11907
11908@item set trust-readonly-sections off
11909Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11910the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11911and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11912
11913@item show trust-readonly-sections
11914Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11915@end table
11916
11917All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11918as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11919name and remembers it that way.
11920
11921@cindex shared libraries
11922@anchor{Shared Libraries}
11923@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11924and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11925
11926On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
11927shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
11928
11929@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11930when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11931(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11932references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11933debugging a core file).
11934
11935On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11936automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11937
11938@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11939@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11940@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11941
11942There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11943symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11944particularly large or there are many of them.
11945
11946To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11947commands:
11948
11949@table @code
11950@kindex set auto-solib-add
11951@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11952If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11953will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11954attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11955informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11956is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11957@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11958
11959@cindex memory used for symbol tables
11960If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11961takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11962memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11963symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11964auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11965library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11966@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11967the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11968
11969@kindex show auto-solib-add
11970@item show auto-solib-add
11971Display the current autoloading mode.
11972@end table
11973
11974@cindex load shared library
11975To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11976command:
11977
11978@table @code
11979@kindex info sharedlibrary
11980@kindex info share
11981@item info share
11982@itemx info sharedlibrary
11983Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11984
11985@kindex sharedlibrary
11986@kindex share
11987@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11988@itemx share @var{regex}
11989Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11990Unix regular expression.
11991As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11992required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11993@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11994loaded.
11995
11996@item nosharedlibrary
11997@kindex nosharedlibrary
11998@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11999Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
12000that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
12001libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
12002discarded.
12003@end table
12004
12005Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
12006when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
12007stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
12008
12009@table @code
12010@item set stop-on-solib-events
12011@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
12012This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
12013when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
12014The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
12015shared library.
12016
12017@item show stop-on-solib-events
12018@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
12019Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
12020library events happen.
12021@end table
12022
12023Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
12024configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
12025host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
12026copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
12027not.
12028
12029@cindex where to look for shared libraries
12030For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
12031libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
12032may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
12033to specify the search directories for target libraries.
12034
12035@table @code
12036@cindex prefix for shared library file names
12037@cindex system root, alternate
12038@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
12039@kindex set sysroot
12040@item set sysroot @var{path}
12041Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
12042absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
12043runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
12044target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
12045libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
12046the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
12047under @var{path}.
12048
12049The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
12050sysroot}.
12051
12052@cindex default system root
12053@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
12054You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
12055@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
12056@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
12057@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
12058automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
12059location.
12060
12061@kindex show sysroot
12062@item show sysroot
12063Display the current shared library prefix.
12064
12065@kindex set solib-search-path
12066@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
12067If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
12068directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
12069is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
12070path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
12071use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
12072@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
12073finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
12074it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
12075of shared library symbols.
12076
12077@kindex show solib-search-path
12078@item show solib-search-path
12079Display the current shared library search path.
12080@end table
12081
12082
12083@node Separate Debug Files
12084@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
12085@cindex separate debugging information files
12086@cindex debugging information in separate files
12087@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
12088@cindex debugging information directory, global
12089@cindex global debugging information directory
12090@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
12091@cindex @file{.build-id} directory
12092
12093@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
12094file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
12095@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
12096Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
12097than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
12098information for their executables in separate files, which users can
12099install only when they need to debug a problem.
12100
12101@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
12102file:
12103
12104@itemize @bullet
12105@item
12106The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
12107the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
12108usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
12109name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
12110(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
12111debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
12112@value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
12113came from the same build.
12114
12115@item
12116The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
12117also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
12118only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
12119for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
12120this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
12121command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
12122The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
12123explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
12124below.
12125@end itemize
12126
12127Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
12128uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
12129
12130@itemize @bullet
12131@item
12132For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
12133the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
12134directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
12135directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
12136directories of the executable's absolute file name.
12137
12138@item
12139For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
12140@file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
12141named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
12142first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
12143are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
12144hex characters, not 10.)
12145@end itemize
12146
12147So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
12148@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
12149file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
12150@code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
12151@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
12152debug information files, in the indicated order:
12153
12154@itemize @minus
12155@item
12156@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
12157@item
12158@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
12159@item
12160@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
12161@item
12162@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
12163@end itemize
12164
12165You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
12166name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
12167
12168@table @code
12169
12170@kindex set debug-file-directory
12171@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
12172Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12173information files to @var{directory}.
12174
12175@kindex show debug-file-directory
12176@item show debug-file-directory
12177Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
12178information files.
12179
12180@end table
12181
12182@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
12183@cindex debug link sections
12184A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
12185@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
12186
12187@itemize
12188@item
12189A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
12190a zero byte,
12191@item
12192zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
12193boundary within the section, and
12194@item
12195a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
12196executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
12197information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
12198zero as the @var{crc} argument.
12199@end itemize
12200
12201Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
12202contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
12203described above.
12204
12205@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
12206@cindex build ID sections
12207The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
12208ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
12209often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
12210It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
12211the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
12212algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
12213content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
12214value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
12215stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
12216
12217The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
12218executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
12219debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
12220should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
12221but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
12222in an ordinary executable.
12223
12224The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
12225@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
12226the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
12227following commands:
12228
12229@smallexample
12230@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
12231@kbd{strip -g foo}
12232@end smallexample
12233
12234@noindent
12235These commands remove the debugging
12236information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
12237@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
12238two files:
12239
12240@itemize @bullet
12241@item
12242The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
12243behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
12244
12245@smallexample
12246@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
12247@end smallexample
12248
12249Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
12250a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
12251foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
12252the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
12253
12254@item
12255Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
12256the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
12257compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
12258utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
12259@end itemize
12260
12261@noindent
12262
12263Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
12264link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
12265simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
12266sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
12267
12268@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
12269@smallexample
12270unsigned long
12271gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
12272 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
12273@{
12274 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
12275 @{
12276 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
12277 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12278 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12279 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12280 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12281 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12282 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12283 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12284 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12285 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12286 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12287 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12288 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12289 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12290 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12291 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12292 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12293 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12294 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12295 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12296 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12297 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12298 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12299 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12300 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12301 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12302 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12303 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12304 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12305 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12306 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12307 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12308 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12309 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12310 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12311 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12312 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12313 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12314 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12315 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12316 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12317 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12318 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12319 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12320 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12321 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12322 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12323 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12324 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12325 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12326 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12327 0x2d02ef8d
12328 @};
12329 unsigned char *end;
12330
12331 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12332 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12333 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12334 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12335@}
12336@end smallexample
12337
12338@noindent
12339This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
12340
12341
12342@node Symbol Errors
12343@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12344
12345While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12346such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12347output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12348they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12349debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12350about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12351only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12352times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12353to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12354complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12355Messages}).
12356
12357The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12358
12359@table @code
12360@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12361
12362The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12363(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12364error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12365in its outer scope blocks.
12366
12367@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12368the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12369may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12370function.
12371
12372@item block at @var{address} out of order
12373
12374The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12375order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12376do so.
12377
12378@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12379locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12380can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12381@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12382Messages}.)
12383
12384@item bad block start address patched
12385
12386The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12387smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12388to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12389
12390@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12391starting on the previous source line.
12392
12393@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12394
12395@cindex foo
12396Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12397larger than the size of the string table.
12398
12399@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12400name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12401with this name.
12402
12403@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12404
12405The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12406not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12407uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12408
12409@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12410This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12411are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12412debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12413on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12414and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12415
12416@item stub type has NULL name
12417
12418@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12419
12420@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12421The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12422information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12423it.
12424
12425@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12426
12427@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12428
12429@end table
12430
12431@node Targets
12432@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12433
12434@cindex debugging target
12435A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12436
12437Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12438in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12439you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12440flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12441host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12442realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12443command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12444(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12445
12446@cindex target architecture
12447It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12448architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12449one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12450command.
12451
12452@table @code
12453@kindex set architecture
12454@kindex show architecture
12455@item set architecture @var{arch}
12456This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12457value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12458supported architectures.
12459
12460@item show architecture
12461Show the current target architecture.
12462
12463@item set processor
12464@itemx processor
12465@kindex set processor
12466@kindex show processor
12467These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12468and @code{show architecture}.
12469@end table
12470
12471@menu
12472* Active Targets:: Active targets
12473* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12474* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12475@end menu
12476
12477@node Active Targets
12478@section Active Targets
12479
12480@cindex stacking targets
12481@cindex active targets
12482@cindex multiple targets
12483
12484There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12485executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12486active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12487start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12488a core file.
12489
12490For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12491@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12492well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12493@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12494first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12495requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12496are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12497read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12498executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12499
12500When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12501target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12502commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12503an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12504process target is active.
12505
12506Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12507core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12508Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12509the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12510Process}).
12511
12512@node Target Commands
12513@section Commands for Managing Targets
12514
12515@table @code
12516@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12517Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12518process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12519facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12520protocol of the target machine.
12521
12522Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12523typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12524with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12525
12526The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12527after executing the command.
12528
12529@kindex help target
12530@item help target
12531Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12532currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12533(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12534
12535@item help target @var{name}
12536Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12537select it.
12538
12539@kindex set gnutarget
12540@item set gnutarget @var{args}
12541@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12542knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12543a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12544with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12545with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12546
12547@quotation
12548@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12549you must know the actual BFD name.
12550@end quotation
12551
12552@noindent
12553@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12554
12555@kindex show gnutarget
12556@item show gnutarget
12557Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12558@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12559@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12560and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12561@end table
12562
12563@cindex common targets
12564Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12565configuration):
12566
12567@table @code
12568@kindex target
12569@item target exec @var{program}
12570@cindex executable file target
12571An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12572@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12573
12574@item target core @var{filename}
12575@cindex core dump file target
12576A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12577@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12578
12579@item target remote @var{medium}
12580@cindex remote target
12581A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12582connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12583protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12584
12585For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12586machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12587
12588@smallexample
12589target remote /dev/ttya
12590@end smallexample
12591
12592@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12593useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12594system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12595clobbered by the download.
12596
12597@item target sim
12598@cindex built-in simulator target
12599Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12600In general,
12601@smallexample
12602 target sim
12603 load
12604 run
12605@end smallexample
12606@noindent
12607works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12608drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12609provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12610see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12611Processors}.
12612
12613@end table
12614
12615Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12616
12617@table @code
12618
12619@item target nrom @var{dev}
12620@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12621NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12622
12623@end table
12624
12625Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12626your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12627
12628Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12629you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12630various aspects of this process.
12631
12632@table @code
12633
12634@item set hash
12635@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12636@cindex hash mark while downloading
12637This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12638downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12639displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12640monitor.
12641
12642@item show hash
12643@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12644Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12645
12646@item set debug monitor
12647@kindex set debug monitor
12648@cindex display remote monitor communications
12649Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12650@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12651
12652@item show debug monitor
12653@kindex show debug monitor
12654Show the current status of displaying communications between
12655@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12656@end table
12657
12658@table @code
12659
12660@kindex load @var{filename}
12661@item load @var{filename}
12662Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12663@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12664is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12665on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12666@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12667the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12668
12669If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12670execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12671target is @dots{}}''
12672
12673The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12674For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12675link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12676specifies a fixed address.
12677@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12678
12679Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12680load programs into flash memory.
12681
12682@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12683@end table
12684
12685@node Byte Order
12686@section Choosing Target Byte Order
12687
12688@cindex choosing target byte order
12689@cindex target byte order
12690
12691Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12692offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12693orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12694designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12695which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12696@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12697
12698@table @code
12699@kindex set endian
12700@item set endian big
12701Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12702
12703@item set endian little
12704Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12705
12706@item set endian auto
12707Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12708executable.
12709
12710@item show endian
12711Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12712
12713@end table
12714
12715Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12716data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12717target system.
12718
12719
12720@node Remote Debugging
12721@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12722@cindex remote debugging
12723
12724If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12725@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12726For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12727or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12728powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12729
12730Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12731to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12732@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12733but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12734write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12735communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12736
12737Other remote targets may be available in your
12738configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12739
12740@menu
12741* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12742* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
12743* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12744* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12745* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12746@end menu
12747
12748@node Connecting
12749@section Connecting to a Remote Target
12750
12751On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12752your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12753Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12754program as the first argument.
12755
12756@cindex @code{target remote}
12757@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12758over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12759each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12760program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12761@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12762Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12763
12764@table @code
12765
12766@item target remote @var{serial-device}
12767@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12768Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12769to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12770
12771@smallexample
12772target remote /dev/ttyb
12773@end smallexample
12774
12775If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12776@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12777(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12778@code{target} command.
12779
12780@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12781@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12782@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12783Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12784The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12785address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12786the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12787it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12788target.
12789
12790For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12791@code{manyfarms}:
12792
12793@smallexample
12794target remote manyfarms:2828
12795@end smallexample
12796
12797If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12798debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12799same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12800port 1234 on your local machine:
12801
12802@smallexample
12803target remote :1234
12804@end smallexample
12805@noindent
12806
12807Note that the colon is still required here.
12808
12809@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12810@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12811Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12812connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12813
12814@smallexample
12815target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12816@end smallexample
12817
12818When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12819keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12820can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12821cause havoc with your debugging session.
12822
12823@item target remote | @var{command}
12824@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12825Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12826pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12827by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12828protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12829standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12830that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12831using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12832
12833If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12834@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12835program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12836
12837@end table
12838
12839Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12840commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12841remote program.
12842
12843@cindex interrupting remote programs
12844@cindex remote programs, interrupting
12845Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12846interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12847program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12848and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12849interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12850
12851@smallexample
12852Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12853Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12854@end smallexample
12855
12856If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12857(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12858remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12859goes back to waiting.
12860
12861@table @code
12862@kindex detach (remote)
12863@item detach
12864When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12865@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12866Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12867will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12868command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12869
12870@kindex disconnect
12871@item disconnect
12872The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12873the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12874(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12875the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12876another target.
12877
12878@cindex send command to remote monitor
12879@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12880@cindex add new commands for external monitor
12881@kindex monitor
12882@item monitor @var{cmd}
12883This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12884remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12885sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12886can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12887and implement.
12888@end table
12889
12890@node File Transfer
12891@section Sending files to a remote system
12892@cindex remote target, file transfer
12893@cindex file transfer
12894@cindex sending files to remote systems
12895
12896Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
12897connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
12898for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
12899running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
12900e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
12901the only way to upload or download files.
12902
12903Not all remote targets support these commands.
12904
12905@table @code
12906@kindex remote put
12907@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
12908Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
12909@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
12910
12911@kindex remote get
12912@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
12913Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
12914on the host system.
12915
12916@kindex remote delete
12917@item remote delete @var{targetfile}
12918Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
12919
12920@end table
12921
12922@node Server
12923@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12924
12925@kindex gdbserver
12926@cindex remote connection without stubs
12927@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12928allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12929@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12930
12931@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12932because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12933that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12934@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12935@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12936because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12937also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12938started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12939Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12940the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12941do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12942by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12943choice for debugging.
12944
12945@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12946or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12947protocol.
12948
12949@table @emph
12950@item On the target machine,
12951you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12952@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12953strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12954system does all the symbol handling.
12955
12956To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12957the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12958syntax is:
12959
12960@smallexample
12961target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12962@end smallexample
12963
12964@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12965hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12966@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12967@file{/dev/com1}:
12968
12969@smallexample
12970target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12971@end smallexample
12972
12973@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12974with it.
12975
12976To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12977
12978@smallexample
12979target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12980@end smallexample
12981
12982The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12983specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12984TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12985expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12986(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12987you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12988TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12989reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12990conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12991and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12992@code{target remote} command.
12993
12994On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12995This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12996
12997@smallexample
12998target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12999@end smallexample
13000
13001@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
13002to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
13003
13004@pindex pidof
13005@cindex attach to a program by name
13006You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
13007@code{pidof} utility:
13008
13009@smallexample
13010target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
13011@end smallexample
13012
13013In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
13014has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
13015@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
13016
13017@item On the host machine,
13018first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
13019your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
13020@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
13021was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
13022
13023The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
13024and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
13025system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
13026are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
13027during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
13028files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
13029programs.
13030
13031Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13032For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
13033the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
13034text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
13035@samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
13036command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
13037already on the target.
13038
13039@end table
13040
13041@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
13042@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
13043
13044During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
13045@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
13046Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
13047debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
13048
13049@table @code
13050@item monitor help
13051List the available monitor commands.
13052
13053@item monitor set debug 0
13054@itemx monitor set debug 1
13055Disable or enable general debugging messages.
13056
13057@item monitor set remote-debug 0
13058@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
13059Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
13060protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
13061
13062@end table
13063
13064@node Remote Configuration
13065@section Remote Configuration
13066
13067@kindex set remote
13068@kindex show remote
13069This section documents the configuration options available when
13070debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
13071extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
13072system-call-allowed}.
13073
13074@table @code
13075@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
13076@cindex address size for remote targets
13077@cindex bits in remote address
13078Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
13079number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
13080that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
13081default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
13082
13083@item show remoteaddresssize
13084Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
13085
13086@item set remotebaud @var{n}
13087@cindex baud rate for remote targets
13088Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
13089value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
13090remote targets.
13091
13092@item show remotebaud
13093Show the current speed of the remote connection.
13094
13095@item set remotebreak
13096@cindex interrupt remote programs
13097@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
13098@anchor{set remotebreak}
13099If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
13100when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
13101on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
13102character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
13103expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
13104
13105@item show remotebreak
13106Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
13107interrupt the remote program.
13108
13109@item set remoteflow on
13110@itemx set remoteflow off
13111@kindex set remoteflow
13112Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
13113on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
13114
13115@item show remoteflow
13116@kindex show remoteflow
13117Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
13118
13119@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
13120Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
13121communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
13122@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
13123@code{ascii}.
13124
13125@item show remotelogbase
13126Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
13127protocol.
13128
13129@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
13130@cindex record serial communications on file
13131Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
13132default is not to record at all.
13133
13134@item show remotelogfile.
13135Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
13136serial communications.
13137
13138@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
13139@cindex timeout for serial communications
13140@cindex remote timeout
13141Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
13142@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
13143
13144@item show remotetimeout
13145Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
13146responses.
13147
13148@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
13149@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
13150@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
13151@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
13152@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
13153@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
13154Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
13155watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
13156@end table
13157
13158@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
13159The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
13160your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
13161can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
13162packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
13163packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
13164or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
13165all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
13166see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
13167
13168During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
13169If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
13170in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
13171@value{GDBN} developers.
13172
13173For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
13174packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
13175are:
13176
13177@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
13178@item Command Name
13179@tab Remote Packet
13180@tab Related Features
13181
13182@item @code{fetch-register}
13183@tab @code{p}
13184@tab @code{info registers}
13185
13186@item @code{set-register}
13187@tab @code{P}
13188@tab @code{set}
13189
13190@item @code{binary-download}
13191@tab @code{X}
13192@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
13193
13194@item @code{read-aux-vector}
13195@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
13196@tab @code{info auxv}
13197
13198@item @code{symbol-lookup}
13199@tab @code{qSymbol}
13200@tab Detecting multiple threads
13201
13202@item @code{verbose-resume}
13203@tab @code{vCont}
13204@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
13205
13206@item @code{software-breakpoint}
13207@tab @code{Z0}
13208@tab @code{break}
13209
13210@item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
13211@tab @code{Z1}
13212@tab @code{hbreak}
13213
13214@item @code{write-watchpoint}
13215@tab @code{Z2}
13216@tab @code{watch}
13217
13218@item @code{read-watchpoint}
13219@tab @code{Z3}
13220@tab @code{rwatch}
13221
13222@item @code{access-watchpoint}
13223@tab @code{Z4}
13224@tab @code{awatch}
13225
13226@item @code{target-features}
13227@tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
13228@tab @code{set architecture}
13229
13230@item @code{library-info}
13231@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
13232@tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
13233
13234@item @code{memory-map}
13235@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
13236@tab @code{info mem}
13237
13238@item @code{read-spu-object}
13239@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
13240@tab @code{info spu}
13241
13242@item @code{write-spu-object}
13243@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
13244@tab @code{info spu}
13245
13246@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
13247@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
13248@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
13249
13250@item @code{supported-packets}
13251@tab @code{qSupported}
13252@tab Remote communications parameters
13253
13254@item @code{pass-signals}
13255@tab @code{QPassSignals}
13256@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
13257
13258@item @code{hostio-close-packet}
13259@tab @code{vFile:close}
13260@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13261
13262@item @code{hostio-open-packet}
13263@tab @code{vFile:open}
13264@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13265
13266@item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
13267@tab @code{vFile:pread}
13268@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13269
13270@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
13271@tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
13272@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
13273
13274@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
13275@tab @code{vFile:unlink}
13276@tab @code{remote delete}
13277@end multitable
13278
13279@node Remote Stub
13280@section Implementing a Remote Stub
13281
13282@cindex debugging stub, example
13283@cindex remote stub, example
13284@cindex stub example, remote debugging
13285The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
13286communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
13287@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
13288these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
13289implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
13290with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
13291organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
13292
13293@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
13294To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
13295@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
13296prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
13297program, you need:
13298
13299@enumerate
13300@item
13301A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
13302have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
13303your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
13304
13305@item
13306A C subroutine library to support your program's
13307subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
13308
13309@item
13310A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
13311download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
13312manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
13313documentation.
13314@end enumerate
13315
13316The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
13317communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
13318machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
13319
13320@table @emph
13321@item On the host,
13322@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
13323else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
13324(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13325
13326@item On the target,
13327you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
13328implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
13329subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
13330
13331On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
13332@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
13333@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
13334@end table
13335
13336The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
13337machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
13338@sc{sparc} boards.
13339
13340@cindex remote serial stub list
13341These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
13342
13343@table @code
13344
13345@item i386-stub.c
13346@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
13347@cindex Intel
13348@cindex i386
13349For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
13350
13351@item m68k-stub.c
13352@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
13353@cindex Motorola 680x0
13354@cindex m680x0
13355For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
13356
13357@item sh-stub.c
13358@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
13359@cindex Renesas
13360@cindex SH
13361For Renesas SH architectures.
13362
13363@item sparc-stub.c
13364@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13365@cindex Sparc
13366For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13367
13368@item sparcl-stub.c
13369@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13370@cindex Fujitsu
13371@cindex SparcLite
13372For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13373
13374@end table
13375
13376The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13377recently added stubs.
13378
13379@menu
13380* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13381* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13382* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13383@end menu
13384
13385@node Stub Contents
13386@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13387
13388@cindex remote serial stub
13389The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13390subroutines:
13391
13392@table @code
13393@item set_debug_traps
13394@findex set_debug_traps
13395@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13396This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13397program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13398beginning of your program.
13399
13400@item handle_exception
13401@findex handle_exception
13402@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13403This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13404explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13405run when a trap is triggered.
13406
13407@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13408execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13409with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13410protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13411representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13412information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13413retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13414execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13415@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13416machine.
13417
13418@item breakpoint
13419@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13420Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13421breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13422way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13423machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13424pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13425@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13426simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13427again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13428your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13429@value{GDBN} session gets control.
13430
13431Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13432to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13433start of your debugging session.
13434@end table
13435
13436@node Bootstrapping
13437@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13438
13439@cindex remote stub, support routines
13440The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13441chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13442debugging target machine.
13443
13444First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13445serial port.
13446
13447@table @code
13448@item int getDebugChar()
13449@findex getDebugChar
13450Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13451It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13452different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13453
13454@item void putDebugChar(int)
13455@findex putDebugChar
13456Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13457It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13458different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13459@end table
13460
13461@cindex control C, and remote debugging
13462@cindex interrupting remote targets
13463If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13464running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13465for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13466character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13467remote system to stop.
13468
13469Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13470probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13471is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13472@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13473
13474Other routines you need to supply are:
13475
13476@table @code
13477@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13478@findex exceptionHandler
13479Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13480handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13481way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13482are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13483containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13484@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13485its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13486might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13487exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13488@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13489and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13490you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13491should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13492
13493For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13494gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13495should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13496@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13497help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13498
13499@item void flush_i_cache()
13500@findex flush_i_cache
13501On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13502instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13503instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13504
13505On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13506function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13507@end table
13508
13509@noindent
13510You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13511
13512@table @code
13513@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13514@findex memset
13515This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13516memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13517@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13518either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13519@end table
13520
13521If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13522library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13523but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13524subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13525
13526
13527@node Debug Session
13528@subsection Putting it All Together
13529
13530@cindex remote serial debugging summary
13531In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13532steps.
13533
13534@enumerate
13535@item
13536Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13537(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13538@display
13539@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13540@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13541@end display
13542
13543@item
13544Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13545
13546@smallexample
13547set_debug_traps();
13548breakpoint();
13549@end smallexample
13550
13551@item
13552For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13553@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13554
13555@smallexample
13556void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13557@end smallexample
13558
13559@noindent
13560but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13561function in your program, that function is called when
13562@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13563error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13564one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13565
13566@item
13567Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13568your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13569
13570@item
13571Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13572the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13573
13574@item
13575@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13576@c document that. FIXME.
13577Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13578whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13579
13580@item
13581Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13582(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13583
13584@end enumerate
13585
13586@node Configurations
13587@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13588
13589While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13590cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13591describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13592
13593There are three major categories of configurations: native
13594configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13595operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13596different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13597are quite different from each other.
13598
13599@menu
13600* Native::
13601* Embedded OS::
13602* Embedded Processors::
13603* Architectures::
13604@end menu
13605
13606@node Native
13607@section Native
13608
13609This section describes details specific to particular native
13610configurations.
13611
13612@menu
13613* HP-UX:: HP-UX
13614* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13615* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13616* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13617* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13618* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13619* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13620@end menu
13621
13622@node HP-UX
13623@subsection HP-UX
13624
13625On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13626begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13627name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13628
13629
13630@node BSD libkvm Interface
13631@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13632
13633@cindex libkvm
13634@cindex kernel memory image
13635@cindex kernel crash dump
13636
13637BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13638interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13639memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13640uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13641dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13642special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13643the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13644@code{kvm} target:
13645
13646@smallexample
13647(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13648@end smallexample
13649
13650For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13651argument:
13652
13653@smallexample
13654(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13655@end smallexample
13656
13657Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13658available:
13659
13660@table @code
13661@kindex kvm
13662@item kvm pcb
13663Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13664
13665@item kvm proc
13666Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13667modern FreeBSD systems.
13668@end table
13669
13670@node SVR4 Process Information
13671@subsection SVR4 Process Information
13672@cindex /proc
13673@cindex examine process image
13674@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13675
13676Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13677@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13678process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13679for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13680proc} is available to report information about the process running
13681your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13682proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13683This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13684Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13685
13686@table @code
13687@kindex info proc
13688@cindex process ID
13689@item info proc
13690@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13691Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13692process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13693that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13694debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13695line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13696executable file's absolute file name.
13697
13698On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13699@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13700within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13701a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13702needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13703a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13704
13705@item info proc mappings
13706@cindex memory address space mappings
13707Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13708information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13709rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13710includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13711memory access rights to that range.
13712
13713@item info proc stat
13714@itemx info proc status
13715@cindex process detailed status information
13716These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13717the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13718how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13719the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13720consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13721value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13722(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13723
13724@item info proc all
13725Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13726above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13727
13728@ignore
13729@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13730@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13731@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13732@kindex info proc times
13733@item info proc times
13734Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13735its children.
13736
13737@kindex info proc id
13738@item info proc id
13739Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13740the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13741@end ignore
13742
13743@item set procfs-trace
13744@kindex set procfs-trace
13745@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13746This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13747
13748@item show procfs-trace
13749@kindex show procfs-trace
13750Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13751
13752@item set procfs-file @var{file}
13753@kindex set procfs-file
13754Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13755@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13756contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13757standard output.
13758
13759@item show procfs-file
13760@kindex show procfs-file
13761Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13762
13763@item proc-trace-entry
13764@itemx proc-trace-exit
13765@itemx proc-untrace-entry
13766@itemx proc-untrace-exit
13767@kindex proc-trace-entry
13768@kindex proc-trace-exit
13769@kindex proc-untrace-entry
13770@kindex proc-untrace-exit
13771These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13772from the @code{syscall} interface.
13773
13774@item info pidlist
13775@kindex info pidlist
13776@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13777For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13778processes and all the threads within each process.
13779
13780@item info meminfo
13781@kindex info meminfo
13782@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13783For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13784@end table
13785
13786@node DJGPP Native
13787@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13788@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13789@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13790@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13791
13792@cindex DPMI
13793@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13794MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13795that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13796top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13797
13798@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13799defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13800subsection describes those commands.
13801
13802@table @code
13803@kindex info dos
13804@item info dos
13805This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13806information about the target system and important OS structures.
13807
13808@kindex sysinfo
13809@cindex MS-DOS system info
13810@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13811@item info dos sysinfo
13812This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13813platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13814DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13815
13816@cindex GDT
13817@cindex LDT
13818@cindex IDT
13819@cindex segment descriptor tables
13820@cindex descriptor tables display
13821@item info dos gdt
13822@itemx info dos ldt
13823@itemx info dos idt
13824These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13825and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13826tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13827that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13828descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13829descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13830rights.
13831
13832A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13833segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13834allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13835conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13836additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13837
13838@cindex garbled pointers
13839These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13840Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13841displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13842display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13843example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13844debugged program's data segment:
13845
13846@smallexample
13847@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13848@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13849@end smallexample
13850
13851@noindent
13852This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13853the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13854
13855@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13856@item info dos pde
13857@itemx info dos pte
13858These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13859Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13860data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13861into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13862page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13863may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13864Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13865that is currently in use.
13866
13867Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13868Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13869the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13870@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13871Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13872means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13873the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13874
13875@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13876These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13877Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13878controller.
13879
13880These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13881
13882@cindex physical address from linear address
13883@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13884This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13885address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13886already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13887because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13888segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13889the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13890
13891@smallexample
13892@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13893@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13894@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13895@end smallexample
13896
13897@noindent
13898This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13899whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13900attributes of that page.
13901
13902Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13903since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13904address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13905be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13906declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13907@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13908
13909Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13910transfer buffer:
13911
13912@smallexample
13913@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13914@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13915@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13916@end smallexample
13917
13918@noindent
13919(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
139203rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13921clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13922memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13923linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13924
13925This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13926@end table
13927
13928@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13929In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13930debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13931to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13932
13933@table @code
13934@kindex set com1base
13935@kindex set com1irq
13936@kindex set com2base
13937@kindex set com2irq
13938@kindex set com3base
13939@kindex set com3irq
13940@kindex set com4base
13941@kindex set com4irq
13942@item set com1base @var{addr}
13943This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13944port.
13945
13946@item set com1irq @var{irq}
13947This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13948for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13949
13950There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13951etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13952other 3 COM ports.
13953
13954@kindex show com1base
13955@kindex show com1irq
13956@kindex show com2base
13957@kindex show com2irq
13958@kindex show com3base
13959@kindex show com3irq
13960@kindex show com4base
13961@kindex show com4irq
13962The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13963display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13964lines used by the COM ports.
13965
13966@item info serial
13967@kindex info serial
13968@cindex DOS serial port status
13969This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13970port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13971IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13972counts of various errors encountered so far.
13973@end table
13974
13975
13976@node Cygwin Native
13977@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13978@cindex MS Windows debugging
13979@cindex native Cygwin debugging
13980@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13981
13982@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13983DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13984additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13985Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13986@ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13987
13988@table @code
13989@kindex info w32
13990@item info w32
13991This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13992information about the target system and important OS structures.
13993
13994@item info w32 selector
13995This command displays information returned by
13996the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13997It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13998a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13999Without argument, this command displays information
14000about the six segment registers.
14001
14002@kindex info dll
14003@item info dll
14004This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
14005
14006@kindex dll-symbols
14007@item dll-symbols
14008This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
14009add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
14010
14011@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
14012@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
14013@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
14014@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
14015If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
14016happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
14017@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
14018exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
14019``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
14020Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
14021@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
14022
14023@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
14024@item show cygwin-exceptions
14025Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
14026inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
14027
14028@kindex set new-console
14029@item set new-console @var{mode}
14030If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
14031be started in a new console on next start.
14032If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
14033be started in the same console as the debugger.
14034
14035@kindex show new-console
14036@item show new-console
14037Displays whether a new console is used
14038when the debuggee is started.
14039
14040@kindex set new-group
14041@item set new-group @var{mode}
14042This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
14043start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
14044This affects the way the Windows OS handles
14045@samp{Ctrl-C}.
14046
14047@kindex show new-group
14048@item show new-group
14049Displays current value of new-group boolean.
14050
14051@kindex set debugevents
14052@item set debugevents
14053This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
14054to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
14055signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
14056unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
14057Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
14058
14059@kindex set debugexec
14060@item set debugexec
14061This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
14062(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
14063
14064@kindex set debugexceptions
14065@item set debugexceptions
14066This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
14067debuggee seen by the debugger.
14068
14069@kindex set debugmemory
14070@item set debugmemory
14071This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
14072and writes by the debugger.
14073
14074@kindex set shell
14075@item set shell
14076This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
14077via a shell or directly (default value is on).
14078
14079@kindex show shell
14080@item show shell
14081Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
14082
14083@end table
14084
14085@menu
14086* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
14087@end menu
14088
14089@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
14090@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
14091@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
14092@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
14093
14094Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
14095not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
14096@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
14097symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
14098information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
14099describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
14100``minimal symbols''.
14101
14102Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
14103will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
14104start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
14105program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
14106@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
14107see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
14108@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
14109explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
14110cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
14111which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
14112
14113@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
14114
14115In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
14116tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
14117DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
14118also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
14119sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
14120(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
14121necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
14122contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
14123exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
14124
14125Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
14126though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
14127symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
14128some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
14129@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
14130(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
14131
14132@smallexample
14133(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
14134All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
14135
14136Non-debugging symbols:
141370x77e885f4 CreateFileA
141380x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
14139@end smallexample
14140
14141@smallexample
14142(@value{GDBP}) info function !
14143All functions matching regular expression "!":
14144
14145Non-debugging symbols:
141460x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
141470x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
141480x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
14149[etc...]
14150@end smallexample
14151
14152@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
14153
14154Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
14155type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
14156refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
14157contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
14158contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
14159means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
14160a function within a DLL without a running program.
14161
14162Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
14163automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
14164variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
14165type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
14166problem:
14167
14168@smallexample
14169(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
14170$1 = 268572168
14171@end smallexample
14172
14173@smallexample
14174(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
141750x10021610: "\230y\""
14176@end smallexample
14177
14178And two possible solutions:
14179
14180@smallexample
14181(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
14182$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14183@end smallexample
14184
14185@smallexample
14186(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
141870x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
14188(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
141890x10021608: 0x0022fd98
14190(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
141910x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
14192@end smallexample
14193
14194Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
14195starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
14196examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
14197function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
14198to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
14199
14200@smallexample
14201(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
14202Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
14203@end smallexample
14204
14205The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
14206break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
14207safe.
14208
14209@node Hurd Native
14210@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
14211@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
14212
14213This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
14214@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
14215
14216@table @code
14217@item set signals
14218@itemx set sigs
14219@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
14220@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14221This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
14222@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
14223affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
14224@code{signals}.
14225
14226@item show signals
14227@itemx show sigs
14228@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
14229@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
14230Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
14231
14232@item set signal-thread
14233@itemx set sigthread
14234@kindex set signal-thread
14235@kindex set sigthread
14236This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
14237thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
14238process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
14239signal-thread}.
14240
14241@item show signal-thread
14242@itemx show sigthread
14243@kindex show signal-thread
14244@kindex show sigthread
14245These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
14246delivered a signal.
14247
14248@item set stopped
14249@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14250This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
14251as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
14252continued by delivering a signal to it.
14253
14254@item show stopped
14255@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
14256This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
14257stopped.
14258
14259@item set exceptions
14260@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14261Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
14262When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
14263single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
14264trapping on.
14265
14266@item show exceptions
14267@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
14268Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
14269
14270@item set task pause
14271@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
14272@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14273@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14274This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
14275Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
14276whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
14277effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
14278to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
14279thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
14280
14281@item show task pause
14282@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
14283Show the current state of task suspension.
14284
14285@item set task detach-suspend-count
14286@cindex task suspend count
14287@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14288This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
14289@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
14290
14291@item show task detach-suspend-count
14292Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
14293
14294@item set task exception-port
14295@itemx set task excp
14296@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14297This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
14298forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
14299rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
14300
14301@item set noninvasive
14302@cindex noninvasive task options
14303This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
14304invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
14305is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
14306@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
14307
14308@item info send-rights
14309@itemx info receive-rights
14310@itemx info port-rights
14311@itemx info port-sets
14312@itemx info dead-names
14313@itemx info ports
14314@itemx info psets
14315@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14316@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14317@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14318@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14319@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14320These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
14321receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
14322There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
14323port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
14324
14325@item set thread pause
14326@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
14327@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14328@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
14329This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
14330control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
14331thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
14332off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
14333Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
14334control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
14335task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
14336only the current thread.
14337
14338@item show thread pause
14339@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
14340This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
14341
14342@item set thread run
14343This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14344
14345@item show thread run
14346Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
14347
14348@item set thread detach-suspend-count
14349@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14350@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14351This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
14352thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
14353found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
14354takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
14355
14356@item show thread detach-suspend-count
14357Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
14358detaching.
14359
14360@item set thread exception-port
14361@itemx set thread excp
14362Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
14363overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
14364@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14365
14366@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14367Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14368value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14369changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14370
14371@item set thread default
14372@itemx show thread default
14373@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14374Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14375default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14376thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14377variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14378threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14379the non-default commands.
14380@end table
14381
14382
14383@node Neutrino
14384@subsection QNX Neutrino
14385@cindex QNX Neutrino
14386
14387@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14388Neutrino target:
14389
14390@table @code
14391@item set debug nto-debug
14392@kindex set debug nto-debug
14393When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14394Neutrino support.
14395
14396@item show debug nto-debug
14397@kindex show debug nto-debug
14398Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14399@end table
14400
14401
14402@node Embedded OS
14403@section Embedded Operating Systems
14404
14405This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14406embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14407architectures.
14408
14409@menu
14410* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14411@end menu
14412
14413@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14414various real-time operating systems.
14415
14416@node VxWorks
14417@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14418
14419@cindex VxWorks
14420
14421@table @code
14422
14423@kindex target vxworks
14424@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14425A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14426is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14427
14428@end table
14429
14430On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14431current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14432
14433@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14434VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14435the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14436both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14437@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14438installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14439@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14440
14441@table @code
14442@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14443@kindex vxworks-timeout
14444All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14445This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14446seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14447your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14448of a thin network line.
14449@end table
14450
14451The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14452this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14453procedures.
14454
14455@findex INCLUDE_RDB
14456To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14457to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14458library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14459VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14460kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14461source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14462information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14463manual.
14464@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14465
14466Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14467your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14468run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14469@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14470
14471@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14472
14473@smallexample
14474(vxgdb)
14475@end smallexample
14476
14477@menu
14478* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14479* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14480* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14481@end menu
14482
14483@node VxWorks Connection
14484@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14485
14486The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14487network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14488
14489@smallexample
14490(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14491@end smallexample
14492
14493@need 750
14494@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14495
14496@smallexample
14497Attaching remote machine across net...
14498Connected to tt.
14499@end smallexample
14500
14501@need 1000
14502@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14503loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14504these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14505path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14506to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14507
14508@smallexample
14509prog.o: No such file or directory.
14510@end smallexample
14511
14512When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14513the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14514command again.
14515
14516@node VxWorks Download
14517@subsubsection VxWorks Download
14518
14519@cindex download to VxWorks
14520If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14521object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14522@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14523incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14524command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14525to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14526table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14527the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14528filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14529Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14530to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14531the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14532@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14533and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14534program, type this on VxWorks:
14535
14536@smallexample
14537-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14538@end smallexample
14539
14540@noindent
14541Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14542
14543@smallexample
14544(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14545(vxgdb) load prog.o
14546@end smallexample
14547
14548@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14549
14550@smallexample
14551Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14552@end smallexample
14553
14554You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14555after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14556this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14557auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14558history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14559debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14560table.)
14561
14562@node VxWorks Attach
14563@subsubsection Running Tasks
14564
14565@cindex running VxWorks tasks
14566You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14567follows:
14568
14569@smallexample
14570(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14571@end smallexample
14572
14573@noindent
14574where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14575or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14576the time of attachment.
14577
14578@node Embedded Processors
14579@section Embedded Processors
14580
14581This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14582configurations.
14583
14584@cindex send command to simulator
14585Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14586allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14587
14588@table @code
14589@item sim @var{command}
14590@kindex sim@r{, a command}
14591Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14592documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14593acceptable commands.
14594@end table
14595
14596
14597@menu
14598* ARM:: ARM RDI
14599* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14600* M68K:: Motorola M68K
14601* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14602* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14603* PA:: HP PA Embedded
14604* PowerPC:: PowerPC
14605* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14606* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14607* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14608* AVR:: Atmel AVR
14609* CRIS:: CRIS
14610* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14611@end menu
14612
14613@node ARM
14614@subsection ARM
14615@cindex ARM RDI
14616
14617@table @code
14618@kindex target rdi
14619@item target rdi @var{dev}
14620ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14621use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14622monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14623
14624@kindex target rdp
14625@item target rdp @var{dev}
14626ARM Demon monitor.
14627
14628@end table
14629
14630@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14631
14632@table @code
14633@item set arm disassembler
14634@kindex set arm
14635This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14636@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14637
14638@item show arm disassembler
14639@kindex show arm
14640Show the current disassembly style.
14641
14642@item set arm apcs32
14643@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14644This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14645
14646@item show arm apcs32
14647Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14648
14649@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14650This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14651argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14652
14653@table @code
14654@item auto
14655Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14656@item softfpa
14657Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14658processors.
14659@item fpa
14660GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14661@item softvfp
14662Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14663@item vfp
14664VFP co-processor.
14665@end table
14666
14667@item show arm fpu
14668Show the current type of the FPU.
14669
14670@item set arm abi
14671This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14672
14673@item show arm abi
14674Show the currently used ABI.
14675
14676@item set debug arm
14677Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14678target support subsystem.
14679
14680@item show debug arm
14681Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14682@end table
14683
14684The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14685using the RDI interface:
14686
14687@table @code
14688@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14689@kindex rdilogfile
14690@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14691Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14692With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14693no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14694@file{rdi.log}.
14695
14696@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14697@kindex rdilogenable
14698Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14699enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14700no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14701ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14702are logged to a file.
14703
14704@item set rdiromatzero
14705@kindex set rdiromatzero
14706@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14707Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14708vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14709(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14710effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14711
14712@item show rdiromatzero
14713@kindex show rdiromatzero
14714Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14715
14716@item set rdiheartbeat
14717@kindex set rdiheartbeat
14718@cindex RDI heartbeat
14719Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14720turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14721well as the Angel monitor.
14722
14723@item show rdiheartbeat
14724@kindex show rdiheartbeat
14725Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14726@end table
14727
14728
14729@node M32R/D
14730@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14731
14732@table @code
14733@kindex target m32r
14734@item target m32r @var{dev}
14735Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14736
14737@kindex target m32rsdi
14738@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14739Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14740@end table
14741
14742The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14743
14744@table @code
14745@item set download-path @var{path}
14746@kindex set download-path
14747@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14748Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14749
14750@item show download-path
14751@kindex show download-path
14752Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14753
14754@item set board-address @var{addr}
14755@kindex set board-address
14756@cindex M32-EVA target board address
14757Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14758
14759@item show board-address
14760@kindex show board-address
14761Show the current IP address of the target board.
14762
14763@item set server-address @var{addr}
14764@kindex set server-address
14765@cindex download server address (M32R)
14766Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14767host machine.
14768
14769@item show server-address
14770@kindex show server-address
14771Display the IP address of the download server.
14772
14773@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14774@kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14775Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14776upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14777executable file is uploaded.
14778
14779@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14780@kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14781Test the @code{upload} command.
14782@end table
14783
14784The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14785
14786@table @code
14787@item sdireset
14788@kindex sdireset
14789@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14790This command resets the SDI connection.
14791
14792@item sdistatus
14793@kindex sdistatus
14794This command shows the SDI connection status.
14795
14796@item debug_chaos
14797@kindex debug_chaos
14798@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14799Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14800
14801@item use_debug_dma
14802@kindex use_debug_dma
14803Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14804
14805@item use_mon_code
14806@kindex use_mon_code
14807Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14808
14809@item use_ib_break
14810@kindex use_ib_break
14811Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14812
14813@item use_dbt_break
14814@kindex use_dbt_break
14815Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14816@end table
14817
14818@node M68K
14819@subsection M68k
14820
14821The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14822target command for the following ROM monitor.
14823
14824@table @code
14825
14826@kindex target dbug
14827@item target dbug @var{dev}
14828dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14829
14830@end table
14831
14832@node MIPS Embedded
14833@subsection MIPS Embedded
14834
14835@cindex MIPS boards
14836@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14837MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14838you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14839
14840@need 1000
14841Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14842
14843@table @code
14844@item target mips @var{port}
14845@kindex target mips @var{port}
14846To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14847name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14848command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14849the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14850been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14851download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14852
14853For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14854port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14855debugger:
14856
14857@smallexample
14858host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14859@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14860(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14861(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14862(@value{GDBP}) run
14863@end smallexample
14864
14865@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14866On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14867connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14868concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14869@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14870
14871@item target pmon @var{port}
14872@kindex target pmon @var{port}
14873PMON ROM monitor.
14874
14875@item target ddb @var{port}
14876@kindex target ddb @var{port}
14877NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14878
14879@item target lsi @var{port}
14880@kindex target lsi @var{port}
14881LSI variant of PMON.
14882
14883@kindex target r3900
14884@item target r3900 @var{dev}
14885Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14886
14887@kindex target array
14888@item target array @var{dev}
14889Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14890
14891@end table
14892
14893
14894@noindent
14895@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14896
14897@table @code
14898@item set mipsfpu double
14899@itemx set mipsfpu single
14900@itemx set mipsfpu none
14901@itemx set mipsfpu auto
14902@itemx show mipsfpu
14903@kindex set mipsfpu
14904@kindex show mipsfpu
14905@cindex MIPS remote floating point
14906@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14907If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14908coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14909need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14910file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14911functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14912@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14913functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14914with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14915processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14916double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14917@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14918
14919In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14920floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14921and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14922
14923As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14924@samp{show mipsfpu}.
14925
14926@item set timeout @var{seconds}
14927@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14928@itemx show timeout
14929@itemx show retransmit-timeout
14930@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14931@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14932@kindex set timeout
14933@kindex show timeout
14934@kindex set retransmit-timeout
14935@kindex show retransmit-timeout
14936You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14937remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14938default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14939waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14940retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14941You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14942retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14943@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14944
14945The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14946is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14947forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14948to run before stopping.
14949
14950@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14951@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14952@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14953Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14954it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14955characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14956
14957@item show syn-garbage-limit
14958@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14959Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14960trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14961
14962@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14963@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14964@cindex remote monitor prompt
14965Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14966remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14967@table @asis
14968@item pmon target
14969@samp{PMON}
14970@item ddb target
14971@samp{NEC010}
14972@item lsi target
14973@samp{PMON>}
14974@end table
14975
14976@item show monitor-prompt
14977@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14978Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14979remote monitor.
14980
14981@item set monitor-warnings
14982@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14983Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14984has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14985display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14986PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14987
14988@item show monitor-warnings
14989@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14990Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14991
14992@item pmon @var{command}
14993@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14994@cindex send PMON command
14995This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14996monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14997@end table
14998
14999@node OpenRISC 1000
15000@subsection OpenRISC 1000
15001@cindex OpenRISC 1000
15002
15003@cindex or1k boards
15004See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
15005about platform and commands.
15006
15007@table @code
15008
15009@kindex target jtag
15010@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
15011
15012Connects to remote JTAG server.
15013JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
15014connected via parallel port to the board.
15015
15016Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
15017
15018@kindex or1ksim
15019@item or1ksim @var{command}
15020If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
15021Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
15022
15023@kindex info or1k spr
15024@item info or1k spr
15025Displays spr groups.
15026
15027@item info or1k spr @var{group}
15028@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
15029Displays register names in selected group.
15030
15031@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
15032@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
15033@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
15034@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
15035Shows information about specified spr register.
15036
15037@kindex spr
15038@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
15039@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
15040@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
15041@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
15042Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
15043@end table
15044
15045Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
15046It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
15047program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
15048triggers can be set using:
15049@table @code
15050@item $LEA/$LDATA
15051Load effective address/data
15052@item $SEA/$SDATA
15053Store effective address/data
15054@item $AEA/$ADATA
15055Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
15056@item $FETCH
15057Fetch data
15058@end table
15059
15060When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
15061@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
15062
15063@code{htrace} commands:
15064@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
15065@table @code
15066@kindex hwatch
15067@item hwatch @var{conditional}
15068Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
15069or Data. For example:
15070
15071@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15072
15073@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
15074
15075@kindex htrace
15076@item htrace info
15077Display information about current HW trace configuration.
15078
15079@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
15080Set starting criteria for HW trace.
15081
15082@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
15083Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
15084
15085@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
15086Set HW trace stopping criteria.
15087
15088@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
15089Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
15090triggered.
15091
15092@item htrace enable
15093@itemx htrace disable
15094Enables/disables the HW trace.
15095
15096@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
15097Clears currently recorded trace data.
15098
15099If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
15100will be written there.
15101
15102@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
15103Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
15104
15105@item htrace mode continuous
15106Set continuous trace mode.
15107
15108@item htrace mode suspend
15109Set suspend trace mode.
15110
15111@end table
15112
15113@node PowerPC
15114@subsection PowerPC
15115
15116@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
15117
15118@table @code
15119@kindex set powerpc
15120@item set powerpc soft-float
15121@itemx show powerpc soft-float
15122Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
15123convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
15124on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15125
15126@item set powerpc vector-abi
15127@itemx show powerpc vector-abi
15128Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
15129arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
15130@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
15131@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
15132registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
15133based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
15134
15135@kindex target dink32
15136@item target dink32 @var{dev}
15137DINK32 ROM monitor.
15138
15139@kindex target ppcbug
15140@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15141@kindex target ppcbug1
15142@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15143PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15144
15145@kindex target sds
15146@item target sds @var{dev}
15147SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15148@end table
15149
15150@cindex SDS protocol
15151The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
15152by @value{GDBN}:
15153
15154@table @code
15155@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15156@kindex set sdstimeout
15157Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15158default is 2 seconds.
15159
15160@item show sdstimeout
15161@kindex show sdstimeout
15162Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15163
15164@item sds @var{command}
15165@kindex sds@r{, a command}
15166Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15167@end table
15168
15169
15170@node PA
15171@subsection HP PA Embedded
15172
15173@table @code
15174
15175@kindex target op50n
15176@item target op50n @var{dev}
15177OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15178
15179@kindex target w89k
15180@item target w89k @var{dev}
15181W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15182
15183@end table
15184
15185@node Sparclet
15186@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15187
15188@cindex Sparclet
15189
15190@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15191Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15192@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15193both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15194@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15195
15196@table @code
15197@item remotetimeout @var{args}
15198@kindex remotetimeout
15199@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15200This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15201seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15202@end table
15203
15204@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15205When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15206information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15207load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15208@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15209
15210@smallexample
15211sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15212@end smallexample
15213
15214You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15215
15216@smallexample
15217sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15218@end smallexample
15219
15220@cindex running, on Sparclet
15221Once you have set
15222your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15223run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15224(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15225
15226@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15227
15228@smallexample
15229(gdbslet)
15230@end smallexample
15231
15232@menu
15233* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15234* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15235* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15236* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15237@end menu
15238
15239@node Sparclet File
15240@subsubsection Setting File to Debug
15241
15242The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15243
15244@smallexample
15245(gdbslet) file prog
15246@end smallexample
15247
15248@need 1000
15249@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15250@value{GDBN} locates
15251the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15252path.
15253If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
15254files will be searched as well.
15255@value{GDBN} locates
15256the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15257path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
15258If it fails
15259to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15260
15261@smallexample
15262prog: No such file or directory.
15263@end smallexample
15264
15265When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15266the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15267@code{target} command again.
15268
15269@node Sparclet Connection
15270@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15271
15272The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15273To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15274
15275@smallexample
15276(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15277Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15278main () at ../prog.c:3
15279@end smallexample
15280
15281@need 750
15282@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15283
15284@smallexample
15285Connected to ttya.
15286@end smallexample
15287
15288@node Sparclet Download
15289@subsubsection Sparclet Download
15290
15291@cindex download to Sparclet
15292Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15293you can use the @value{GDBN}
15294@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15295The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15296command.
15297Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15298address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15299offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15300of each of the file's sections.
15301For instance, if the program
15302@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15303and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15304
15305@smallexample
15306(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15307Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15308@end smallexample
15309
15310If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15311to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15312to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15313
15314@node Sparclet Execution
15315@subsubsection Running and Debugging
15316
15317@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15318You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15319commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15320manual for the list of commands.
15321
15322@smallexample
15323(gdbslet) b main
15324Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15325(gdbslet) run
15326Starting program: prog
15327Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
153283 char *symarg = 0;
15329(gdbslet) step
153304 char *execarg = "hello!";
15331(gdbslet)
15332@end smallexample
15333
15334@node Sparclite
15335@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15336
15337@table @code
15338
15339@kindex target sparclite
15340@item target sparclite @var{dev}
15341Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15342You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15343For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15344remote protocol.
15345
15346@end table
15347
15348@node Z8000
15349@subsection Zilog Z8000
15350
15351@cindex Z8000
15352@cindex simulator, Z8000
15353@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15354
15355When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15356a Z8000 simulator.
15357
15358For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15359unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15360segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15361appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15362
15363@table @code
15364@item target sim @var{args}
15365@kindex sim
15366@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15367Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15368options, specify them via @var{args}.
15369@end table
15370
15371@noindent
15372After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15373CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15374@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15375to run your program, and so on.
15376
15377As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15378(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15379additional items of information as specially named registers:
15380
15381@table @code
15382
15383@item cycles
15384Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15385
15386@item insts
15387Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15388
15389@item time
15390Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15391
15392@end table
15393
15394You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15395conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15396conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15397simulated clock ticks.
15398
15399@node AVR
15400@subsection Atmel AVR
15401@cindex AVR
15402
15403When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15404following AVR-specific commands:
15405
15406@table @code
15407@item info io_registers
15408@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15409@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15410This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15411each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15412@end table
15413
15414@node CRIS
15415@subsection CRIS
15416@cindex CRIS
15417
15418When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15419following CRIS-specific commands:
15420
15421@table @code
15422@item set cris-version @var{ver}
15423@cindex CRIS version
15424Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15425The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15426case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15427
15428@item show cris-version
15429Show the current CRIS version.
15430
15431@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15432@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15433Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15434Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15435@code{R59}.
15436
15437@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15438Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15439
15440@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15441@cindex CRIS mode
15442Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15443debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15444@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15445
15446@item show cris-mode
15447Show the current CRIS mode.
15448@end table
15449
15450@node Super-H
15451@subsection Renesas Super-H
15452@cindex Super-H
15453
15454For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15455commands:
15456
15457@table @code
15458@item regs
15459@kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15460Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15461@end table
15462
15463
15464@node Architectures
15465@section Architectures
15466
15467This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15468all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15469
15470@menu
15471* i386::
15472* A29K::
15473* Alpha::
15474* MIPS::
15475* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15476* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15477@end menu
15478
15479@node i386
15480@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15481
15482@table @code
15483@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15484@kindex set struct-convention
15485@cindex struct return convention
15486@cindex struct/union returned in registers
15487Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15488@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15489@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15490default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15491are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15492@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15493be returned in a register.
15494
15495@item show struct-convention
15496@kindex show struct-convention
15497Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15498from functions.
15499@end table
15500
15501@node A29K
15502@subsection A29K
15503
15504@table @code
15505
15506@kindex set rstack_high_address
15507@cindex AMD 29K register stack
15508@cindex register stack, AMD29K
15509@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15510On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15511@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15512extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15513stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15514memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15515this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15516the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15517address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15518hexadecimal.
15519
15520@kindex show rstack_high_address
15521@item show rstack_high_address
15522Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15523processors.
15524
15525@end table
15526
15527@node Alpha
15528@subsection Alpha
15529
15530See the following section.
15531
15532@node MIPS
15533@subsection MIPS
15534
15535@cindex stack on Alpha
15536@cindex stack on MIPS
15537@cindex Alpha stack
15538@cindex MIPS stack
15539Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15540sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15541find the beginning of a function.
15542
15543@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15544To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15545@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15546you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15547commands:
15548
15549@table @code
15550@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15551@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15552Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15553search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15554default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15555larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15556and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15557this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15558
15559@item show heuristic-fence-post
15560Display the current limit.
15561@end table
15562
15563@noindent
15564These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15565for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15566
15567Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15568programs:
15569
15570@table @code
15571@item set mips abi @var{arg}
15572@kindex set mips abi
15573@cindex set ABI for MIPS
15574Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15575values of @var{arg} are:
15576
15577@table @samp
15578@item auto
15579The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15580default).
15581@item o32
15582@item o64
15583@item n32
15584@item n64
15585@item eabi32
15586@item eabi64
15587@item auto
15588@end table
15589
15590@item show mips abi
15591@kindex show mips abi
15592Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15593
15594@item set mipsfpu
15595@itemx show mipsfpu
15596@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15597
15598@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15599@kindex set mips mask-address
15600@cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15601This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15602MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15603@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15604setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15605
15606@item show mips mask-address
15607@kindex show mips mask-address
15608Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15609not.
15610
15611@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15612@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15613This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15614transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15615that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15616and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15617
15618@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15619@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15620Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15621
15622@item set debug mips
15623@kindex set debug mips
15624This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15625target code in @value{GDBN}.
15626
15627@item show debug mips
15628@kindex show debug mips
15629Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15630@end table
15631
15632
15633@node HPPA
15634@subsection HPPA
15635@cindex HPPA support
15636
15637When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15638following special commands:
15639
15640@table @code
15641@item set debug hppa
15642@kindex set debug hppa
15643This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15644messages are to be displayed.
15645
15646@item show debug hppa
15647Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15648
15649@item maint print unwind @var{address}
15650@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15651This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15652given @var{address}.
15653
15654@end table
15655
15656
15657@node SPU
15658@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
15659@cindex Cell Broadband Engine
15660@cindex SPU
15661
15662When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
15663it provides the following special commands:
15664
15665@table @code
15666@item info spu event
15667@kindex info spu
15668Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
15669and pending event status.
15670
15671@item info spu signal
15672Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
15673signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
15674notification channels.
15675
15676@item info spu mailbox
15677Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
15678in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
15679SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
15680
15681@item info spu dma
15682Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15683DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15684and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15685
15686@item info spu proxydma
15687Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
15688Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
15689and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
15690
15691@end table
15692
15693
15694@node Controlling GDB
15695@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15696
15697You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15698@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15699data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15700described here.
15701
15702@menu
15703* Prompt:: Prompt
15704* Editing:: Command editing
15705* Command History:: Command history
15706* Screen Size:: Screen size
15707* Numbers:: Numbers
15708* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15709* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15710* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15711@end menu
15712
15713@node Prompt
15714@section Prompt
15715
15716@cindex prompt
15717
15718@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15719called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15720can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15721instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15722the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15723which one you are talking to.
15724
15725@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15726prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15727or a prompt that does not.
15728
15729@table @code
15730@kindex set prompt
15731@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15732Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15733
15734@kindex show prompt
15735@item show prompt
15736Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15737@end table
15738
15739@node Editing
15740@section Command Editing
15741@cindex readline
15742@cindex command line editing
15743
15744@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15745@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15746command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15747or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15748substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15749debugging sessions.
15750
15751You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15752command @code{set}.
15753
15754@table @code
15755@kindex set editing
15756@cindex editing
15757@item set editing
15758@itemx set editing on
15759Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15760
15761@item set editing off
15762Disable command line editing.
15763
15764@kindex show editing
15765@item show editing
15766Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15767@end table
15768
15769@xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15770interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15771encouraged to read that chapter.
15772
15773@node Command History
15774@section Command History
15775@cindex command history
15776
15777@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15778debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15779happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15780history facility.
15781
15782@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15783package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15784Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15785
15786To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15787the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
15788(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
15789means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15790affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15791pressed on a line by itself.
15792
15793@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15794The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15795history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15796use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15797
15798Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15799history.
15800
15801@table @code
15802@cindex history substitution
15803@cindex history file
15804@kindex set history filename
15805@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15806@item set history filename @var{fname}
15807Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15808This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15809list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15810exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15811the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15812to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15813@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15814is not set.
15815
15816@cindex save command history
15817@kindex set history save
15818@item set history save
15819@itemx set history save on
15820Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15821@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15822
15823@item set history save off
15824Stop recording command history in a file.
15825
15826@cindex history size
15827@kindex set history size
15828@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15829@item set history size @var{size}
15830Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15831This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15832@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15833@end table
15834
15835History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15836@xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15837
15838@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15839Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15840is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15841@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15842follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15843a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15844history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15845@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15846
15847The commands to control history expansion are:
15848
15849@table @code
15850@item set history expansion on
15851@itemx set history expansion
15852@kindex set history expansion
15853Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15854
15855@item set history expansion off
15856Disable history expansion.
15857
15858@c @group
15859@kindex show history
15860@item show history
15861@itemx show history filename
15862@itemx show history save
15863@itemx show history size
15864@itemx show history expansion
15865These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15866@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15867@c @end group
15868@end table
15869
15870@table @code
15871@kindex show commands
15872@cindex show last commands
15873@cindex display command history
15874@item show commands
15875Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15876
15877@item show commands @var{n}
15878Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15879
15880@item show commands +
15881Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15882@end table
15883
15884@node Screen Size
15885@section Screen Size
15886@cindex size of screen
15887@cindex pauses in output
15888
15889Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15890information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15891@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15892output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15893to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15894determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15895printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15896rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15897
15898Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15899driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15900together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15901@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15902you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15903width} commands:
15904
15905@table @code
15906@kindex set height
15907@kindex set width
15908@kindex show width
15909@kindex show height
15910@item set height @var{lpp}
15911@itemx show height
15912@itemx set width @var{cpl}
15913@itemx show width
15914These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15915a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15916commands display the current settings.
15917
15918If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15919output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15920file or to an editor buffer.
15921
15922Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15923from wrapping its output.
15924
15925@item set pagination on
15926@itemx set pagination off
15927@kindex set pagination
15928Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15929pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15930
15931@item show pagination
15932@kindex show pagination
15933Show the current pagination mode.
15934@end table
15935
15936@node Numbers
15937@section Numbers
15938@cindex number representation
15939@cindex entering numbers
15940
15941You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15942@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15943@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15944begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15945@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
1594610; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15947format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15948both input and output with the commands described below.
15949
15950@table @code
15951@kindex set input-radix
15952@item set input-radix @var{base}
15953Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15954for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15955specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15956example, any of
15957
15958@smallexample
15959set input-radix 012
15960set input-radix 10.
15961set input-radix 0xa
15962@end smallexample
15963
15964@noindent
15965sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15966leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15967@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15968interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15969@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15970change the radix.
15971
15972@kindex set output-radix
15973@item set output-radix @var{base}
15974Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15975for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15976specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15977
15978@kindex show input-radix
15979@item show input-radix
15980Display the current default base for numeric input.
15981
15982@kindex show output-radix
15983@item show output-radix
15984Display the current default base for numeric display.
15985
15986@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15987@itemx show radix
15988@kindex set radix
15989@kindex show radix
15990These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15991of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15992the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15993default value of 10.
15994
15995@end table
15996
15997@node ABI
15998@section Configuring the Current ABI
15999
16000@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
16001application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
16002conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
16003current ABI.
16004
16005@cindex OS ABI
16006@kindex set osabi
16007@kindex show osabi
16008
16009One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
16010system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
16011@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
16012but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
16013One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
16014an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
16015not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
16016platform provides.
16017
16018@table @code
16019@item show osabi
16020Show the OS ABI currently in use.
16021
16022@item set osabi
16023With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
16024
16025@item set osabi @var{abi}
16026Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
16027@end table
16028
16029@cindex float promotion
16030
16031Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
16032function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
16033(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
16034according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
16035(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
16036@code{double} and then passed.
16037
16038Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
16039a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16040as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16041
16042@table @code
16043@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16044@item set coerce-float-to-double
16045@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16046Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16047to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16048
16049@item set coerce-float-to-double off
16050Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16051functions.
16052
16053@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16054@item show coerce-float-to-double
16055Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16056@end table
16057
16058@kindex set cp-abi
16059@kindex show cp-abi
16060@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16061objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16062used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16063programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16064multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16065program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16066Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16067before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16068``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16069use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16070``auto''.
16071
16072@table @code
16073@item show cp-abi
16074Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16075
16076@item set cp-abi
16077With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16078
16079@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16080@itemx set cp-abi auto
16081Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16082@end table
16083
16084@node Messages/Warnings
16085@section Optional Warnings and Messages
16086
16087@cindex verbose operation
16088@cindex optional warnings
16089By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16090running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16091command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16092internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16093
16094Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16095which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16096see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16097
16098@table @code
16099@kindex set verbose
16100@item set verbose on
16101Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16102
16103@item set verbose off
16104Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16105
16106@kindex show verbose
16107@item show verbose
16108Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16109@end table
16110
16111By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16112object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16113find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
16114Symbol Files}).
16115
16116@table @code
16117
16118@kindex set complaints
16119@item set complaints @var{limit}
16120Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16121unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16122@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16123to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16124
16125@kindex show complaints
16126@item show complaints
16127Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16128
16129@end table
16130
16131By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16132lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16133you try to run a program which is already running:
16134
16135@smallexample
16136(@value{GDBP}) run
16137The program being debugged has been started already.
16138Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16139@end smallexample
16140
16141If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16142commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16143
16144@table @code
16145
16146@kindex set confirm
16147@cindex flinching
16148@cindex confirmation
16149@cindex stupid questions
16150@item set confirm off
16151Disables confirmation requests.
16152
16153@item set confirm on
16154Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16155
16156@kindex show confirm
16157@item show confirm
16158Displays state of confirmation requests.
16159
16160@end table
16161
16162@cindex command tracing
16163If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16164useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16165printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16166quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16167
16168@table @code
16169@kindex set trace-commands
16170@cindex command scripts, debugging
16171@item set trace-commands on
16172Enable command tracing.
16173@item set trace-commands off
16174Disable command tracing.
16175@item show trace-commands
16176Display the current state of command tracing.
16177@end table
16178
16179@node Debugging Output
16180@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
16181@cindex optional debugging messages
16182
16183@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16184various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16185interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16186section documents those commands.
16187
16188@table @code
16189@kindex set exec-done-display
16190@item set exec-done-display
16191Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16192completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16193asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16194@kindex show exec-done-display
16195@item show exec-done-display
16196Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16197notification.
16198@kindex set debug
16199@cindex gdbarch debugging info
16200@cindex architecture debugging info
16201@item set debug arch
16202Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16203@kindex show debug
16204@item show debug arch
16205Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16206@item set debug aix-thread
16207@cindex AIX threads
16208Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16209module.
16210@item show debug aix-thread
16211Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16212@item set debug event
16213@cindex event debugging info
16214Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16215default is off.
16216@item show debug event
16217Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16218info.
16219@item set debug expression
16220@cindex expression debugging info
16221Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16222expression parsing. The default is off.
16223@item show debug expression
16224Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16225@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16226@item set debug frame
16227@cindex frame debugging info
16228Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16229default is off.
16230@item show debug frame
16231Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16232info.
16233@item set debug infrun
16234@cindex inferior debugging info
16235Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16236The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16237for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16238@item show debug infrun
16239Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16240@item set debug lin-lwp
16241@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16242@cindex Linux lightweight processes
16243Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16244@item show debug lin-lwp
16245Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16246@item set debug observer
16247@cindex observer debugging info
16248Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16249includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16250@item show debug observer
16251Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16252@item set debug overload
16253@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16254Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16255info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16256is off.
16257@item show debug overload
16258Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16259debugging info.
16260@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16261@cindex serial connections, debugging
16262@cindex debug remote protocol
16263@cindex remote protocol debugging
16264@cindex display remote packets
16265@item set debug remote
16266Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16267the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16268@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16269@item show debug remote
16270Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16271@item set debug serial
16272Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16273default is off.
16274@item show debug serial
16275Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16276info.
16277@item set debug solib-frv
16278@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16279Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16280@item show debug solib-frv
16281Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16282messages.
16283@item set debug target
16284@cindex target debugging info
16285Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16286includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16287default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16288value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16289until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16290@item show debug target
16291Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16292info.
16293@item set debugvarobj
16294@cindex variable object debugging info
16295Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16296info. The default is off.
16297@item show debugvarobj
16298Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16299debugging info.
16300@item set debug xml
16301@cindex XML parser debugging
16302Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
16303@item show debug xml
16304Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
16305@end table
16306
16307@node Sequences
16308@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16309
16310Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16311Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16312commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16313files.
16314
16315@menu
16316* Define:: How to define your own commands
16317* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16318* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16319* Output:: Commands for controlled output
16320@end menu
16321
16322@node Define
16323@section User-defined Commands
16324
16325@cindex user-defined command
16326@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16327A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16328which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16329@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16330separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16331via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16332
16333@smallexample
16334define adder
16335 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16336end
16337@end smallexample
16338
16339@noindent
16340To execute the command use:
16341
16342@smallexample
16343adder 1 2 3
16344@end smallexample
16345
16346@noindent
16347This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16348its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16349reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16350functions calls.
16351
16352@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16353@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16354In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16355been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16356
16357@smallexample
16358define adder
16359 if $argc == 2
16360 print $arg0 + $arg1
16361 end
16362 if $argc == 3
16363 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16364 end
16365end
16366@end smallexample
16367
16368@table @code
16369
16370@kindex define
16371@item define @var{commandname}
16372Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16373by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16374
16375The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16376which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16377commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16378
16379@kindex document
16380@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16381@item document @var{commandname}
16382Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16383accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16384defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16385reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16386After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16387@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16388
16389You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16390documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16391does not change the documentation.
16392
16393@kindex dont-repeat
16394@cindex don't repeat command
16395@item dont-repeat
16396Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16397command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16398(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16399
16400@kindex help user-defined
16401@item help user-defined
16402List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16403(if any) for each.
16404
16405@kindex show user
16406@item show user
16407@itemx show user @var{commandname}
16408Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16409not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16410definitions for all user-defined commands.
16411
16412@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16413@kindex show max-user-call-depth
16414@kindex set max-user-call-depth
16415@item show max-user-call-depth
16416@itemx set max-user-call-depth
16417The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16418levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16419infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16420@end table
16421
16422In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16423use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16424
16425When user-defined commands are executed, the
16426commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16427stops execution of the user-defined command.
16428
16429If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16430without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16431commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16432messages when used in a user-defined command.
16433
16434@node Hooks
16435@section User-defined Command Hooks
16436@cindex command hooks
16437@cindex hooks, for commands
16438@cindex hooks, pre-command
16439
16440@kindex hook
16441You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16442command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16443command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16444before that command.
16445
16446@cindex hooks, post-command
16447@kindex hookpost
16448A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16449Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16450@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16451that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16452pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16453
16454It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16455occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16456
16457@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16458@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16459
16460@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16461In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16462(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16463execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16464displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16465
16466For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16467single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16468you could define:
16469
16470@smallexample
16471define hook-stop
16472handle SIGALRM nopass
16473end
16474
16475define hook-run
16476handle SIGALRM pass
16477end
16478
16479define hook-continue
16480handle SIGALRM pass
16481end
16482@end smallexample
16483
16484As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16485command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16486you could define:
16487
16488@smallexample
16489define hook-echo
16490echo <<<---
16491end
16492
16493define hookpost-echo
16494echo --->>>\n
16495end
16496
16497(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16498<<<---Hello World--->>>
16499(@value{GDBP})
16500
16501@end smallexample
16502
16503You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16504not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16505name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16506@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16507@c or not?
16508If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16509@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16510(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16511
16512If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16513get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16514
16515@node Command Files
16516@section Command Files
16517
16518@cindex command files
16519@cindex scripting commands
16520A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16521@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16522also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16523does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16524terminal.
16525
16526You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16527command:
16528
16529@table @code
16530@kindex source
16531@cindex execute commands from a file
16532@item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16533Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16534@end table
16535
16536The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16537unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16538@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16539printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16540execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16541
16542@value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16543on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16544
16545If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16546each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16547@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16548
16549Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16550without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16551normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16552when called from command files.
16553
16554@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16555mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16556standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16557not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16558the next command.
16559
16560@smallexample
16561gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16562@end smallexample
16563
16564(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16565will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16566would be directed to @file{log}.
16567
16568Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16569commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16570complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16571variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16572built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16573deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16574complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16575conditionally, etc.
16576
16577@table @code
16578@kindex if
16579@kindex else
16580@item if
16581@itemx else
16582This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16583commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16584expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16585are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16586There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16587of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16588end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16589
16590@kindex while
16591@item while
16592This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16593@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16594to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16595line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16596@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16597executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16598
16599@kindex loop_break
16600@item loop_break
16601This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16602Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16603line.
16604
16605@kindex loop_continue
16606@item loop_continue
16607This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16608in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16609branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16610the controlling expression.
16611
16612@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16613@item end
16614Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16615@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16616@end table
16617
16618
16619@node Output
16620@section Commands for Controlled Output
16621
16622During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16623@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16624explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16625describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16626want.
16627
16628@table @code
16629@kindex echo
16630@item echo @var{text}
16631@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16632@c because it is not in ANSI.
16633Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16634@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16635newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16636In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16637by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16638string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16639trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16640To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16641@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16642
16643A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16644the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16645
16646@smallexample
16647echo This is some text\n\
16648which is continued\n\
16649onto several lines.\n
16650@end smallexample
16651
16652produces the same output as
16653
16654@smallexample
16655echo This is some text\n
16656echo which is continued\n
16657echo onto several lines.\n
16658@end smallexample
16659
16660@kindex output
16661@item output @var{expression}
16662Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16663newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16664value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16665on expressions.
16666
16667@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16668Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16669the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16670Formats}, for more information.
16671
16672@kindex printf
16673@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16674Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
16675the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
16676@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
16677which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
16678specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
16679executing the code below:
16680
16681@smallexample
16682printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16683@end smallexample
16684
16685As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
16686are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
16687by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
16688evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
16689style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
16690printed.
16691
16692For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16693
16694@smallexample
16695printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16696@end smallexample
16697
16698@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
16699specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
16700character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
16701
16702@itemize @bullet
16703@item
16704The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
16705
16706@item
16707The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
16708width.
16709
16710@item
16711The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
16712@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
16713
16714@item
16715The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
16716supported.
16717
16718@item
16719The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
16720
16721@item
16722The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
16723@end itemize
16724
16725@noindent
16726Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
16727underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
16728the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
16729supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
16730
16731As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
16732sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
16733@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
16734single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
16735supported.
16736
16737Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
16738(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
16739together with a floating point specifier.
16740letters:
16741
16742@itemize @bullet
16743@item
16744@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
16745
16746@item
16747@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
16748
16749@item
16750@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
16751@end itemize
16752
16753If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
16754support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
16755such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
16756
16757In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
16758available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
16759
16760Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
16761@smallexample
16762printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
16763@end smallexample
16764
16765@end table
16766
16767@node Interpreters
16768@chapter Command Interpreters
16769@cindex command interpreters
16770
16771@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16772infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16773between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16774
16775@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16776interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16777and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16778describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16779
16780By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16781However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16782interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16783startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16784
16785@table @code
16786@item console
16787@cindex console interpreter
16788The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16789used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16790@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16791
16792@item mi
16793@cindex mi interpreter
16794The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16795by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16796or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16797Interface}.
16798
16799@item mi2
16800@cindex mi2 interpreter
16801The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16802
16803@item mi1
16804@cindex mi1 interpreter
16805The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16806
16807@end table
16808
16809@cindex invoke another interpreter
16810The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16811switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16812precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16813enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16814@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16815the IDE inoperable!
16816
16817@kindex interpreter-exec
16818Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16819commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16820command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16821@code{interpreter-exec} command:
16822
16823@smallexample
16824interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16825@end smallexample
16826
16827@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16828@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16829
16830@node TUI
16831@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16832@cindex TUI
16833@cindex Text User Interface
16834
16835@menu
16836* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16837* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16838* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16839* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16840* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16841@end menu
16842
16843The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
16844interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16845file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16846commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
16847on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
16848is available.
16849
16850@pindex @value{GDBTUI}
16851The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
16852either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
16853You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
16854using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
16855@xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
16856
16857@node TUI Overview
16858@section TUI Overview
16859
16860In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
16861
16862@table @emph
16863@item command
16864This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16865prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16866managed using readline.
16867
16868@item source
16869The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16870line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16871
16872@item assembly
16873The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16874
16875@item register
16876This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
16877when their values change.
16878@end table
16879
16880The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16881by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
16882Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
16883indicates the breakpoint type:
16884
16885@table @code
16886@item B
16887Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16888
16889@item b
16890Breakpoint which was never hit.
16891
16892@item H
16893Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16894
16895@item h
16896Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16897@end table
16898
16899The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16900
16901@table @code
16902@item +
16903Breakpoint is enabled.
16904
16905@item -
16906Breakpoint is disabled.
16907@end table
16908
16909The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
16910thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
16911changes.
16912
16913These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
16914window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
16915layouts:
16916
16917@itemize @bullet
16918@item
16919source only,
16920
16921@item
16922assembly only,
16923
16924@item
16925source and assembly,
16926
16927@item
16928source and registers, or
16929
16930@item
16931assembly and registers.
16932@end itemize
16933
16934A status line above the command window shows the following information:
16935
16936@table @emph
16937@item target
16938Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
16939(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16940
16941@item process
16942Gives the current process or thread number.
16943When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16944
16945@item function
16946Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16947The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16948When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
16949the string @code{??} is displayed.
16950
16951@item line
16952Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16953When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
16954
16955@item pc
16956Indicates the current program counter address.
16957@end table
16958
16959@node TUI Keys
16960@section TUI Key Bindings
16961@cindex TUI key bindings
16962
16963The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16964(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
16965are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16966
16967@table @kbd
16968@kindex C-x C-a
16969@item C-x C-a
16970@kindex C-x a
16971@itemx C-x a
16972@kindex C-x A
16973@itemx C-x A
16974Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
16975the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
16976its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
16977the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
16978The screen is then refreshed.
16979
16980@kindex C-x 1
16981@item C-x 1
16982Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16983either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16984is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16985
16986Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16987
16988@kindex C-x 2
16989@item C-x 2
16990Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16991layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
16992When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16993previous layout and the new one.
16994
16995Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16996
16997@kindex C-x o
16998@item C-x o
16999Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
17000(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
17001gives the focus to the next TUI window.
17002
17003Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
17004
17005@kindex C-x s
17006@item C-x s
17007Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
17008keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
17009@end table
17010
17011The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
17012
17013@table @asis
17014@kindex PgUp
17015@item @key{PgUp}
17016Scroll the active window one page up.
17017
17018@kindex PgDn
17019@item @key{PgDn}
17020Scroll the active window one page down.
17021
17022@kindex Up
17023@item @key{Up}
17024Scroll the active window one line up.
17025
17026@kindex Down
17027@item @key{Down}
17028Scroll the active window one line down.
17029
17030@kindex Left
17031@item @key{Left}
17032Scroll the active window one column left.
17033
17034@kindex Right
17035@item @key{Right}
17036Scroll the active window one column right.
17037
17038@kindex C-L
17039@item @kbd{C-L}
17040Refresh the screen.
17041@end table
17042
17043Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
17044are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
17045window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
17046other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
17047and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
17048
17049@node TUI Single Key Mode
17050@section TUI Single Key Mode
17051@cindex TUI single key mode
17052
17053The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
17054frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
17055switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
17056
17057@table @kbd
17058@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17059@item c
17060continue
17061
17062@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17063@item d
17064down
17065
17066@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17067@item f
17068finish
17069
17070@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17071@item n
17072next
17073
17074@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17075@item q
17076exit the SingleKey mode.
17077
17078@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17079@item r
17080run
17081
17082@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17083@item s
17084step
17085
17086@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17087@item u
17088up
17089
17090@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17091@item v
17092info locals
17093
17094@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17095@item w
17096where
17097@end table
17098
17099Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17100The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17101it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17102with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17103SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17104this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17105
17106
17107@node TUI Commands
17108@section TUI-specific Commands
17109@cindex TUI commands
17110
17111The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17112These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
17113the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
17114of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
17115
17116@table @code
17117@item info win
17118@kindex info win
17119List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17120
17121@item layout next
17122@kindex layout
17123Display the next layout.
17124
17125@item layout prev
17126Display the previous layout.
17127
17128@item layout src
17129Display the source window only.
17130
17131@item layout asm
17132Display the assembly window only.
17133
17134@item layout split
17135Display the source and assembly window.
17136
17137@item layout regs
17138Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17139
17140@item focus next
17141@kindex focus
17142Make the next window active for scrolling.
17143
17144@item focus prev
17145Make the previous window active for scrolling.
17146
17147@item focus src
17148Make the source window active for scrolling.
17149
17150@item focus asm
17151Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
17152
17153@item focus regs
17154Make the register window active for scrolling.
17155
17156@item focus cmd
17157Make the command window active for scrolling.
17158
17159@item refresh
17160@kindex refresh
17161Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17162
17163@item tui reg float
17164@kindex tui reg
17165Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17166
17167@item tui reg general
17168Show the general registers in the register window.
17169
17170@item tui reg next
17171Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17172their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17173following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17174@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17175
17176@item tui reg system
17177Show the system registers in the register window.
17178
17179@item update
17180@kindex update
17181Update the source window and the current execution point.
17182
17183@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17184@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17185@kindex winheight
17186Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17187lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17188decrease it.
17189
17190@item tabset @var{nchars}
17191@kindex tabset
17192Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17193@end table
17194
17195@node TUI Configuration
17196@section TUI Configuration Variables
17197@cindex TUI configuration variables
17198
17199Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
17200
17201@table @code
17202@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17203@kindex set tui border-kind
17204Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17205The possible values are the following:
17206@table @code
17207@item space
17208Use a space character to draw the border.
17209
17210@item ascii
17211Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
17212
17213@item acs
17214Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17215drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17216@end table
17217
17218@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17219@kindex set tui border-mode
17220@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17221@kindex set tui active-border-mode
17222Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
17223or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17224@table @code
17225@item normal
17226Use normal attributes to display the border.
17227
17228@item standout
17229Use standout mode.
17230
17231@item reverse
17232Use reverse video mode.
17233
17234@item half
17235Use half bright mode.
17236
17237@item half-standout
17238Use half bright and standout mode.
17239
17240@item bold
17241Use extra bright or bold mode.
17242
17243@item bold-standout
17244Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17245@end table
17246@end table
17247
17248@node Emacs
17249@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17250
17251@cindex Emacs
17252@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17253A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17254edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17255@value{GDBN}.
17256
17257To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17258executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17259@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17260created Emacs buffer.
17261@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17262
17263Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17264things:
17265
17266@itemize @bullet
17267@item
17268All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
17269the GUD buffer.
17270
17271This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17272and output done by the program you are debugging.
17273
17274This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17275commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17276in this way.
17277
17278All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17279with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17280way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17281stop.
17282
17283@item
17284@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17285
17286Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17287source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17288left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17289source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17290and the source.
17291
17292Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17293usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17294@end itemize
17295
17296We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
17297a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
17298that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
17299@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
17300
17301If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17302gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17303your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17304sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17305with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17306program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17307some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17308@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17309buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17310
17311The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17312line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
17313that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
17314,Commands to Specify Files}.
17315
17316By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17317need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17318keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17319customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17320one you want.
17321
17322In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17323addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17324
17325@table @kbd
17326@item C-h m
17327Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
17328
17329@item C-c C-s
17330Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17331update the display window to show the current file and location.
17332
17333@item C-c C-n
17334Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17335calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17336to show the current file and location.
17337
17338@item C-c C-i
17339Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17340display window accordingly.
17341
17342@item C-c C-f
17343Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17344@code{finish} command.
17345
17346@item C-c C-r
17347Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17348command.
17349
17350@item C-c <
17351Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17352(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17353like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17354
17355@item C-c >
17356Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17357@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17358@end table
17359
17360In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17361tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17362
17363In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
17364separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
17365Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
17366become the current frame and display the associated source in the
17367source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
17368selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
17369speedbar displays watch expressions.
17370
17371If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17372it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17373request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17374the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17375frame.
17376
17377The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17378which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17379the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17380communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17381delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17382to correspond properly with the code.
17383
17384A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
17385given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
17386Emacs Manual}).
17387
17388@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17389@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17390@ignore
17391@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17392@kindex Epoch
17393@kindex inspect
17394
17395Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17396called the @code{epoch}
17397environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17398@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17399each value is printed in its own window.
17400@end ignore
17401
17402
17403@node GDB/MI
17404@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17405
17406@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17407
17408@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17409@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17410@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17411@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17412is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17413use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17414
17415This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17416in the form of a reference manual.
17417
17418Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17419features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17420(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17421
17422@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17423
17424@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17425This chapter uses the following notation:
17426
17427@itemize @bullet
17428@item
17429@code{|} separates two alternatives.
17430
17431@item
17432@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17433it may or may not be given.
17434
17435@item
17436@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17437may repeat zero or more times.
17438
17439@item
17440@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17441may repeat one or more times.
17442
17443@item
17444@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17445@end itemize
17446
17447@ignore
17448@heading Dependencies
17449@end ignore
17450
17451@menu
17452* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17453* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17454* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17455* GDB/MI Output Records::
17456* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17457* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17458* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17459* GDB/MI Program Context::
17460* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17461* GDB/MI Program Execution::
17462* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17463* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17464* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17465* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17466* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17467* GDB/MI File Commands::
17468@ignore
17469* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17470* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17471* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17472@end ignore
17473* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17474* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
17475* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17476@end menu
17477
17478@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17479@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17480@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17481
17482@menu
17483* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17484* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17485@end menu
17486
17487@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17488@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17489
17490@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17491@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17492@table @code
17493@item @var{command} @expansion{}
17494@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17495
17496@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17497@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17498@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17499
17500@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17501@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17502@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17503
17504@item @var{token} @expansion{}
17505"any sequence of digits"
17506
17507@item @var{option} @expansion{}
17508@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17509
17510@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17511@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17512
17513@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17514@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17515
17516@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17517@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17518"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17519
17520@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17521@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17522
17523@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17524@code{CR | CR-LF}
17525@end table
17526
17527@noindent
17528Notes:
17529
17530@itemize @bullet
17531@item
17532The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17533output is described below.
17534
17535@item
17536The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17537finishes.
17538
17539@item
17540Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17541list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17542followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17543parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17544@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17545@end itemize
17546
17547Pragmatics:
17548
17549@itemize @bullet
17550@item
17551We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17552
17553@item
17554We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17555@end itemize
17556
17557@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17558@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17559
17560@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17561@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17562The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17563followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17564is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17565terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17566
17567If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17568corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17569@var{token}.
17570
17571@table @code
17572@item @var{output} @expansion{}
17573@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17574
17575@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17576@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17577
17578@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17579@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17580
17581@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17582@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17583
17584@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17585@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17586
17587@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17588@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17589
17590@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17591@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17592
17593@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17594@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17595
17596@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17597@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17598
17599@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17600@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17601depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17602
17603@item @var{result} @expansion{}
17604@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17605
17606@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17607@code{ @var{string} }
17608
17609@item @var{value} @expansion{}
17610@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17611
17612@item @var{const} @expansion{}
17613@code{@var{c-string}}
17614
17615@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17616@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17617
17618@item @var{list} @expansion{}
17619@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17620@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17621
17622@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17623@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17624
17625@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17626@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17627
17628@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17629@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17630
17631@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17632@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17633
17634@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17635@code{CR | CR-LF}
17636
17637@item @var{token} @expansion{}
17638@emph{any sequence of digits}.
17639@end table
17640
17641@noindent
17642Notes:
17643
17644@itemize @bullet
17645@item
17646All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17647
17648@item
17649The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17650command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17651@var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17652original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17653
17654@item
17655@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17656@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17657progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17658prefixed by @samp{+}.
17659
17660@item
17661@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17662@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17663(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17664@samp{*}.
17665
17666@item
17667@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17668@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17669client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17670output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17671
17672@item
17673@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17674@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17675console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17676output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17677
17678@item
17679@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17680@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17681All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17682
17683@item
17684@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17685@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17686instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17687the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17688
17689@item
17690@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17691New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17692@var{values}.
17693
17694
17695@end itemize
17696
17697@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17698details about the various output records.
17699
17700@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17701@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17702@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17703
17704@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17705@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17706
17707For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17708but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17709that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17710command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17711@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17712@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17713
17714This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17715recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17716(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17717
17718@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17719@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17720@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17721@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17722
17723The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17724program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17725
17726Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17727by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17728to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17729section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17730might change.
17731
17732Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17733for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17734list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17735parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17736
17737@itemize @bullet
17738@item
17739New MI commands may be added.
17740
17741@item
17742New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17743
17744@item
17745The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17746@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17747
17748@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17749@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17750
17751@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17752@c resolve inconsistencies.
17753@end itemize
17754
17755If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17756will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17757output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17758@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17759responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17760
17761@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17762@c version?
17763
17764The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17765end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17766follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17767@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17768@email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17769Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17770called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17771for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17772@cindex mailing lists
17773
17774@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17775@node GDB/MI Output Records
17776@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17777
17778@menu
17779* GDB/MI Result Records::
17780* GDB/MI Stream Records::
17781* GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17782@end menu
17783
17784@node GDB/MI Result Records
17785@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17786
17787@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17788@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17789In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17790@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17791
17792@table @code
17793@findex ^done
17794@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17795The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17796values.
17797
17798@item "^running"
17799@findex ^running
17800@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17801The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17802running.
17803
17804@item "^connected"
17805@findex ^connected
17806@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17807
17808@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17809@findex ^error
17810The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17811error message.
17812
17813@item "^exit"
17814@findex ^exit
17815@value{GDBN} has terminated.
17816
17817@end table
17818
17819@node GDB/MI Stream Records
17820@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17821
17822@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17823@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17824@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17825target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17826funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17827
17828Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17829identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17830Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17831@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17832line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17833
17834@table @code
17835@item "~" @var{string-output}
17836The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17837CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17838
17839@item "@@" @var{string-output}
17840The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17841target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17842asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17843
17844@item "&" @var{string-output}
17845The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17846internals.
17847@end table
17848
17849@node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17850@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17851
17852@cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17853@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17854@dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17855additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17856consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17857target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17858
17859The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17860In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17861
17862@table @code
17863@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17864@end table
17865
17866@var{reason} can be one of the following:
17867
17868@table @code
17869@item breakpoint-hit
17870A breakpoint was reached.
17871@item watchpoint-trigger
17872A watchpoint was triggered.
17873@item read-watchpoint-trigger
17874A read watchpoint was triggered.
17875@item access-watchpoint-trigger
17876An access watchpoint was triggered.
17877@item function-finished
17878An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17879@item location-reached
17880An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17881@item watchpoint-scope
17882A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17883@item end-stepping-range
17884An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17885similar CLI command was accomplished.
17886@item exited-signalled
17887The inferior exited because of a signal.
17888@item exited
17889The inferior exited.
17890@item exited-normally
17891The inferior exited normally.
17892@item signal-received
17893A signal was received by the inferior.
17894@end table
17895
17896
17897@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17898@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17899@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17900@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17901
17902This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17903the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17904following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17905the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17906
17907Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17908readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17909
17910@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17911
17912Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17913information of the breakpoint.
17914
17915@smallexample
17916-> -break-insert main
17917<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17918 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17919 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17920<- (gdb)
17921@end smallexample
17922
17923@subheading Program Execution
17924
17925Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17926reason that execution stopped.
17927
17928@smallexample
17929-> -exec-run
17930<- ^running
17931<- (gdb)
17932<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17933 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17934 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17935 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17936<- (gdb)
17937-> -exec-continue
17938<- ^running
17939<- (gdb)
17940<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17941<- (gdb)
17942@end smallexample
17943
17944@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17945
17946Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17947
17948@smallexample
17949-> (gdb)
17950<- -gdb-exit
17951<- ^exit
17952@end smallexample
17953
17954@subheading A Bad Command
17955
17956Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17957
17958@smallexample
17959-> -rubbish
17960<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17961<- (gdb)
17962@end smallexample
17963
17964
17965@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17966@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17967@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17968
17969The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17970commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17971
17972@subheading Motivation
17973
17974The motivation for this collection of commands.
17975
17976@subheading Introduction
17977
17978A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17979
17980@subheading Commands
17981
17982For each command in the block, the following is described:
17983
17984@subsubheading Synopsis
17985
17986@smallexample
17987 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17988@end smallexample
17989
17990@subsubheading Result
17991
17992@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17993
17994The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17995
17996@subsubheading Example
17997
17998Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17999not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
18000
18001
18002@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18003@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
18004@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
18005
18006@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
18007@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
18008This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
18009breakpoints.
18010
18011@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
18012@findex -break-after
18013
18014@subsubheading Synopsis
18015
18016@smallexample
18017 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
18018@end smallexample
18019
18020The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
18021hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
18022the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
18023@samp{-break-list} command below.
18024
18025@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18026
18027The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
18028
18029@subsubheading Example
18030
18031@smallexample
18032(gdb)
18033-break-insert main
18034^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
18035fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
18036(gdb)
18037-break-after 1 3
18038~
18039^done
18040(gdb)
18041-break-list
18042^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18043hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18044@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18045@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18046@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18047@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18048@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18049body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18050addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18051line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18052(gdb)
18053@end smallexample
18054
18055@ignore
18056@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
18057@findex -break-catch
18058
18059@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
18060@findex -break-commands
18061@end ignore
18062
18063
18064@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
18065@findex -break-condition
18066
18067@subsubheading Synopsis
18068
18069@smallexample
18070 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
18071@end smallexample
18072
18073Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
18074@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
18075@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
18076command below).
18077
18078@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18079
18080The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
18081
18082@subsubheading Example
18083
18084@smallexample
18085(gdb)
18086-break-condition 1 1
18087^done
18088(gdb)
18089-break-list
18090^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18091hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18092@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18093@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18094@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18095@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18096@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18097body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18098addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18099line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
18100(gdb)
18101@end smallexample
18102
18103@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18104@findex -break-delete
18105
18106@subsubheading Synopsis
18107
18108@smallexample
18109 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18110@end smallexample
18111
18112Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18113list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18114
18115@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18116
18117The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18118
18119@subsubheading Example
18120
18121@smallexample
18122(gdb)
18123-break-delete 1
18124^done
18125(gdb)
18126-break-list
18127^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18128hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18129@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18130@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18131@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18132@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18133@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18134body=[]@}
18135(gdb)
18136@end smallexample
18137
18138@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18139@findex -break-disable
18140
18141@subsubheading Synopsis
18142
18143@smallexample
18144 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18145@end smallexample
18146
18147Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18148break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18149
18150@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18151
18152The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18153
18154@subsubheading Example
18155
18156@smallexample
18157(gdb)
18158-break-disable 2
18159^done
18160(gdb)
18161-break-list
18162^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18163hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18164@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18165@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18166@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18167@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18168@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18169body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18170addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18171line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18172(gdb)
18173@end smallexample
18174
18175@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18176@findex -break-enable
18177
18178@subsubheading Synopsis
18179
18180@smallexample
18181 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18182@end smallexample
18183
18184Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18185
18186@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18187
18188The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18189
18190@subsubheading Example
18191
18192@smallexample
18193(gdb)
18194-break-enable 2
18195^done
18196(gdb)
18197-break-list
18198^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18199hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18200@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18201@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18202@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18203@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18204@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18205body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18206addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18207line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18208(gdb)
18209@end smallexample
18210
18211@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18212@findex -break-info
18213
18214@subsubheading Synopsis
18215
18216@smallexample
18217 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18218@end smallexample
18219
18220@c REDUNDANT???
18221Get information about a single breakpoint.
18222
18223@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18224
18225The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18226
18227@subsubheading Example
18228N.A.
18229
18230@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18231@findex -break-insert
18232
18233@subsubheading Synopsis
18234
18235@smallexample
18236 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ]
18237 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18238 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
18239@end smallexample
18240
18241@noindent
18242If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
18243
18244@itemize @bullet
18245@item function
18246@c @item +offset
18247@c @item -offset
18248@c @item linenum
18249@item filename:linenum
18250@item filename:function
18251@item *address
18252@end itemize
18253
18254The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18255
18256@table @samp
18257@item -t
18258Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18259@item -h
18260Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18261@item -c @var{condition}
18262Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18263@item -i @var{ignore-count}
18264Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18265@item -f
18266If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
18267refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
18268breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
18269an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
18270cannot be parsed.
18271@end table
18272
18273@subsubheading Result
18274
18275The result is in the form:
18276
18277@smallexample
18278^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18279enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18280fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18281times="@var{times}"@}
18282@end smallexample
18283
18284@noindent
18285where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18286@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18287inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18288this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18289and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18290(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18291which use the same output).
18292
18293Note: this format is open to change.
18294@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18295
18296@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18297
18298The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18299@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18300
18301@subsubheading Example
18302
18303@smallexample
18304(gdb)
18305-break-insert main
18306^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18307fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18308(gdb)
18309-break-insert -t foo
18310^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18311fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18312(gdb)
18313-break-list
18314^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18315hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18316@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18317@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18318@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18319@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18320@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18321body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18322addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18323fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18324bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18325addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18326fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18327(gdb)
18328-break-insert -r foo.*
18329~int foo(int, int);
18330^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18331"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18332(gdb)
18333@end smallexample
18334
18335@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18336@findex -break-list
18337
18338@subsubheading Synopsis
18339
18340@smallexample
18341 -break-list
18342@end smallexample
18343
18344Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18345
18346@table @samp
18347@item Number
18348number of the breakpoint
18349@item Type
18350type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18351@item Disposition
18352should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18353or @samp{nokeep}
18354@item Enabled
18355is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18356@item Address
18357memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18358@item What
18359logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18360name, line number
18361@item Times
18362number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18363@end table
18364
18365If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18366@code{body} field is an empty list.
18367
18368@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18369
18370The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18371
18372@subsubheading Example
18373
18374@smallexample
18375(gdb)
18376-break-list
18377^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18378hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18379@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18380@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18381@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18382@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18383@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18384body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18385addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18386bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18387addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18388line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18389(gdb)
18390@end smallexample
18391
18392Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18393
18394@smallexample
18395(gdb)
18396-break-list
18397^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18398hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18399@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18400@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18401@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18402@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18403@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18404body=[]@}
18405(gdb)
18406@end smallexample
18407
18408@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18409@findex -break-watch
18410
18411@subsubheading Synopsis
18412
18413@smallexample
18414 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18415@end smallexample
18416
18417Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18418@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18419read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18420option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
18421trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18422either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18423i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18424@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
18425
18426Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18427breakpoints inserted.
18428
18429@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18430
18431The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18432@samp{rwatch}.
18433
18434@subsubheading Example
18435
18436Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18437
18438@smallexample
18439(gdb)
18440-break-watch x
18441^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18442(gdb)
18443-exec-continue
18444^running
18445(gdb)
18446*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18447value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18448frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18449fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18450(gdb)
18451@end smallexample
18452
18453Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18454the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18455for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18456
18457@smallexample
18458(gdb)
18459-break-watch C
18460^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18461(gdb)
18462-exec-continue
18463^running
18464(gdb)
18465*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18466wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18467frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18468file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18469fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18470(gdb)
18471-exec-continue
18472^running
18473(gdb)
18474*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18475frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18476value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18477file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18478fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18479(gdb)
18480@end smallexample
18481
18482Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18483execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18484deleted.
18485
18486@smallexample
18487(gdb)
18488-break-watch C
18489^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18490(gdb)
18491-break-list
18492^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18493hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18494@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18495@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18496@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18497@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18498@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18499body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18500addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18501file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18502fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18503bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18504enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18505(gdb)
18506-exec-continue
18507^running
18508(gdb)
18509*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18510value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18511frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18512file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18513fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18514(gdb)
18515-break-list
18516^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18517hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18518@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18519@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18520@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18521@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18522@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18523body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18524addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18525file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18526fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18527bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18528enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18529(gdb)
18530-exec-continue
18531^running
18532^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18533frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18534value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18535file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18536fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18537(gdb)
18538-break-list
18539^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18540hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18541@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18542@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18543@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18544@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18545@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18546body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18547addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18548file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18549fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18550times="1"@}]@}
18551(gdb)
18552@end smallexample
18553
18554@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18555@node GDB/MI Program Context
18556@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18557
18558@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18559@findex -exec-arguments
18560
18561
18562@subsubheading Synopsis
18563
18564@smallexample
18565 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18566@end smallexample
18567
18568Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18569@samp{-exec-run}.
18570
18571@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18572
18573The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18574
18575@subsubheading Example
18576
18577@c FIXME!
18578Don't have one around.
18579
18580
18581@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18582@findex -exec-show-arguments
18583
18584@subsubheading Synopsis
18585
18586@smallexample
18587 -exec-show-arguments
18588@end smallexample
18589
18590Print the arguments of the program.
18591
18592@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18593
18594The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18595
18596@subsubheading Example
18597N.A.
18598
18599
18600@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18601@findex -environment-cd
18602
18603@subsubheading Synopsis
18604
18605@smallexample
18606 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18607@end smallexample
18608
18609Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18610
18611@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18612
18613The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18614
18615@subsubheading Example
18616
18617@smallexample
18618(gdb)
18619-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18620^done
18621(gdb)
18622@end smallexample
18623
18624
18625@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18626@findex -environment-directory
18627
18628@subsubheading Synopsis
18629
18630@smallexample
18631 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18632@end smallexample
18633
18634Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18635If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18636search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18637@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18638occurs as normal.
18639Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18640multiple directories in a single command
18641results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18642search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18643If blanks are needed as
18644part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18645the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18646by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18647character must not be used
18648in any directory name.
18649If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18650
18651@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18652
18653The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18654
18655@subsubheading Example
18656
18657@smallexample
18658(gdb)
18659-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18660^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18661(gdb)
18662-environment-directory ""
18663^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18664(gdb)
18665-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18666^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18667(gdb)
18668-environment-directory -r
18669^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18670(gdb)
18671@end smallexample
18672
18673
18674@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18675@findex -environment-path
18676
18677@subsubheading Synopsis
18678
18679@smallexample
18680 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18681@end smallexample
18682
18683Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18684If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18685search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18686supplied in addition to the
18687@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18688occurs as normal.
18689Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18690multiple directories in a single command
18691results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18692search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18693If blanks are needed as
18694part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18695the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18696by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18697character must not be used
18698in any directory name.
18699If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18700
18701
18702@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18703
18704The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18705
18706@subsubheading Example
18707
18708@smallexample
18709(gdb)
18710-environment-path
18711^done,path="/usr/bin"
18712(gdb)
18713-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18714^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18715(gdb)
18716-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18717^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18718(gdb)
18719@end smallexample
18720
18721
18722@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18723@findex -environment-pwd
18724
18725@subsubheading Synopsis
18726
18727@smallexample
18728 -environment-pwd
18729@end smallexample
18730
18731Show the current working directory.
18732
18733@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18734
18735The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18736
18737@subsubheading Example
18738
18739@smallexample
18740(gdb)
18741-environment-pwd
18742^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18743(gdb)
18744@end smallexample
18745
18746@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18747@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18748@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18749
18750
18751@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18752@findex -thread-info
18753
18754@subsubheading Synopsis
18755
18756@smallexample
18757 -thread-info
18758@end smallexample
18759
18760@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18761
18762No equivalent.
18763
18764@subsubheading Example
18765N.A.
18766
18767
18768@subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18769@findex -thread-list-all-threads
18770
18771@subsubheading Synopsis
18772
18773@smallexample
18774 -thread-list-all-threads
18775@end smallexample
18776
18777@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18778
18779The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18780
18781@subsubheading Example
18782N.A.
18783
18784
18785@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18786@findex -thread-list-ids
18787
18788@subsubheading Synopsis
18789
18790@smallexample
18791 -thread-list-ids
18792@end smallexample
18793
18794Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18795end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18796
18797@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18798
18799Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18800
18801@subsubheading Example
18802
18803No threads present, besides the main process:
18804
18805@smallexample
18806(gdb)
18807-thread-list-ids
18808^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18809(gdb)
18810@end smallexample
18811
18812
18813Several threads:
18814
18815@smallexample
18816(gdb)
18817-thread-list-ids
18818^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18819number-of-threads="3"
18820(gdb)
18821@end smallexample
18822
18823
18824@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18825@findex -thread-select
18826
18827@subsubheading Synopsis
18828
18829@smallexample
18830 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18831@end smallexample
18832
18833Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18834current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18835
18836@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18837
18838The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18839
18840@subsubheading Example
18841
18842@smallexample
18843(gdb)
18844-exec-next
18845^running
18846(gdb)
18847*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18848file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18849(gdb)
18850-thread-list-ids
18851^done,
18852thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18853number-of-threads="3"
18854(gdb)
18855-thread-select 3
18856^done,new-thread-id="3",
18857frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18858args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18859@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18860(gdb)
18861@end smallexample
18862
18863@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18864@node GDB/MI Program Execution
18865@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18866
18867These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18868record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18869asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18870other cases.
18871
18872@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18873@findex -exec-continue
18874
18875@subsubheading Synopsis
18876
18877@smallexample
18878 -exec-continue
18879@end smallexample
18880
18881Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18882encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18883
18884@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18885
18886The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18887
18888@subsubheading Example
18889
18890@smallexample
18891-exec-continue
18892^running
18893(gdb)
18894@@Hello world
18895*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18896file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18897(gdb)
18898@end smallexample
18899
18900
18901@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18902@findex -exec-finish
18903
18904@subsubheading Synopsis
18905
18906@smallexample
18907 -exec-finish
18908@end smallexample
18909
18910Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18911function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18912
18913@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18914
18915The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18916
18917@subsubheading Example
18918
18919Function returning @code{void}.
18920
18921@smallexample
18922-exec-finish
18923^running
18924(gdb)
18925@@hello from foo
18926*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18927file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18928(gdb)
18929@end smallexample
18930
18931Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18932@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18933value itself.
18934
18935@smallexample
18936-exec-finish
18937^running
18938(gdb)
18939*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18940args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18941file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18942gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18943(gdb)
18944@end smallexample
18945
18946
18947@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18948@findex -exec-interrupt
18949
18950@subsubheading Synopsis
18951
18952@smallexample
18953 -exec-interrupt
18954@end smallexample
18955
18956Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18957associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18958that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18959appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18960interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18961
18962@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18963
18964The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18965
18966@subsubheading Example
18967
18968@smallexample
18969(gdb)
18970111-exec-continue
18971111^running
18972
18973(gdb)
18974222-exec-interrupt
18975222^done
18976(gdb)
18977111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18978frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18979fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18980(gdb)
18981
18982(gdb)
18983-exec-interrupt
18984^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18985(gdb)
18986@end smallexample
18987
18988
18989@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18990@findex -exec-next
18991
18992@subsubheading Synopsis
18993
18994@smallexample
18995 -exec-next
18996@end smallexample
18997
18998Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18999of the next source line is reached.
19000
19001@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19002
19003The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
19004
19005@subsubheading Example
19006
19007@smallexample
19008-exec-next
19009^running
19010(gdb)
19011*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
19012(gdb)
19013@end smallexample
19014
19015
19016@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
19017@findex -exec-next-instruction
19018
19019@subsubheading Synopsis
19020
19021@smallexample
19022 -exec-next-instruction
19023@end smallexample
19024
19025Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
19026call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
19027instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
19028printed as well.
19029
19030@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19031
19032The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
19033
19034@subsubheading Example
19035
19036@smallexample
19037(gdb)
19038-exec-next-instruction
19039^running
19040
19041(gdb)
19042*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19043addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
19044(gdb)
19045@end smallexample
19046
19047
19048@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
19049@findex -exec-return
19050
19051@subsubheading Synopsis
19052
19053@smallexample
19054 -exec-return
19055@end smallexample
19056
19057Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
19058Displays the new current frame.
19059
19060@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19061
19062The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
19063
19064@subsubheading Example
19065
19066@smallexample
19067(gdb)
19068200-break-insert callee4
19069200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
19070file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19071(gdb)
19072000-exec-run
19073000^running
19074(gdb)
19075000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19076frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
19077file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19078fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
19079(gdb)
19080205-break-delete
19081205^done
19082(gdb)
19083111-exec-return
19084111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
19085args=[@{name="strarg",
19086value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
19087file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19088fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
19089(gdb)
19090@end smallexample
19091
19092
19093@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
19094@findex -exec-run
19095
19096@subsubheading Synopsis
19097
19098@smallexample
19099 -exec-run
19100@end smallexample
19101
19102Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
19103executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
19104exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
19105the program has exited exceptionally.
19106
19107@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19108
19109The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19110
19111@subsubheading Examples
19112
19113@smallexample
19114(gdb)
19115-break-insert main
19116^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19117(gdb)
19118-exec-run
19119^running
19120(gdb)
19121*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19122frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19123fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19124(gdb)
19125@end smallexample
19126
19127@noindent
19128Program exited normally:
19129
19130@smallexample
19131(gdb)
19132-exec-run
19133^running
19134(gdb)
19135x = 55
19136*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19137(gdb)
19138@end smallexample
19139
19140@noindent
19141Program exited exceptionally:
19142
19143@smallexample
19144(gdb)
19145-exec-run
19146^running
19147(gdb)
19148x = 55
19149*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19150(gdb)
19151@end smallexample
19152
19153Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19154@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19155
19156@smallexample
19157(gdb)
19158*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19159signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19160@end smallexample
19161
19162
19163@c @subheading -exec-signal
19164
19165
19166@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19167@findex -exec-step
19168
19169@subsubheading Synopsis
19170
19171@smallexample
19172 -exec-step
19173@end smallexample
19174
19175Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19176of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19177function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19178function.
19179
19180@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19181
19182The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19183
19184@subsubheading Example
19185
19186Stepping into a function:
19187
19188@smallexample
19189-exec-step
19190^running
19191(gdb)
19192*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19193frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19194@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19195fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19196(gdb)
19197@end smallexample
19198
19199Regular stepping:
19200
19201@smallexample
19202-exec-step
19203^running
19204(gdb)
19205*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19206(gdb)
19207@end smallexample
19208
19209
19210@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19211@findex -exec-step-instruction
19212
19213@subsubheading Synopsis
19214
19215@smallexample
19216 -exec-step-instruction
19217@end smallexample
19218
19219Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19220output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19221we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19222case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19223well.
19224
19225@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19226
19227The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19228
19229@subsubheading Example
19230
19231@smallexample
19232(gdb)
19233-exec-step-instruction
19234^running
19235
19236(gdb)
19237*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19238frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19239fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19240(gdb)
19241-exec-step-instruction
19242^running
19243
19244(gdb)
19245*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19246frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19247fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19248(gdb)
19249@end smallexample
19250
19251
19252@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19253@findex -exec-until
19254
19255@subsubheading Synopsis
19256
19257@smallexample
19258 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19259@end smallexample
19260
19261Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19262argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19263until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19264reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19265
19266@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19267
19268The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19269
19270@subsubheading Example
19271
19272@smallexample
19273(gdb)
19274-exec-until recursive2.c:6
19275^running
19276(gdb)
19277x = 55
19278*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19279file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19280(gdb)
19281@end smallexample
19282
19283@ignore
19284@subheading -file-clear
19285Is this going away????
19286@end ignore
19287
19288@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19289@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19290@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19291
19292
19293@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19294@findex -stack-info-frame
19295
19296@subsubheading Synopsis
19297
19298@smallexample
19299 -stack-info-frame
19300@end smallexample
19301
19302Get info on the selected frame.
19303
19304@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19305
19306The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19307(without arguments).
19308
19309@subsubheading Example
19310
19311@smallexample
19312(gdb)
19313-stack-info-frame
19314^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19315file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19316fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19317(gdb)
19318@end smallexample
19319
19320@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19321@findex -stack-info-depth
19322
19323@subsubheading Synopsis
19324
19325@smallexample
19326 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19327@end smallexample
19328
19329Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19330is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19331
19332@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19333
19334There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19335
19336@subsubheading Example
19337
19338For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19339
19340@smallexample
19341(gdb)
19342-stack-info-depth
19343^done,depth="12"
19344(gdb)
19345-stack-info-depth 4
19346^done,depth="4"
19347(gdb)
19348-stack-info-depth 12
19349^done,depth="12"
19350(gdb)
19351-stack-info-depth 11
19352^done,depth="11"
19353(gdb)
19354-stack-info-depth 13
19355^done,depth="12"
19356(gdb)
19357@end smallexample
19358
19359@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19360@findex -stack-list-arguments
19361
19362@subsubheading Synopsis
19363
19364@smallexample
19365 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19366 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19367@end smallexample
19368
19369Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19370and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19371@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19372call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19373at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19374larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19375@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19376which case only existing frames will be returned.
19377
19378The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
193790 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19380means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19381
19382@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19383
19384@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19385@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19386functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19387
19388@subsubheading Example
19389
19390@smallexample
19391(gdb)
19392-stack-list-frames
19393^done,
19394stack=[
19395frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19396file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19397fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19398frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19399file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19400fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19401frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19402file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19403fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19404frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19405file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19406fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19407frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19408file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19409fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19410(gdb)
19411-stack-list-arguments 0
19412^done,
19413stack-args=[
19414frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19415frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19416frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19417frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19418frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19419(gdb)
19420-stack-list-arguments 1
19421^done,
19422stack-args=[
19423frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19424frame=@{level="1",
19425 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19426frame=@{level="2",args=[
19427@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19428@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19429@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19430@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19431@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19432@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19433frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19434(gdb)
19435-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19436^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19437(gdb)
19438-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19439^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19440args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19441@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19442(gdb)
19443@end smallexample
19444
19445@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19446
19447
19448@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19449@findex -stack-list-frames
19450
19451@subsubheading Synopsis
19452
19453@smallexample
19454 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19455@end smallexample
19456
19457List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19458following info:
19459
19460@table @samp
19461@item @var{level}
19462The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19463@item @var{addr}
19464The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19465@item @var{func}
19466Function name.
19467@item @var{file}
19468File name of the source file where the function lives.
19469@item @var{line}
19470Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19471@end table
19472
19473If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19474whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19475levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19476are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19477an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19478frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19479actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19480
19481@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19482
19483The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19484
19485@subsubheading Example
19486
19487Full stack backtrace:
19488
19489@smallexample
19490(gdb)
19491-stack-list-frames
19492^done,stack=
19493[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19494 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19495frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19496 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19497frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19498 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19499frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19500 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19501frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19502 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19503frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19504 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19505frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19506 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19507frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19508 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19509frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19510 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19511frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19512 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19513frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19514 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19515frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19516 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19517(gdb)
19518@end smallexample
19519
19520Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19521
19522@smallexample
19523(gdb)
19524-stack-list-frames 3 5
19525^done,stack=
19526[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19527 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19528frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19529 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19530frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19531 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19532(gdb)
19533@end smallexample
19534
19535Show a single frame:
19536
19537@smallexample
19538(gdb)
19539-stack-list-frames 3 3
19540^done,stack=
19541[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19542 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19543(gdb)
19544@end smallexample
19545
19546
19547@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19548@findex -stack-list-locals
19549
19550@subsubheading Synopsis
19551
19552@smallexample
19553 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19554@end smallexample
19555
19556Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19557@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19558the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19559values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19560type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19561structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19562display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19563other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19564more detail.
19565
19566@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19567
19568@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19569
19570@subsubheading Example
19571
19572@smallexample
19573(gdb)
19574-stack-list-locals 0
19575^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19576(gdb)
19577-stack-list-locals --all-values
19578^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19579 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19580-stack-list-locals --simple-values
19581^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19582 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19583(gdb)
19584@end smallexample
19585
19586
19587@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19588@findex -stack-select-frame
19589
19590@subsubheading Synopsis
19591
19592@smallexample
19593 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19594@end smallexample
19595
19596Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19597the stack.
19598
19599@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19600
19601The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19602@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19603
19604@subsubheading Example
19605
19606@smallexample
19607(gdb)
19608-stack-select-frame 2
19609^done
19610(gdb)
19611@end smallexample
19612
19613@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19614@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19615@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19616
19617@ignore
19618
19619@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19620
19621For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19622expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19623used by @code{Insight}.
19624
19625The two main reasons for that are:
19626
19627@enumerate 1
19628@item
19629It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19630
19631@item
19632It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19633now).
19634@end enumerate
19635
19636The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19637slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19638describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19639hints about their use.
19640
19641@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19642expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19643least, the following operations:
19644
19645@itemize @bullet
19646@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19647@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19648@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19649@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19650@end itemize
19651
19652@end ignore
19653
19654@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19655
19656@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19657
19658Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19659changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19660work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19661simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19662is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19663frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19664expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19665expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19666variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19667operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19668object, or to change display format.
19669
19670Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19671that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19672a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19673element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19674children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19675leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
19676objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
19677is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
19678child will be created.
19679
19680For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19681string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19682obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19683that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19684contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19685
19686A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19687the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19688variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19689operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19690be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
19691objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
19692real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
19693variables that frontend has created.
19694
19695The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
19696might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
19697and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
19698relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
19699to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
19700visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
19701called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
19702implicitly updated.
19703
19704The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19705access this functionality:
19706
19707@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19708@item @strong{Operation}
19709@tab @strong{Description}
19710
19711@item @code{-var-create}
19712@tab create a variable object
19713@item @code{-var-delete}
19714@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19715@item @code{-var-set-format}
19716@tab set the display format of this variable
19717@item @code{-var-show-format}
19718@tab show the display format of this variable
19719@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19720@tab tells how many children this object has
19721@item @code{-var-list-children}
19722@tab return a list of the object's children
19723@item @code{-var-info-type}
19724@tab show the type of this variable object
19725@item @code{-var-info-expression}
19726@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
19727@item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
19728@tab print full expression that this variable object represents
19729@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19730@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19731@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19732@tab get the value of this variable
19733@item @code{-var-assign}
19734@tab set the value of this variable
19735@item @code{-var-update}
19736@tab update the variable and its children
19737@item @code{-var-set-frozen}
19738@tab set frozeness attribute
19739@end multitable
19740
19741In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19742how it can be used.
19743
19744@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19745
19746@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19747@findex -var-create
19748
19749@subsubheading Synopsis
19750
19751@smallexample
19752 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19753 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19754@end smallexample
19755
19756This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19757a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19758register.
19759
19760The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19761referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19762system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19763unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19764The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19765
19766The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19767specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19768frame should be used.
19769
19770@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19771begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19772
19773@itemize @bullet
19774@item
19775@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19776
19777@item
19778@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19779
19780@item
19781@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19782@end itemize
19783
19784@subsubheading Result
19785
19786This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19787object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19788the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19789
19790@smallexample
19791 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19792@end smallexample
19793
19794
19795@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19796@findex -var-delete
19797
19798@subsubheading Synopsis
19799
19800@smallexample
19801 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19802@end smallexample
19803
19804Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19805With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19806
19807Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19808
19809
19810@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19811@findex -var-set-format
19812
19813@subsubheading Synopsis
19814
19815@smallexample
19816 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19817@end smallexample
19818
19819Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19820@var{format-spec}.
19821
19822The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19823
19824@smallexample
19825 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19826 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19827@end smallexample
19828
19829The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19830based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19831for pointers, etc.).
19832
19833For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19834variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19835
19836@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19837@findex -var-show-format
19838
19839@subsubheading Synopsis
19840
19841@smallexample
19842 -var-show-format @var{name}
19843@end smallexample
19844
19845Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19846
19847@smallexample
19848 @var{format} @expansion{}
19849 @var{format-spec}
19850@end smallexample
19851
19852
19853@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19854@findex -var-info-num-children
19855
19856@subsubheading Synopsis
19857
19858@smallexample
19859 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19860@end smallexample
19861
19862Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19863
19864@smallexample
19865 numchild=@var{n}
19866@end smallexample
19867
19868
19869@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19870@findex -var-list-children
19871
19872@subsubheading Synopsis
19873
19874@smallexample
19875 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19876@end smallexample
19877@anchor{-var-list-children}
19878
19879Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19880create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19881a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19882@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19883@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19884values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19885value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19886and unions.
19887
19888@subsubheading Example
19889
19890@smallexample
19891(gdb)
19892 -var-list-children n
19893 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19894 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19895(gdb)
19896 -var-list-children --all-values n
19897 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19898 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19899@end smallexample
19900
19901
19902@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19903@findex -var-info-type
19904
19905@subsubheading Synopsis
19906
19907@smallexample
19908 -var-info-type @var{name}
19909@end smallexample
19910
19911Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19912returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19913@value{GDBN} CLI:
19914
19915@smallexample
19916 type=@var{typename}
19917@end smallexample
19918
19919
19920@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19921@findex -var-info-expression
19922
19923@subsubheading Synopsis
19924
19925@smallexample
19926 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19927@end smallexample
19928
19929Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
19930variable object in user interface. The string is generally
19931not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
19932
19933For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
19934@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
19935
19936@smallexample
19937(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
19938^done,lang="C",exp="1"
19939@end smallexample
19940
19941@noindent
19942Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19943
19944Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
19945includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
19946is of limited use.
19947
19948@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
19949@findex -var-info-path-expression
19950
19951@subsubheading Synopsis
19952
19953@smallexample
19954 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
19955@end smallexample
19956
19957Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
19958context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
19959Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
19960result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
19961the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
19962watchpoint from a variable object.
19963
19964For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
19965@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
19966@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
19967@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
19968@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
19969@smallexample
19970(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
19971^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
19972@end smallexample
19973
19974@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19975@findex -var-show-attributes
19976
19977@subsubheading Synopsis
19978
19979@smallexample
19980 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19981@end smallexample
19982
19983List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19984
19985@smallexample
19986 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19987@end smallexample
19988
19989@noindent
19990where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19991
19992@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19993@findex -var-evaluate-expression
19994
19995@subsubheading Synopsis
19996
19997@smallexample
19998 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19999@end smallexample
20000
20001Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
20002object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
20003string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
20004
20005@smallexample
20006 value=@var{value}
20007@end smallexample
20008
20009Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
20010before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
20011
20012@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
20013@findex -var-assign
20014
20015@subsubheading Synopsis
20016
20017@smallexample
20018 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
20019@end smallexample
20020
20021Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
20022by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
20023value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
20024subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
20025
20026@subsubheading Example
20027
20028@smallexample
20029(gdb)
20030-var-assign var1 3
20031^done,value="3"
20032(gdb)
20033-var-update *
20034^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
20035(gdb)
20036@end smallexample
20037
20038@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
20039@findex -var-update
20040
20041@subsubheading Synopsis
20042
20043@smallexample
20044 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
20045@end smallexample
20046
20047Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
20048@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
20049list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
20050be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
20051@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
20052@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
20053object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
20054for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
20055@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
20056names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
20057as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
20058recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
20059number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
20060
20061
20062@subsubheading Example
20063
20064@smallexample
20065(gdb)
20066-var-assign var1 3
20067^done,value="3"
20068(gdb)
20069-var-update --all-values var1
20070^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
20071type_changed="false"@}]
20072(gdb)
20073@end smallexample
20074
20075@anchor{-var-update}
20076The field in_scope may take three values:
20077
20078@table @code
20079@item "true"
20080The variable object's current value is valid.
20081
20082@item "false"
20083The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
20084hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
20085scope.
20086
20087@item "invalid"
20088The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
20089This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
20090either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
20091command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
20092objects.
20093@end table
20094
20095In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
20096be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
20097
20098@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
20099@findex -var-set-frozen
20100@anchor{-var-set-frozen}
20101
20102@subsubheading Synopsis
20103
20104@smallexample
20105 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
20106@end smallexample
20107
20108Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
20109@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
20110frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
20111frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
20112implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
20113a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
20114@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
20115values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
20116implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
20117Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
20118@code{-var-update} does.
20119
20120@subsubheading Example
20121
20122@smallexample
20123(gdb)
20124-var-set-frozen V 1
20125^done
20126(gdb)
20127@end smallexample
20128
20129
20130@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20131@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
20132@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
20133
20134@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
20135@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
20136This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
20137examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
20138
20139@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
20140@c @subheading -data-assign
20141@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
20142@c @subsubheading GDB Command
20143@c set variable
20144@c @subsubheading Example
20145@c N.A.
20146
20147@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
20148@findex -data-disassemble
20149
20150@subsubheading Synopsis
20151
20152@smallexample
20153 -data-disassemble
20154 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
20155 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
20156 -- @var{mode}
20157@end smallexample
20158
20159@noindent
20160Where:
20161
20162@table @samp
20163@item @var{start-addr}
20164is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
20165@item @var{end-addr}
20166is the end address
20167@item @var{filename}
20168is the name of the file to disassemble
20169@item @var{linenum}
20170is the line number to disassemble around
20171@item @var{lines}
20172is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
20173the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
20174specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
20175@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
20176@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
20177displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
20178@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
20179are displayed.
20180@item @var{mode}
20181is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
20182disassembly).
20183@end table
20184
20185@subsubheading Result
20186
20187The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
20188
20189@itemize @bullet
20190@item Address
20191@item Func-name
20192@item Offset
20193@item Instruction
20194@end itemize
20195
20196Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
20197directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
20198
20199@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20200
20201There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
20202
20203@subsubheading Example
20204
20205Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
20206
20207@smallexample
20208(gdb)
20209-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
20210^done,
20211asm_insns=[
20212@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20213inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20214@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20215inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20216@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
20217inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
20218@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
20219inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20220@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
20221inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
20222(gdb)
20223@end smallexample
20224
20225Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
20226@code{main}.
20227
20228@smallexample
20229-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
20230^done,asm_insns=[
20231@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20232inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20233@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20234inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20235@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20236inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
20237[@dots{}]
20238@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
20239@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
20240(gdb)
20241@end smallexample
20242
20243Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
20244
20245@smallexample
20246(gdb)
20247-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
20248^done,asm_insns=[
20249@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20250inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20251@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20252inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20253@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20254inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20255(gdb)
20256@end smallexample
20257
20258Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20259
20260@smallexample
20261(gdb)
20262-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20263^done,asm_insns=[
20264src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20265file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20266 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20267@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20268inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20269src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20270file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20271 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20272@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20273inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20274@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20275inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20276(gdb)
20277@end smallexample
20278
20279
20280@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20281@findex -data-evaluate-expression
20282
20283@subsubheading Synopsis
20284
20285@smallexample
20286 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20287@end smallexample
20288
20289Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20290inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20291If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20292
20293@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20294
20295The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20296@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20297@samp{gdb_eval} command.
20298
20299@subsubheading Example
20300
20301In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20302@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20303Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20304output.
20305
20306@smallexample
20307211-data-evaluate-expression A
20308211^done,value="1"
20309(gdb)
20310311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20311311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20312(gdb)
20313411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20314411^done,value="4"
20315(gdb)
20316511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20317511^done,value="4"
20318(gdb)
20319@end smallexample
20320
20321
20322@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20323@findex -data-list-changed-registers
20324
20325@subsubheading Synopsis
20326
20327@smallexample
20328 -data-list-changed-registers
20329@end smallexample
20330
20331Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20332
20333@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20334
20335@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20336has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20337
20338@subsubheading Example
20339
20340On a PPC MBX board:
20341
20342@smallexample
20343(gdb)
20344-exec-continue
20345^running
20346
20347(gdb)
20348*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20349args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20350(gdb)
20351-data-list-changed-registers
20352^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20353"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20354"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20355(gdb)
20356@end smallexample
20357
20358
20359@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20360@findex -data-list-register-names
20361
20362@subsubheading Synopsis
20363
20364@smallexample
20365 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20366@end smallexample
20367
20368Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20369are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20370integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20371names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20372consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20373include empty register names.
20374
20375@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20376
20377@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20378@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20379corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20380
20381@subsubheading Example
20382
20383For the PPC MBX board:
20384@smallexample
20385(gdb)
20386-data-list-register-names
20387^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20388"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20389"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20390"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20391"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20392"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20393"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20394(gdb)
20395-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20396^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20397(gdb)
20398@end smallexample
20399
20400@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20401@findex -data-list-register-values
20402
20403@subsubheading Synopsis
20404
20405@smallexample
20406 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20407@end smallexample
20408
20409Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20410which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20411list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20412numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20413
20414Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20415
20416@table @code
20417@item x
20418Hexadecimal
20419@item o
20420Octal
20421@item t
20422Binary
20423@item d
20424Decimal
20425@item r
20426Raw
20427@item N
20428Natural
20429@end table
20430
20431@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20432
20433The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20434all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20435
20436@subsubheading Example
20437
20438For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20439don't appear in the actual output):
20440
20441@smallexample
20442(gdb)
20443-data-list-register-values r 64 65
20444^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20445@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20446(gdb)
20447-data-list-register-values x
20448^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20449@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20450@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20451@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20452@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20453@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20454@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20455@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20456@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20457@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20458@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20459@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20460@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20461@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20462@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20463@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20464@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20465@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20466@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20467@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20468@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20469@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20470@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20471@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20472@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20473@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20474@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20475@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20476@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20477@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20478@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20479@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20480@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20481@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20482@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20483@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20484(gdb)
20485@end smallexample
20486
20487
20488@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20489@findex -data-read-memory
20490
20491@subsubheading Synopsis
20492
20493@smallexample
20494 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20495 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20496 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20497@end smallexample
20498
20499@noindent
20500where:
20501
20502@table @samp
20503@item @var{address}
20504An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20505read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20506quoted using the C convention.
20507
20508@item @var{word-format}
20509The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20510same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20511,Output Formats}).
20512
20513@item @var{word-size}
20514The size of each memory word in bytes.
20515
20516@item @var{nr-rows}
20517The number of rows in the output table.
20518
20519@item @var{nr-cols}
20520The number of columns in the output table.
20521
20522@item @var{aschar}
20523If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20524value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20525member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20526characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20527
20528@item @var{byte-offset}
20529An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20530@end table
20531
20532This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20533@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20534@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20535(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20536of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20537using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20538in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20539@samp{addr}.
20540
20541The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20542@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20543@samp{prev-page}.
20544
20545@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20546
20547The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20548@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20549
20550@subsubheading Example
20551
20552Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20553@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20554word. Display each word in hex.
20555
20556@smallexample
20557(gdb)
205589-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
205599^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20560next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20561prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20562@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20563@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20564@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20565(gdb)
20566@end smallexample
20567
20568Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20569display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20570
20571@smallexample
20572(gdb)
205735-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
205745^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20575next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20576next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20577@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20578(gdb)
20579@end smallexample
20580
20581Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20582as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20583used as the non-printable character.
20584
20585@smallexample
20586(gdb)
205874-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
205884^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20589next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20590next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20591@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20592@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20593@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20594@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20595@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20596@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20597@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20598@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20599(gdb)
20600@end smallexample
20601
20602@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20603@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20604@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20605
20606The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20607
20608@c @subheading -trace-actions
20609
20610@c @subheading -trace-delete
20611
20612@c @subheading -trace-disable
20613
20614@c @subheading -trace-dump
20615
20616@c @subheading -trace-enable
20617
20618@c @subheading -trace-exists
20619
20620@c @subheading -trace-find
20621
20622@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20623
20624@c @subheading -trace-info
20625
20626@c @subheading -trace-insert
20627
20628@c @subheading -trace-list
20629
20630@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20631
20632@c @subheading -trace-save
20633
20634@c @subheading -trace-start
20635
20636@c @subheading -trace-stop
20637
20638
20639@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20640@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20641@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20642
20643
20644@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20645@findex -symbol-info-address
20646
20647@subsubheading Synopsis
20648
20649@smallexample
20650 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20651@end smallexample
20652
20653Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20654
20655@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20656
20657The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20658
20659@subsubheading Example
20660N.A.
20661
20662
20663@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20664@findex -symbol-info-file
20665
20666@subsubheading Synopsis
20667
20668@smallexample
20669 -symbol-info-file
20670@end smallexample
20671
20672Show the file for the symbol.
20673
20674@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20675
20676There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20677@samp{gdb_find_file}.
20678
20679@subsubheading Example
20680N.A.
20681
20682
20683@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20684@findex -symbol-info-function
20685
20686@subsubheading Synopsis
20687
20688@smallexample
20689 -symbol-info-function
20690@end smallexample
20691
20692Show which function the symbol lives in.
20693
20694@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20695
20696@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20697
20698@subsubheading Example
20699N.A.
20700
20701
20702@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20703@findex -symbol-info-line
20704
20705@subsubheading Synopsis
20706
20707@smallexample
20708 -symbol-info-line
20709@end smallexample
20710
20711Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20712
20713@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20714
20715The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20716@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20717
20718@subsubheading Example
20719N.A.
20720
20721
20722@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20723@findex -symbol-info-symbol
20724
20725@subsubheading Synopsis
20726
20727@smallexample
20728 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20729@end smallexample
20730
20731Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20732
20733@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20734
20735The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20736
20737@subsubheading Example
20738N.A.
20739
20740
20741@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20742@findex -symbol-list-functions
20743
20744@subsubheading Synopsis
20745
20746@smallexample
20747 -symbol-list-functions
20748@end smallexample
20749
20750List the functions in the executable.
20751
20752@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20753
20754@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20755@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20756
20757@subsubheading Example
20758N.A.
20759
20760
20761@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20762@findex -symbol-list-lines
20763
20764@subsubheading Synopsis
20765
20766@smallexample
20767 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20768@end smallexample
20769
20770Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20771addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20772ascending PC order.
20773
20774@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20775
20776There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20777
20778@subsubheading Example
20779@smallexample
20780(gdb)
20781-symbol-list-lines basics.c
20782^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20783(gdb)
20784@end smallexample
20785
20786
20787@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20788@findex -symbol-list-types
20789
20790@subsubheading Synopsis
20791
20792@smallexample
20793 -symbol-list-types
20794@end smallexample
20795
20796List all the type names.
20797
20798@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20799
20800The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20801@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20802
20803@subsubheading Example
20804N.A.
20805
20806
20807@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20808@findex -symbol-list-variables
20809
20810@subsubheading Synopsis
20811
20812@smallexample
20813 -symbol-list-variables
20814@end smallexample
20815
20816List all the global and static variable names.
20817
20818@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20819
20820@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20821
20822@subsubheading Example
20823N.A.
20824
20825
20826@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20827@findex -symbol-locate
20828
20829@subsubheading Synopsis
20830
20831@smallexample
20832 -symbol-locate
20833@end smallexample
20834
20835@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20836
20837@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20838
20839@subsubheading Example
20840N.A.
20841
20842
20843@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20844@findex -symbol-type
20845
20846@subsubheading Synopsis
20847
20848@smallexample
20849 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20850@end smallexample
20851
20852Show type of @var{variable}.
20853
20854@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20855
20856The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20857@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20858
20859@subsubheading Example
20860N.A.
20861
20862
20863@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20864@node GDB/MI File Commands
20865@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20866
20867This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20868and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20869
20870@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20871@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20872
20873@subsubheading Synopsis
20874
20875@smallexample
20876 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20877@end smallexample
20878
20879Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20880which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20881command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20882are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20883error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20884notification.
20885
20886@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20887
20888The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20889
20890@subsubheading Example
20891
20892@smallexample
20893(gdb)
20894-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20895^done
20896(gdb)
20897@end smallexample
20898
20899
20900@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20901@findex -file-exec-file
20902
20903@subsubheading Synopsis
20904
20905@smallexample
20906 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20907@end smallexample
20908
20909Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20910@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20911from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20912about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20913notification.
20914
20915@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20916
20917The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20918
20919@subsubheading Example
20920
20921@smallexample
20922(gdb)
20923-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20924^done
20925(gdb)
20926@end smallexample
20927
20928
20929@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20930@findex -file-list-exec-sections
20931
20932@subsubheading Synopsis
20933
20934@smallexample
20935 -file-list-exec-sections
20936@end smallexample
20937
20938List the sections of the current executable file.
20939
20940@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20941
20942The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20943information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20944@samp{gdb_load_info}.
20945
20946@subsubheading Example
20947N.A.
20948
20949
20950@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20951@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20952
20953@subsubheading Synopsis
20954
20955@smallexample
20956 -file-list-exec-source-file
20957@end smallexample
20958
20959List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20960to the current source file for the current executable.
20961
20962@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20963
20964The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20965
20966@subsubheading Example
20967
20968@smallexample
20969(gdb)
20970123-file-list-exec-source-file
20971123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20972(gdb)
20973@end smallexample
20974
20975
20976@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20977@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20978
20979@subsubheading Synopsis
20980
20981@smallexample
20982 -file-list-exec-source-files
20983@end smallexample
20984
20985List the source files for the current executable.
20986
20987It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20988the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20989
20990@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20991
20992The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20993@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20994
20995@subsubheading Example
20996@smallexample
20997(gdb)
20998-file-list-exec-source-files
20999^done,files=[
21000@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
21001@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
21002@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
21003(gdb)
21004@end smallexample
21005
21006@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
21007@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
21008
21009@subsubheading Synopsis
21010
21011@smallexample
21012 -file-list-shared-libraries
21013@end smallexample
21014
21015List the shared libraries in the program.
21016
21017@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21018
21019The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
21020
21021@subsubheading Example
21022N.A.
21023
21024
21025@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
21026@findex -file-list-symbol-files
21027
21028@subsubheading Synopsis
21029
21030@smallexample
21031 -file-list-symbol-files
21032@end smallexample
21033
21034List symbol files.
21035
21036@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21037
21038The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
21039
21040@subsubheading Example
21041N.A.
21042
21043
21044@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
21045@findex -file-symbol-file
21046
21047@subsubheading Synopsis
21048
21049@smallexample
21050 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
21051@end smallexample
21052
21053Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
21054used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
21055produced, except for a completion notification.
21056
21057@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21058
21059The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
21060
21061@subsubheading Example
21062
21063@smallexample
21064(gdb)
21065-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
21066^done
21067(gdb)
21068@end smallexample
21069
21070@ignore
21071@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21072@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
21073@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
21074
21075The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
21076
21077@c @subheading -overlay-auto
21078
21079@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
21080
21081@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
21082
21083@c @subheading -overlay-map
21084
21085@c @subheading -overlay-off
21086
21087@c @subheading -overlay-on
21088
21089@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
21090
21091@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21092@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
21093@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
21094
21095Signal handling commands are not implemented.
21096
21097@c @subheading -signal-handle
21098
21099@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
21100
21101@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
21102@end ignore
21103
21104
21105@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21106@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
21107@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
21108
21109
21110@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
21111@findex -target-attach
21112
21113@subsubheading Synopsis
21114
21115@smallexample
21116 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
21117@end smallexample
21118
21119Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
21120
21121@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21122
21123The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
21124
21125@subsubheading Example
21126N.A.
21127
21128
21129@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
21130@findex -target-compare-sections
21131
21132@subsubheading Synopsis
21133
21134@smallexample
21135 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
21136@end smallexample
21137
21138Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
21139Without the argument, all sections are compared.
21140
21141@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21142
21143The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
21144
21145@subsubheading Example
21146N.A.
21147
21148
21149@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
21150@findex -target-detach
21151
21152@subsubheading Synopsis
21153
21154@smallexample
21155 -target-detach
21156@end smallexample
21157
21158Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
21159There's no output.
21160
21161@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21162
21163The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
21164
21165@subsubheading Example
21166
21167@smallexample
21168(gdb)
21169-target-detach
21170^done
21171(gdb)
21172@end smallexample
21173
21174
21175@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
21176@findex -target-disconnect
21177
21178@subsubheading Synopsis
21179
21180@smallexample
21181 -target-disconnect
21182@end smallexample
21183
21184Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
21185generally not resumed.
21186
21187@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21188
21189The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
21190
21191@subsubheading Example
21192
21193@smallexample
21194(gdb)
21195-target-disconnect
21196^done
21197(gdb)
21198@end smallexample
21199
21200
21201@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
21202@findex -target-download
21203
21204@subsubheading Synopsis
21205
21206@smallexample
21207 -target-download
21208@end smallexample
21209
21210Loads the executable onto the remote target.
21211It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
21212
21213@table @samp
21214@item section
21215The name of the section.
21216@item section-sent
21217The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
21218@item section-size
21219The size of the section.
21220@item total-sent
21221The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
21222@item total-size
21223The size of the overall executable to download.
21224@end table
21225
21226@noindent
21227Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
21228@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
21229
21230In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
21231downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
21232
21233@table @samp
21234@item section
21235The name of the section.
21236@item section-size
21237The size of the section.
21238@item total-size
21239The size of the overall executable to download.
21240@end table
21241
21242@noindent
21243At the end, a summary is printed.
21244
21245@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21246
21247The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
21248
21249@subsubheading Example
21250
21251Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21252have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21253
21254@smallexample
21255(gdb)
21256-target-download
21257+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21258+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21259total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21260+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21261total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21262+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21263total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21264+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21265total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21266+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21267total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21268+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21269total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21270+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21271total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21272+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21273total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21274+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21275total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21276+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21277total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21278+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21279total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21280+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21281total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21282+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21283total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21284+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21285+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21286+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21287+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21288total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21289+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21290total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21291+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21292total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21293+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21294total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21295+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21296total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21297+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21298total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21299^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21300write-rate="429"
21301(gdb)
21302@end smallexample
21303
21304
21305@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21306@findex -target-exec-status
21307
21308@subsubheading Synopsis
21309
21310@smallexample
21311 -target-exec-status
21312@end smallexample
21313
21314Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21315not, for instance).
21316
21317@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21318
21319There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21320
21321@subsubheading Example
21322N.A.
21323
21324
21325@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21326@findex -target-list-available-targets
21327
21328@subsubheading Synopsis
21329
21330@smallexample
21331 -target-list-available-targets
21332@end smallexample
21333
21334List the possible targets to connect to.
21335
21336@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21337
21338The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21339
21340@subsubheading Example
21341N.A.
21342
21343
21344@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21345@findex -target-list-current-targets
21346
21347@subsubheading Synopsis
21348
21349@smallexample
21350 -target-list-current-targets
21351@end smallexample
21352
21353Describe the current target.
21354
21355@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21356
21357The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21358other things).
21359
21360@subsubheading Example
21361N.A.
21362
21363
21364@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21365@findex -target-list-parameters
21366
21367@subsubheading Synopsis
21368
21369@smallexample
21370 -target-list-parameters
21371@end smallexample
21372
21373@c ????
21374
21375@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21376
21377No equivalent.
21378
21379@subsubheading Example
21380N.A.
21381
21382
21383@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21384@findex -target-select
21385
21386@subsubheading Synopsis
21387
21388@smallexample
21389 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21390@end smallexample
21391
21392Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21393
21394@table @samp
21395@item @var{type}
21396The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21397@item @var{parameters}
21398Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21399Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
21400@end table
21401
21402The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21403which the target program is, in the following form:
21404
21405@smallexample
21406^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21407 args=[@var{arg list}]
21408@end smallexample
21409
21410@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21411
21412The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21413
21414@subsubheading Example
21415
21416@smallexample
21417(gdb)
21418-target-select async /dev/ttya
21419^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21420(gdb)
21421@end smallexample
21422
21423@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21424@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
21425@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
21426
21427
21428@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21429@findex -target-file-put
21430
21431@subsubheading Synopsis
21432
21433@smallexample
21434 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21435@end smallexample
21436
21437Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21438@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21439
21440@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21441
21442The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
21443
21444@subsubheading Example
21445
21446@smallexample
21447(gdb)
21448-target-file-put localfile remotefile
21449^done
21450(gdb)
21451@end smallexample
21452
21453
21454@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
21455@findex -target-file-get
21456
21457@subsubheading Synopsis
21458
21459@smallexample
21460 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21461@end smallexample
21462
21463Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21464on the host system.
21465
21466@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21467
21468The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
21469
21470@subsubheading Example
21471
21472@smallexample
21473(gdb)
21474-target-file-get remotefile localfile
21475^done
21476(gdb)
21477@end smallexample
21478
21479
21480@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
21481@findex -target-file-delete
21482
21483@subsubheading Synopsis
21484
21485@smallexample
21486 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
21487@end smallexample
21488
21489Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21490
21491@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21492
21493The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
21494
21495@subsubheading Example
21496
21497@smallexample
21498(gdb)
21499-target-file-delete remotefile
21500^done
21501(gdb)
21502@end smallexample
21503
21504
21505@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21506@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21507@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21508
21509@c @subheading -gdb-complete
21510
21511@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21512@findex -gdb-exit
21513
21514@subsubheading Synopsis
21515
21516@smallexample
21517 -gdb-exit
21518@end smallexample
21519
21520Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21521
21522@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21523
21524Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21525
21526@subsubheading Example
21527
21528@smallexample
21529(gdb)
21530-gdb-exit
21531^exit
21532@end smallexample
21533
21534
21535@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21536@findex -exec-abort
21537
21538@subsubheading Synopsis
21539
21540@smallexample
21541 -exec-abort
21542@end smallexample
21543
21544Kill the inferior running program.
21545
21546@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21547
21548The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21549
21550@subsubheading Example
21551N.A.
21552
21553
21554@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21555@findex -gdb-set
21556
21557@subsubheading Synopsis
21558
21559@smallexample
21560 -gdb-set
21561@end smallexample
21562
21563Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21564@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21565
21566@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21567
21568The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21569
21570@subsubheading Example
21571
21572@smallexample
21573(gdb)
21574-gdb-set $foo=3
21575^done
21576(gdb)
21577@end smallexample
21578
21579
21580@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21581@findex -gdb-show
21582
21583@subsubheading Synopsis
21584
21585@smallexample
21586 -gdb-show
21587@end smallexample
21588
21589Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21590
21591@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21592
21593The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21594
21595@subsubheading Example
21596
21597@smallexample
21598(gdb)
21599-gdb-show annotate
21600^done,value="0"
21601(gdb)
21602@end smallexample
21603
21604@c @subheading -gdb-source
21605
21606
21607@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21608@findex -gdb-version
21609
21610@subsubheading Synopsis
21611
21612@smallexample
21613 -gdb-version
21614@end smallexample
21615
21616Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21617
21618@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21619
21620The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21621default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21622
21623@subsubheading Example
21624
21625@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21626@c box in TeX.
21627@smallexample
21628(gdb)
21629-gdb-version
21630~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21631~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21632~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21633~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21634~ certain conditions.
21635~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21636~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21637~ details.
21638~This GDB was configured as
21639 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21640^done
21641(gdb)
21642@end smallexample
21643
21644@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
21645@findex -list-features
21646
21647Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
21648this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
21649or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
21650important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
21651of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
21652startup.
21653
21654The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
21655available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
21656have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
21657is given below.
21658
21659Example output:
21660
21661@smallexample
21662(gdb) -list-features
21663^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
21664@end smallexample
21665
21666The current list of features is:
21667
21668@itemize @minus
21669@item
21670@samp{frozen-varobjs}---indicates presence of the
21671@code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well as possible presense of the
21672@code{frozen} field in the output of @code{-varobj-create}.
21673@item
21674@samp{pending-breakpoints}---indicates presence of the @code{-f}
21675option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
21676
21677@end itemize
21678
21679@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21680@findex -interpreter-exec
21681
21682@subheading Synopsis
21683
21684@smallexample
21685-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21686@end smallexample
21687@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21688
21689Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21690
21691@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21692
21693The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21694
21695@subheading Example
21696
21697@smallexample
21698(gdb)
21699-interpreter-exec console "break main"
21700&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21701&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21702~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21703^done
21704(gdb)
21705@end smallexample
21706
21707@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21708@findex -inferior-tty-set
21709
21710@subheading Synopsis
21711
21712@smallexample
21713-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21714@end smallexample
21715
21716Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21717
21718@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21719
21720The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21721
21722@subheading Example
21723
21724@smallexample
21725(gdb)
21726-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21727^done
21728(gdb)
21729@end smallexample
21730
21731@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21732@findex -inferior-tty-show
21733
21734@subheading Synopsis
21735
21736@smallexample
21737-inferior-tty-show
21738@end smallexample
21739
21740Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21741
21742@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21743
21744The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21745
21746@subheading Example
21747
21748@smallexample
21749(gdb)
21750-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21751^done
21752(gdb)
21753-inferior-tty-show
21754^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21755(gdb)
21756@end smallexample
21757
21758@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21759@findex -enable-timings
21760
21761@subheading Synopsis
21762
21763@smallexample
21764-enable-timings [yes | no]
21765@end smallexample
21766
21767Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21768command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21769developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21770equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21771
21772@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21773
21774No equivalent.
21775
21776@subheading Example
21777
21778@smallexample
21779(gdb)
21780-enable-timings
21781^done
21782(gdb)
21783-break-insert main
21784^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21785addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21786fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21787time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21788(gdb)
21789-enable-timings no
21790^done
21791(gdb)
21792-exec-run
21793^running
21794(gdb)
21795*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21796frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21797@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21798fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21799(gdb)
21800@end smallexample
21801
21802@node Annotations
21803@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21804
21805This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21806designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21807similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21808relatively high level.
21809
21810The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21811(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21812
21813@ignore
21814This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21815@end ignore
21816
21817@menu
21818* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21819* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
21820* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21821* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21822* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21823* Annotations for Running::
21824 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21825* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21826@end menu
21827
21828@node Annotations Overview
21829@section What is an Annotation?
21830@cindex annotations
21831
21832Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21833characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21834information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21835is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21836information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21837additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21838cannot contain newline characters.
21839
21840Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21841characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21842no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21843@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21844annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21845means those three characters as output.
21846
21847The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21848@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21849how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21850values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21851is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21852subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21853for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21854been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21855Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21856
21857@table @code
21858@kindex set annotate
21859@item set annotate @var{level}
21860The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21861annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21862
21863@item show annotate
21864@kindex show annotate
21865Show the current annotation level.
21866@end table
21867
21868This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21869
21870A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21871
21872@smallexample
21873$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21874GNU gdb 6.0
21875Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21876GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21877and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21878under certain conditions.
21879Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21880There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21881for details.
21882This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21883
21884^Z^Zpre-prompt
21885(@value{GDBP})
21886^Z^Zprompt
21887@kbd{quit}
21888
21889^Z^Zpost-prompt
21890$
21891@end smallexample
21892
21893Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21894@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21895denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21896output from @value{GDBN}.
21897
21898@node Server Prefix
21899@section The Server Prefix
21900@cindex server prefix
21901
21902If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
21903the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
21904command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
21905means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
21906a transparent manner.
21907
21908The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21909history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21910use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21911
21912@node Prompting
21913@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21914
21915@cindex annotations for prompts
21916When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21917to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21918over, etc.
21919
21920Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21921input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21922denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21923annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21924annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21925associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21926features the following annotations:
21927
21928@smallexample
21929^Z^Zpre-prompt
21930^Z^Zprompt
21931^Z^Zpost-prompt
21932@end smallexample
21933
21934The input types are
21935
21936@table @code
21937@findex pre-prompt annotation
21938@findex prompt annotation
21939@findex post-prompt annotation
21940@item prompt
21941When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21942
21943@findex pre-commands annotation
21944@findex commands annotation
21945@findex post-commands annotation
21946@item commands
21947When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21948command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21949
21950@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21951@findex overload-choice annotation
21952@findex post-overload-choice annotation
21953@item overload-choice
21954When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21955
21956@findex pre-query annotation
21957@findex query annotation
21958@findex post-query annotation
21959@item query
21960When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21961
21962@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21963@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21964@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21965@item prompt-for-continue
21966When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21967expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21968prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21969presence of annotations.
21970@end table
21971
21972@node Errors
21973@section Errors
21974@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21975
21976@findex quit annotation
21977@smallexample
21978^Z^Zquit
21979@end smallexample
21980
21981This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21982
21983@findex error annotation
21984@smallexample
21985^Z^Zerror
21986@end smallexample
21987
21988This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21989
21990Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21991in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21992@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21993cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21994cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21995does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21996to the top level.
21997
21998@findex error-begin annotation
21999A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
22000
22001@smallexample
22002^Z^Zerror-begin
22003@end smallexample
22004
22005Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
22006message.
22007
22008Warning messages are not yet annotated.
22009@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
22010@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
22011
22012@node Invalidation
22013@section Invalidation Notices
22014
22015@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
22016The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
22017changed.
22018
22019@table @code
22020@findex frames-invalid annotation
22021@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
22022
22023The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
22024have changed.
22025
22026@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
22027@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
22028
22029The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
22030deleted a breakpoint.
22031@end table
22032
22033@node Annotations for Running
22034@section Running the Program
22035@cindex annotations for running programs
22036
22037@findex starting annotation
22038@findex stopping annotation
22039When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
22040@code{step} or @code{continue},
22041
22042@smallexample
22043^Z^Zstarting
22044@end smallexample
22045
22046is output. When the program stops,
22047
22048@smallexample
22049^Z^Zstopped
22050@end smallexample
22051
22052is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
22053annotations describe how the program stopped.
22054
22055@table @code
22056@findex exited annotation
22057@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
22058The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
22059successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
22060
22061@findex signalled annotation
22062@findex signal-name annotation
22063@findex signal-name-end annotation
22064@findex signal-string annotation
22065@findex signal-string-end annotation
22066@item ^Z^Zsignalled
22067The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
22068annotation continues:
22069
22070@smallexample
22071@var{intro-text}
22072^Z^Zsignal-name
22073@var{name}
22074^Z^Zsignal-name-end
22075@var{middle-text}
22076^Z^Zsignal-string
22077@var{string}
22078^Z^Zsignal-string-end
22079@var{end-text}
22080@end smallexample
22081
22082@noindent
22083where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
22084@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
22085as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
22086@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
22087user's benefit and have no particular format.
22088
22089@findex signal annotation
22090@item ^Z^Zsignal
22091The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
22092just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
22093terminated with it.
22094
22095@findex breakpoint annotation
22096@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
22097The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
22098
22099@findex watchpoint annotation
22100@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
22101The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
22102@end table
22103
22104@node Source Annotations
22105@section Displaying Source
22106@cindex annotations for source display
22107
22108@findex source annotation
22109The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
22110
22111@smallexample
22112^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
22113@end smallexample
22114
22115where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
22116file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
22117first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
22118within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
22119debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
22120@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
22121line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
22122@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
22123source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
22124followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
22125depend on the language).
22126
22127@node GDB Bugs
22128@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
22129@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
22130@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
22131
22132Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
22133
22134Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
22135may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
22136the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
22137reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
22138
22139In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
22140information that enables us to fix the bug.
22141
22142@menu
22143* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
22144* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
22145@end menu
22146
22147@node Bug Criteria
22148@section Have You Found a Bug?
22149@cindex bug criteria
22150
22151If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
22152
22153@itemize @bullet
22154@cindex fatal signal
22155@cindex debugger crash
22156@cindex crash of debugger
22157@item
22158If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
22159@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
22160
22161@cindex error on valid input
22162@item
22163If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
22164bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
22165somewhere in the connection to the target.)
22166
22167@cindex invalid input
22168@item
22169If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
22170that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
22171``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
22172for traditional practice''.
22173
22174@item
22175If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
22176for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
22177@end itemize
22178
22179@node Bug Reporting
22180@section How to Report Bugs
22181@cindex bug reports
22182@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
22183
22184A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
22185If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
22186contact that organization first.
22187
22188You can find contact information for many support companies and
22189individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
22190distribution.
22191@c should add a web page ref...
22192
22193In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
22194@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
22195@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
22196page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
22197be used.
22198
22199@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
22200@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
22201not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
22202@samp{bug-gdb}.
22203
22204The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
22205serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
22206the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
22207newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
22208problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
22209path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
22210we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
22211bug reports to the mailing list.
22212
22213The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
22214@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
22215fact or leave it out, state it!
22216
22217Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
22218problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
22219assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
22220Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
22221stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
22222name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
22223of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
22224the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
22225easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
22226
22227Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
22228bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
22229you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
22230self-contained.
22231
22232Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
22233bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
22234@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
22235bugs properly.
22236
22237To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
22238
22239@itemize @bullet
22240@item
22241The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
22242with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
22243version}.
22244
22245Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
22246the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
22247
22248@item
22249The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
22250version number.
22251
22252@item
22253What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
22254``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
22255
22256@item
22257What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
22258debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
22259C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
22260to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
22261those compilers.
22262
22263@item
22264The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
22265observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
22266you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
22267Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
22268
22269If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
22270and then we might not encounter the bug.
22271
22272@item
22273A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
22274reproduce the bug.
22275
22276@item
22277A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
22278incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
22279
22280Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
22281will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
22282not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
22283a chance to make a mistake.
22284
22285Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
22286say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
22287copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
22288the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
22289crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
22290ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
22291us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
22292to draw any conclusion from our observations.
22293
22294@pindex script
22295@cindex recording a session script
22296To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
22297such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
22298Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
22299include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
22300
22301Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
22302inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
22303
22304@item
22305If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
22306diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
22307it by context, not by line number.
22308
22309The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
22310sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
22311
22312@end itemize
22313
22314Here are some things that are not necessary:
22315
22316@itemize @bullet
22317@item
22318A description of the envelope of the bug.
22319
22320Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
22321which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
22322changes will not affect it.
22323
22324This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
22325will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
22326with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
22327We recommend that you save your time for something else.
22328
22329Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
22330of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
22331output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
22332less time, and so on.
22333
22334However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
22335report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
22336
22337@item
22338A patch for the bug.
22339
22340A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
22341the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
22342a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
22343to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
22344
22345Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
22346construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
22347through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
22348to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
22349
22350And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
22351patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
22352help us to understand.
22353
22354@item
22355A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
22356
22357Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
22358things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
22359@end itemize
22360
22361@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
22362@c and consists of the two following files:
22363@c rluser.texinfo
22364@c inc-hist.texinfo
22365@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
22366@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
22367@include rluser.texi
22368@include inc-hist.texinfo
22369
22370
22371@node Formatting Documentation
22372@appendix Formatting Documentation
22373
22374@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
22375@cindex reference card
22376The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
22377for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
22378subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
22379@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
22380release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
22381you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
22382
22383The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
22384can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
22385
22386@smallexample
22387make refcard.dvi
22388@end smallexample
22389
22390The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
22391mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
22392that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
22393high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
22394your @sc{dvi} output program.
22395
22396@cindex documentation
22397
22398All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
22399distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
22400a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
22401on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
22402formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
22403and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
22404
22405@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
22406version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
22407file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
22408subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
22409necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
22410but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
22411Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
22412@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
22413
22414If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
22415Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
22416@code{makeinfo}.
22417
22418If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
22419@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
22420version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
22421
22422@smallexample
22423cd gdb
22424make gdb.info
22425@end smallexample
22426
22427If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22428a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22429Texinfo definitions file.
22430
22431@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22432produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22433document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22434has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22435command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22436(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22437require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22438
22439@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22440@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22441written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22442typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22443and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22444directory.
22445
22446If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22447typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
22448subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22449@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22450
22451@smallexample
22452make gdb.dvi
22453@end smallexample
22454
22455Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22456
22457@node Installing GDB
22458@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22459@cindex installation
22460
22461@menu
22462* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22463* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
22464* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22465* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22466* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22467@end menu
22468
22469@node Requirements
22470@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
22471@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22472
22473Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22474Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22475
22476@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
22477@table @asis
22478@item ISO C90 compiler
22479@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22480working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22481
22482@end table
22483
22484@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
22485@table @asis
22486@item Expat
22487@anchor{Expat}
22488@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22489included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22490can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22491The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
22492standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22493use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22494
22495Expat is used for:
22496
22497@itemize @bullet
22498@item
22499Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
22500@item
22501Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
22502@item
22503Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
22504@item
22505MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
22506@end itemize
22507
22508@end table
22509
22510@node Running Configure
22511@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
22512@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22513@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
22514of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22515build the @code{gdb} program.
22516@iftex
22517@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22518@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22519look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22520installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22521@end iftex
22522
22523The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22524@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22525appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22526
22527For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22528@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22529
22530@table @code
22531@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22532script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22533
22534@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22535the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22536
22537@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22538source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22539
22540@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22541@sc{gnu} include files
22542
22543@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22544source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22545
22546@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22547source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22548
22549@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22550source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22551
22552@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22553source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22554
22555@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22556source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22557@end table
22558
22559The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
22560from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22561this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22562
22563First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22564if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
22565identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22566argument.
22567
22568For example:
22569
22570@smallexample
22571cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22572./configure @var{host}
22573make
22574@end smallexample
22575
22576@noindent
22577where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22578@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22579(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
22580correct value by examining your system.)
22581
22582Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22583@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22584libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22585binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22586
22587@need 750
22588@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22589system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22590shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22591
22592@smallexample
22593sh configure @var{host}
22594@end smallexample
22595
22596If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
22597directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22598@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
22599@file{configure}
22600creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22601you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22602
22603You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
22604source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22605@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22606that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22607if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22608of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22609configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22610directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22611about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22612
22613You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22614However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22615the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22616that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22617let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22618
22619@node Separate Objdir
22620@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
22621
22622If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22623you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22624host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22625allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22626rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22627handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22628@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22629program specified there.
22630
22631To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
22632with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22633(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
22634itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
22635would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22636the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22637
22638For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22639separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22640
22641@smallexample
22642@group
22643cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22644mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22645cd ../gdb-sun4
22646../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22647make
22648@end group
22649@end smallexample
22650
22651When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22652directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22653(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22654the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22655directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22656@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22657
22658Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22659instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22660like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22661one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22662build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22663
22664One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22665directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22666@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22667programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22668You specify a cross-debugging target by
22669giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
22670
22671When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22672it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22673called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22674
22675The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
22676directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22677directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22678directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22679will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22680
22681When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22682directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22683if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22684with each other.
22685
22686@node Config Names
22687@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22688
22689The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22690script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22691aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22692of information in the following pattern:
22693
22694@smallexample
22695@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22696@end smallexample
22697
22698For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22699or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22700option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22701
22702The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22703any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22704aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22705@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22706script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22707abbreviations---for example:
22708
22709@smallexample
22710% sh config.sub i386-linux
22711i386-pc-linux-gnu
22712% sh config.sub alpha-linux
22713alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22714% sh config.sub hp9k700
22715hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22716% sh config.sub sun4
22717sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22718% sh config.sub sun3
22719m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22720% sh config.sub i986v
22721Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22722@end smallexample
22723
22724@noindent
22725@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22726directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22727
22728@node Configure Options
22729@section @file{configure} Options
22730
22731Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22732are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22733several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22734Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22735
22736@smallexample
22737configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22738 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22739 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22740 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22741 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22742 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22743 @var{host}
22744@end smallexample
22745
22746@noindent
22747You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22748@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22749@samp{--}.
22750
22751@table @code
22752@item --help
22753Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22754
22755@item --prefix=@var{dir}
22756Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22757@file{@var{dir}}.
22758
22759@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22760Configure the source to install programs under directory
22761@file{@var{dir}}.
22762
22763@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22764@need 2000
22765@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22766@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22767@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22768Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22769@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22770build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22771directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22772the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22773directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22774the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22775@var{dirname}.
22776
22777@item --norecursion
22778Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22779propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22780
22781@item --target=@var{target}
22782Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22783@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22784programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22785
22786There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22787
22788@item @var{host} @dots{}
22789Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22790
22791There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22792@end table
22793
22794There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22795needed for special purposes only.
22796
22797@node Maintenance Commands
22798@appendix Maintenance Commands
22799@cindex maintenance commands
22800@cindex internal commands
22801
22802In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22803includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22804that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22805provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22806messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22807
22808@table @code
22809@kindex maint agent
22810@item maint agent @var{expression}
22811Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22812This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22813(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22814
22815@kindex maint info breakpoints
22816@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22817Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22818breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22819internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22820breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22821is shown:
22822
22823@table @code
22824@item breakpoint
22825Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22826
22827@item watchpoint
22828Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22829
22830@item longjmp
22831Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22832@code{longjmp} calls.
22833
22834@item longjmp resume
22835Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22836
22837@item until
22838Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22839
22840@item finish
22841Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22842
22843@item shlib events
22844Shared library events.
22845
22846@end table
22847
22848@kindex maint check-symtabs
22849@item maint check-symtabs
22850Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22851
22852@kindex maint cplus first_component
22853@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22854Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22855
22856@kindex maint cplus namespace
22857@item maint cplus namespace
22858Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22859
22860@kindex maint demangle
22861@item maint demangle @var{name}
22862Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22863
22864@kindex maint deprecate
22865@kindex maint undeprecate
22866@cindex deprecated commands
22867@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22868@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22869Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22870cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22871argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22872favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22873the replacement as part of the warning.
22874
22875@kindex maint dump-me
22876@item maint dump-me
22877@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22878Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22879This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22880with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22881
22882@kindex maint internal-error
22883@kindex maint internal-warning
22884@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22885@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22886Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22887or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22888or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22889internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22890either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22891@value{GDBN} session.
22892
22893These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22894used as the text of the error or warning message.
22895
22896Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22897
22898@smallexample
22899(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22900@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22901A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22902debugging may prove unreliable.
22903Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22904Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22905(@value{GDBP})
22906@end smallexample
22907
22908@kindex maint packet
22909@item maint packet @var{text}
22910If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22911then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22912displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22913@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22914checksum.
22915
22916@kindex maint print architecture
22917@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22918Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22919@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22920
22921@kindex maint print c-tdesc
22922@item maint print c-tdesc
22923Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
22924a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
22925when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
22926
22927@kindex maint print dummy-frames
22928@item maint print dummy-frames
22929Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22930
22931@smallexample
22932(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22933@dots{}
22934(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22935Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
2293658 return (a + b);
22937The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22938@dots{}
22939(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
229400x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22941 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22942 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22943(@value{GDBP})
22944@end smallexample
22945
22946Takes an optional file parameter.
22947
22948@kindex maint print registers
22949@kindex maint print raw-registers
22950@kindex maint print cooked-registers
22951@kindex maint print register-groups
22952@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22953@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22954@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22955@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22956Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22957
22958The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22959the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22960includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22961@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22962register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22963@value{GDBN} Internals}.
22964
22965These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22966write the information.
22967
22968@kindex maint print reggroups
22969@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22970Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22971optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22972information.
22973
22974The register groups info looks like this:
22975
22976@smallexample
22977(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22978 Group Type
22979 general user
22980 float user
22981 all user
22982 vector user
22983 system user
22984 save internal
22985 restore internal
22986@end smallexample
22987
22988@kindex flushregs
22989@item flushregs
22990This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22991
22992@kindex maint print objfiles
22993@cindex info for known object files
22994@item maint print objfiles
22995Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22996command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22997and symtabs.
22998
22999@kindex maint print statistics
23000@cindex bcache statistics
23001@item maint print statistics
23002This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
23003about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
23004statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
23005of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
23006defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
23007the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
23008used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
23009sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
23010average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
23011savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
23012lengths.
23013
23014@kindex maint print target-stack
23015@cindex target stack description
23016@item maint print target-stack
23017A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
23018kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
23019so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
23020In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
23021until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
23022address.
23023
23024This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
23025the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
23026
23027@kindex maint print type
23028@cindex type chain of a data type
23029@item maint print type @var{expr}
23030Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
23031can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
23032that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
23033a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
23034data structures, including its flags and contained types.
23035
23036@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23037@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23038@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
23039@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
23040Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
23041
23042@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
23043In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
23044produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
23045reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
23046This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
23047cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
23048compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
23049memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
23050slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
23051
23052@kindex maint set profile
23053@kindex maint show profile
23054@cindex profiling GDB
23055@item maint set profile
23056@itemx maint show profile
23057Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
23058
23059Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
23060command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
23061collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
23062exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
23063if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
23064(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
23065data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
23066
23067Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
23068compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
23069
23070@kindex maint show-debug-regs
23071@cindex x86 hardware debug registers
23072@item maint show-debug-regs
23073Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
23074registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
23075enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
23076removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
23077triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
23078
23079@kindex maint space
23080@cindex memory used by commands
23081@item maint space
23082Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
23083nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
23084took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
23085by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
23086switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23087
23088@kindex maint time
23089@cindex time of command execution
23090@item maint time
23091Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
23092set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
23093took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
23094This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
23095@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
23096
23097@kindex maint translate-address
23098@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
23099Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
23100@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
23101@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
23102the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
23103the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
23104command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
23105
23106@end table
23107
23108The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
23109@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
23110
23111@table @code
23112@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
23113@kindex set watchdog
23114@cindex watchdog timer
23115@cindex timeout for commands
23116Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
23117target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
23118reports and error and the command is aborted.
23119
23120@item show watchdog
23121Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
23122@end table
23123
23124@node Remote Protocol
23125@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
23126
23127@menu
23128* Overview::
23129* Packets::
23130* Stop Reply Packets::
23131* General Query Packets::
23132* Register Packet Format::
23133* Tracepoint Packets::
23134* Host I/O Packets::
23135* Interrupts::
23136* Examples::
23137* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
23138* Library List Format::
23139* Memory Map Format::
23140@end menu
23141
23142@node Overview
23143@section Overview
23144
23145There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
23146protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
23147machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
23148recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
23149
23150In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
23151transmitted and received data, respectively.
23152
23153@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
23154@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
23155@cindex remote serial protocol
23156All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
23157sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
23158@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
23159@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
23160
23161@smallexample
23162@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23163@end smallexample
23164@noindent
23165
23166@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
23167@noindent
23168The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
23169characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
23170eight bit unsigned checksum).
23171
23172Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
23173specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
23174
23175@smallexample
23176@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23177@end smallexample
23178
23179@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
23180@noindent
23181That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
23182has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
23183since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
23184
23185@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
23186When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
23187response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
23188the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
23189retransmission):
23190
23191@smallexample
23192-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
23193<- @code{+}
23194@end smallexample
23195@noindent
23196
23197The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
23198debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
23199the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
23200when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
23201
23202@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
23203exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
23204exceptions).
23205
23206@cindex remote protocol, field separator
23207Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
23208@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
23209@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
23210
23211Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
23212@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
23213would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
23214
23215@cindex remote protocol, binary data
23216@anchor{Binary Data}
23217Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
23218digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
23219protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
23220Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
23221connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
23222binary data.
23223
23224The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
23225as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
23226character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
23227For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
23228bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
23229@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
23230@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
23231must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
23232is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
23233(described next).
23234
23235Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
23236Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
23237instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
23238repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
23239binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
23240@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
23241produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
23242code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
23243encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
23244@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
23245after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
232463}} more times.
23247
23248The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
23249greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
23250seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
23251five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
23252@samp{0*"00}.
23253
23254The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
23255error number. That number is not well defined.
23256
23257@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
23258For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
23259(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
23260protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
23261on that response.
23262
23263A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
23264@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
23265optional.
23266
23267@node Packets
23268@section Packets
23269
23270The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
23271@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
23272@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
23273I/O extension of the remote protocol.
23274
23275Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
23276syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
23277include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
23278part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
23279separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
23280@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
23281bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
23282@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
23283@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
23284@var{baz}.
23285
23286Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
23287letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
23288
23289Here are the packet descriptions.
23290
23291@table @samp
23292
23293@item !
23294@cindex @samp{!} packet
23295Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
23296persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
23297debugged.
23298
23299Reply:
23300@table @samp
23301@item OK
23302The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
23303@end table
23304
23305@item ?
23306@cindex @samp{?} packet
23307Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
23308step and continue.
23309
23310Reply:
23311@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23312
23313@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
23314@cindex @samp{A} packet
23315Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
23316specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
23317@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
23318
23319Reply:
23320@table @samp
23321@item OK
23322The arguments were set.
23323@item E @var{NN}
23324An error occurred.
23325@end table
23326
23327@item b @var{baud}
23328@cindex @samp{b} packet
23329(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
23330Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
23331
23332JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
23333received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
23334problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
23335
23336Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
23337it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
23338some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
23339switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
23340of view, nothing actually happened.}
23341
23342@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
23343@cindex @samp{B} packet
23344Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
23345breakpoint at @var{addr}.
23346
23347Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
23348(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
23349
23350@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23351@cindex @samp{c} packet
23352Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
23353resume at current address.
23354
23355Reply:
23356@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23357
23358@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23359@cindex @samp{C} packet
23360Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
23361@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
23362
23363Reply:
23364@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23365
23366@item d
23367@cindex @samp{d} packet
23368Toggle debug flag.
23369
23370Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
23371(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
23372
23373@item D
23374@cindex @samp{D} packet
23375Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
23376before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
23377
23378Reply:
23379@table @samp
23380@item OK
23381for success
23382@item E @var{NN}
23383for an error
23384@end table
23385
23386@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
23387@cindex @samp{F} packet
23388A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
23389This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
23390Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
23391
23392@item g
23393@anchor{read registers packet}
23394@cindex @samp{g} packet
23395Read general registers.
23396
23397Reply:
23398@table @samp
23399@item @var{XX@dots{}}
23400Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
23401with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
23402each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
23403determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
23404@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
23405specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
23406@item E @var{NN}
23407for an error.
23408@end table
23409
23410@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
23411@cindex @samp{G} packet
23412Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
23413description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
23414
23415Reply:
23416@table @samp
23417@item OK
23418for success
23419@item E @var{NN}
23420for an error
23421@end table
23422
23423@item H @var{c} @var{t}
23424@cindex @samp{H} packet
23425Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
23426@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
23427should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
23428operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
23429the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
23430
23431Reply:
23432@table @samp
23433@item OK
23434for success
23435@item E @var{NN}
23436for an error
23437@end table
23438
23439@c FIXME: JTC:
23440@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
23441@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
23442@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
23443@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
23444@c described. For example:
23445@c
23446@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23447@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
23448@c otherwise returns current registers.
23449@c
23450@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
23451@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
23452@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
23453
23454@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
23455@anchor{cycle step packet}
23456@cindex @samp{i} packet
23457Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
23458present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
23459step starting at that address.
23460
23461@item I
23462@cindex @samp{I} packet
23463Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23464step packet}.
23465
23466@item k
23467@cindex @samp{k} packet
23468Kill request.
23469
23470FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23471thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23472thread?)}.
23473
23474@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23475@cindex @samp{m} packet
23476Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23477Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23478
23479The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23480data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23481and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23482use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23483suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23484@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23485@cindex size of remote memory accesses
23486@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23487
23488Reply:
23489@table @samp
23490@item @var{XX@dots{}}
23491Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23492number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23493server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23494@item E @var{NN}
23495@var{NN} is errno
23496@end table
23497
23498@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23499@cindex @samp{M} packet
23500Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23501@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23502hexadecimal number.
23503
23504Reply:
23505@table @samp
23506@item OK
23507for success
23508@item E @var{NN}
23509for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23510written).
23511@end table
23512
23513@item p @var{n}
23514@cindex @samp{p} packet
23515Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23516@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23517register value is encoded.
23518
23519Reply:
23520@table @samp
23521@item @var{XX@dots{}}
23522the register's value
23523@item E @var{NN}
23524for an error
23525@item
23526Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23527@end table
23528
23529@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23530@anchor{write register packet}
23531@cindex @samp{P} packet
23532Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23533number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23534digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23535
23536Reply:
23537@table @samp
23538@item OK
23539for success
23540@item E @var{NN}
23541for an error
23542@end table
23543
23544@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23545@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23546@cindex @samp{q} packet
23547@cindex @samp{Q} packet
23548General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23549described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23550
23551@item r
23552@cindex @samp{r} packet
23553Reset the entire system.
23554
23555Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23556
23557@item R @var{XX}
23558@cindex @samp{R} packet
23559Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23560This packet is only available in extended mode.
23561
23562The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23563
23564@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23565@cindex @samp{s} packet
23566Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23567@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23568
23569Reply:
23570@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23571
23572@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23573@anchor{step with signal packet}
23574@cindex @samp{S} packet
23575Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23576requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23577
23578Reply:
23579@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23580
23581@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23582@cindex @samp{t} packet
23583Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23584@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23585@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23586
23587@item T @var{XX}
23588@cindex @samp{T} packet
23589Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23590
23591Reply:
23592@table @samp
23593@item OK
23594thread is still alive
23595@item E @var{NN}
23596thread is dead
23597@end table
23598
23599@item v
23600Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23601up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23602
23603@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23604@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23605Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23606If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23607threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23608specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23609default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23610Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23611
23612@table @samp
23613@item c
23614Continue.
23615@item C @var{sig}
23616Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23617@item s
23618Step.
23619@item S @var{sig}
23620Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23621@end table
23622
23623The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23624not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23625
23626Reply:
23627@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23628
23629@item vCont?
23630@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23631Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23632
23633Reply:
23634@table @samp
23635@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23636The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23637command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23638@item
23639The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23640@end table
23641
23642@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
23643@cindex @samp{vFile} packet
23644Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
23645see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
23646
23647@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23648@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23649Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23650@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23651its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23652flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
23653Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23654together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23655stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23656packet is received.
23657
23658Reply:
23659@table @samp
23660@item OK
23661for success
23662@item E @var{NN}
23663for an error
23664@end table
23665
23666@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23667@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23668Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23669is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23670packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23671@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23672not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23673(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23674have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23675@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23676neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23677target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23678
23679
23680Reply:
23681@table @samp
23682@item OK
23683for success
23684@item E.memtype
23685for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23686@item E @var{NN}
23687for an error
23688@end table
23689
23690@item vFlashDone
23691@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23692Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23693The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23694@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23695@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23696regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23697request is completed.
23698
23699@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23700@anchor{X packet}
23701@cindex @samp{X} packet
23702Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23703@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23704@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23705
23706Reply:
23707@table @samp
23708@item OK
23709for success
23710@item E @var{NN}
23711for an error
23712@end table
23713
23714@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23715@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23716@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23717@cindex @samp{z} packet
23718@cindex @samp{Z} packets
23719Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23720watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23721@var{length} bytes.
23722
23723Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23724separately.
23725
23726@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23727for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23728remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23729@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23730avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23731be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23732
23733@item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23734@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23735@cindex @samp{z0} packet
23736@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23737Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23738@var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23739
23740A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23741@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23742@var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23743breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23744@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23745
23746@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23747code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23748overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23749target, is not defined.}
23750
23751Reply:
23752@table @samp
23753@item OK
23754success
23755@item
23756not supported
23757@item E @var{NN}
23758for an error
23759@end table
23760
23761@item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23762@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23763@cindex @samp{z1} packet
23764@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23765Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23766address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23767
23768A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23769dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23770
23771@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23772movement.}
23773
23774Reply:
23775@table @samp
23776@item OK
23777success
23778@item
23779not supported
23780@item E @var{NN}
23781for an error
23782@end table
23783
23784@item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23785@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23786@cindex @samp{z2} packet
23787@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23788Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23789
23790Reply:
23791@table @samp
23792@item OK
23793success
23794@item
23795not supported
23796@item E @var{NN}
23797for an error
23798@end table
23799
23800@item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23801@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23802@cindex @samp{z3} packet
23803@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23804Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23805
23806Reply:
23807@table @samp
23808@item OK
23809success
23810@item
23811not supported
23812@item E @var{NN}
23813for an error
23814@end table
23815
23816@item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23817@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23818@cindex @samp{z4} packet
23819@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23820Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23821
23822Reply:
23823@table @samp
23824@item OK
23825success
23826@item
23827not supported
23828@item E @var{NN}
23829for an error
23830@end table
23831
23832@end table
23833
23834@node Stop Reply Packets
23835@section Stop Reply Packets
23836@cindex stop reply packets
23837
23838The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23839receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23840@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23841when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23842number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23843@value{GDBN} source code.
23844
23845As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23846reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23847syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23848components.
23849
23850@table @samp
23851
23852@item S @var{AA}
23853The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23854number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23855@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23856
23857@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23858@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23859The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23860number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23861@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23862and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23863round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23864this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23865
23866@itemize @bullet
23867@item
23868If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23869corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23870series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23871two-digit hex number.
23872
23873@item
23874If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23875hex.
23876
23877@item
23878If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
23879specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
23880reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
23881signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
23882
23883@item
23884Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23885and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23886future.
23887@end itemize
23888
23889The currently defined stop reasons are:
23890
23891@table @samp
23892@item watch
23893@itemx rwatch
23894@itemx awatch
23895The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23896hex.
23897
23898@cindex shared library events, remote reply
23899@item library
23900The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
23901@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
23902list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
23903@end table
23904
23905@item W @var{AA}
23906The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23907applicable to certain targets.
23908
23909@item X @var{AA}
23910The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23911
23912@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23913@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23914written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23915while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23916for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23917
23918@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23919@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23920be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23921correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23922@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23923system calls.
23924
23925@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23926this very system call.
23927
23928The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23929call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23930with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23931reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23932or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23933Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23934
23935@end table
23936
23937@node General Query Packets
23938@section General Query Packets
23939@cindex remote query requests
23940
23941Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23942packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23943query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23944sending information to and from the stub.
23945
23946The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23947indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23948@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23949definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23950conventions:
23951
23952@itemize @bullet
23953@item
23954The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23955@item
23956Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23957letter.
23958@item
23959The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23960lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23961the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23962foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23963@end itemize
23964
23965The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23966parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23967separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23968full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23969in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23970with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23971packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23972for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23973are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23974existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23975packet.}.
23976
23977Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23978has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23979explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23980templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23981@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23982
23983Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23984
23985@table @samp
23986
23987@item qC
23988@cindex current thread, remote request
23989@cindex @samp{qC} packet
23990Return the current thread id.
23991
23992Reply:
23993@table @samp
23994@item QC @var{pid}
23995Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23996@item @r{(anything else)}
23997Any other reply implies the old pid.
23998@end table
23999
24000@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
24001@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
24002@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
24003Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
24004Reply:
24005@table @samp
24006@item E @var{NN}
24007An error (such as memory fault)
24008@item C @var{crc32}
24009The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
24010@end table
24011
24012@item qfThreadInfo
24013@itemx qsThreadInfo
24014@cindex list active threads, remote request
24015@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
24016@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
24017Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
24018may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
24019works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
24020obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
24021be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
24022sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
24023
24024NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
24025
24026Reply:
24027@table @samp
24028@item m @var{id}
24029A single thread id
24030@item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
24031a comma-separated list of thread ids
24032@item l
24033(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
24034@end table
24035
24036In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
24037more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
24038@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
24039ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
24040with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
24041
24042@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
24043@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
24044@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
24045Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
24046by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
24047
24048@var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
24049thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
24050
24051@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
24052thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
24053information associated with the variable.)
24054
24055@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
24056the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
24057a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
24058object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
24059Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
24060differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
24061
24062Reply:
24063@table @samp
24064@item @var{XX}@dots{}
24065Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
24066local storage requested.
24067
24068@item E @var{nn}
24069An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24070
24071@item
24072An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
24073@end table
24074
24075@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
24076Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
24077digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
24078subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
24079number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
24080(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
24081returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
24082
24083Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
24084
24085Reply:
24086@table @samp
24087@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
24088Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
24089returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
24090and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
24091digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
24092is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
24093digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
24094@end table
24095
24096@item qOffsets
24097@cindex section offsets, remote request
24098@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
24099Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
24100image.
24101
24102Reply:
24103@table @samp
24104@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
24105Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
24106Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
24107If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
24108@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
24109segments by the supplied offsets.
24110
24111@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
24112@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
24113to the @code{Bss} section.}
24114
24115@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
24116Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
24117contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
24118@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
24119conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
24120@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
24121does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
24122as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
24123kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
24124@end table
24125
24126@item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
24127@cindex thread information, remote request
24128@cindex @samp{qP} packet
24129Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
24130encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
24131
24132Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
24133(see below).
24134
24135Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
24136
24137@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
24138@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
24139@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24140@anchor{QPassSignals}
24141Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
24142Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
24143(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
24144strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
24145the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
24146reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
24147combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
24148new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
24149@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
24150
24151Reply:
24152@table @samp
24153@item OK
24154The request succeeded.
24155
24156@item E @var{nn}
24157An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
24158
24159@item
24160An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
24161the stub.
24162@end table
24163
24164Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
24165command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
24166This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24167by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24168
24169@item qRcmd,@var{command}
24170@cindex execute remote command, remote request
24171@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
24172@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
24173execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
24174string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
24175with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
24176packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
24177stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
24178
24179Reply:
24180@table @samp
24181@item OK
24182A command response with no output.
24183@item @var{OUTPUT}
24184A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
24185@item E @var{NN}
24186Indicate a badly formed request.
24187@item
24188An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
24189@end table
24190
24191(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
24192command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24193conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24194packets.)
24195
24196@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
24197@cindex supported packets, remote query
24198@cindex features of the remote protocol
24199@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
24200@anchor{qSupported}
24201Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
24202query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
24203@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
24204features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
24205at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
24206packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
24207high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
24208be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
24209stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
24210automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
24211reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
24212unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
24213helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
24214versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
24215
24216Reply:
24217@table @samp
24218@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
24219The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
24220depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
24221possible forms).
24222@item
24223An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
24224or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
24225@end table
24226
24227The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
24228@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
24229are:
24230
24231@table @samp
24232@item @var{name}=@var{value}
24233The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
24234with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
24235on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
24236@item @var{name}+
24237The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
24238need an associated value.
24239@item @var{name}-
24240The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
24241@item @var{name}?
24242The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
24243@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
24244needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
24245but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
24246@end table
24247
24248Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
24249supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
24250request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
24251state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
24252a different version of @value{GDBN}.
24253
24254No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
24255are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
24256@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
24257packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
24258versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
24259for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
24260advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
24261improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
24262responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
24263the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
24264of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
24265describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
24266all the features it supports.
24267
24268Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
24269responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
24270
24271Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
24272should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
24273require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
24274form response.
24275
24276Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
24277@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
24278in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
24279stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
24280
24281Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
24282mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
24283architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
24284about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
24285stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
24286
24287These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
24288
24289@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
24290@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
24291@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
24292@item Feature Name
24293@tab Value Required
24294@tab Default
24295@tab Probe Allowed
24296
24297@item @samp{PacketSize}
24298@tab Yes
24299@tab @samp{-}
24300@tab No
24301
24302@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
24303@tab No
24304@tab @samp{-}
24305@tab Yes
24306
24307@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
24308@tab No
24309@tab @samp{-}
24310@tab Yes
24311
24312@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
24313@tab No
24314@tab @samp{-}
24315@tab Yes
24316
24317@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
24318@tab No
24319@tab @samp{-}
24320@tab Yes
24321
24322@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
24323@tab No
24324@tab @samp{-}
24325@tab Yes
24326
24327@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
24328@tab No
24329@tab @samp{-}
24330@tab Yes
24331
24332@item @samp{QPassSignals}
24333@tab No
24334@tab @samp{-}
24335@tab Yes
24336
24337@end multitable
24338
24339These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
24340
24341@table @samp
24342@cindex packet size, remote protocol
24343@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
24344The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
24345length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
24346transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
24347data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
24348There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
24349stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
24350byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
24351@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
24352
24353@item qXfer:auxv:read
24354The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
24355(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
24356
24357@item qXfer:features:read
24358The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
24359(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
24360
24361@item qXfer:libraries:read
24362The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
24363(@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
24364
24365@item qXfer:memory-map:read
24366The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
24367(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
24368
24369@item qXfer:spu:read
24370The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
24371(@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
24372
24373@item qXfer:spu:write
24374The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
24375(@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
24376
24377@item QPassSignals
24378The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
24379(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
24380
24381@end table
24382
24383@item qSymbol::
24384@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
24385@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
24386Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
24387requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
24388
24389Reply:
24390@table @samp
24391@item OK
24392The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24393@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24394The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
24395@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
24396@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
24397below.
24398@end table
24399
24400@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
24401Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
24402
24403@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
24404target has previously requested.
24405
24406@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
24407@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
24408will be empty.
24409
24410Reply:
24411@table @samp
24412@item OK
24413The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
24414@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
24415The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
24416encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
24417(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
24418@end table
24419
24420@item QTDP
24421@itemx QTFrame
24422@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24423
24424@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
24425@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
24426@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
24427Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
24428the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
24429string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
24430for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
24431displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
24432examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
24433@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
24434
24435Reply:
24436@table @samp
24437@item @var{XX}@dots{}
24438Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
24439comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
24440the thread's attributes.
24441@end table
24442
24443(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
24444the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
24445conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
24446packets.)
24447
24448@item QTStart
24449@itemx QTStop
24450@itemx QTinit
24451@itemx QTro
24452@itemx qTStatus
24453@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
24454
24455@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24456@cindex read special object, remote request
24457@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
24458@anchor{qXfer read}
24459Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
24460identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
24461starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
24462encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
24463additional details about what data to access.
24464
24465Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24466@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24467formats, listed below.
24468
24469@table @samp
24470@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24471@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
24472Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
24473auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
24474
24475This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24476by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24477
24478@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24479@anchor{qXfer target description read}
24480Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
24481annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
24482always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
24483
24484This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24485by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24486
24487@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24488@anchor{qXfer library list read}
24489Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
24490The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24491(@pxref{qXfer read}).
24492
24493Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
24494not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
24495the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
24496
24497This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24498by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24499
24500@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
24501@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
24502Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
24503annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
24504(@pxref{qXfer read}).
24505
24506This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24507by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24508
24509@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
24510@anchor{qXfer spu read}
24511Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24512annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
24513@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24514in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24515in that context to be accessed.
24516
24517This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24518by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24519@end table
24520
24521Reply:
24522@table @samp
24523@item m @var{data}
24524Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
24525target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
24526it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
24527block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
24528@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
24529request.
24530
24531@item l @var{data}
24532Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
24533There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
24534than the @var{length} in the request.
24535
24536@item l
24537The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
24538There is no more data to be read.
24539
24540@item E00
24541The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24542
24543@item E @var{nn}
24544The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
24545@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24546
24547@item
24548An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
24549the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
24550@end table
24551
24552@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24553@cindex write data into object, remote request
24554Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
24555identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
24556into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
24557(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
24558is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
24559to access.
24560
24561Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
24562@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
24563formats, listed below.
24564
24565@table @samp
24566@item qXfer:@var{spu}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
24567@anchor{qXfer spu write}
24568Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
24569annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
24570@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
24571in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
24572in that context to be accessed.
24573
24574This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
24575by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
24576@end table
24577
24578Reply:
24579@table @samp
24580@item @var{nn}
24581@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
24582This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
24583
24584@item E00
24585The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
24586
24587@item E @var{nn}
24588The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
24589@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
24590
24591@item
24592An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
24593recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24594@end table
24595
24596@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24597Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24598not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24599@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24600must respond with an empty packet.
24601
24602@end table
24603
24604@node Register Packet Format
24605@section Register Packet Format
24606
24607The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24608In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24609sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24610to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24611byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24612most-significant - least-significant.
24613
24614@table @r
24615
24616@item MIPS32
24617
24618All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2461932 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24620registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24621
24622@item MIPS64
24623
24624All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24625thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24626as @code{MIPS32}.
24627
24628@end table
24629
24630@node Tracepoint Packets
24631@section Tracepoint Packets
24632@cindex tracepoint packets
24633@cindex packets, tracepoint
24634
24635Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24636tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24637
24638@table @samp
24639
24640@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24641Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24642is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24643the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24644count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24645present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24646tracepoint's actions.
24647
24648Replies:
24649@table @samp
24650@item OK
24651The packet was understood and carried out.
24652@item
24653The packet was not recognized.
24654@end table
24655
24656@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24657Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24658@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24659this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24660another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24661trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24662specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24663
24664In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24665can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24666is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24667actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24668taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24669@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24670tracepoint actions.
24671
24672The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24673actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24674following forms:
24675
24676@table @samp
24677
24678@item R @var{mask}
24679Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24680a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24681@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24682zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24683not fit in a 32-bit word.
24684
24685@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24686Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24687number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24688@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24689address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24690@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24691values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24692
24693@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24694Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24695it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24696@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24697two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24698in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24699packet).
24700
24701@end table
24702
24703Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24704packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24705length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24706action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24707actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24708must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24709``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24710separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24711
24712Replies:
24713@table @samp
24714@item OK
24715The packet was understood and carried out.
24716@item
24717The packet was not recognized.
24718@end table
24719
24720@item QTFrame:@var{n}
24721Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24722register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24723request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24724
24725A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24726requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24727without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24728one of the following forms:
24729
24730@table @samp
24731@item F @var{f}
24732The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24733@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24734was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24735
24736@item T @var{t}
24737The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24738@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24739
24740@end table
24741
24742@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24743Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24744currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24745@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24746
24747@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24748Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24749currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24750is a hexadecimal number.
24751
24752@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24753Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24754currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24755and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24756numbers.
24757
24758@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24759Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24760frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24761
24762@item QTStart
24763Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24764hits in the trace frame buffer.
24765
24766@item QTStop
24767End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24768
24769@item QTinit
24770Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24771
24772@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24773Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24774will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24775if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24776
24777@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24778containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24779still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24780there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24781
24782@item qTStatus
24783Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24784
24785Replies:
24786@table @samp
24787@item T0
24788There is no trace experiment running.
24789@item T1
24790There is a trace experiment running.
24791@end table
24792
24793@end table
24794
24795
24796@node Host I/O Packets
24797@section Host I/O Packets
24798@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
24799@cindex file transfer, remote protocol
24800
24801The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
24802operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
24803used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
24804filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
24805layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
24806Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
24807protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
24808Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
24809target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
24810Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
24811
24812The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
24813its arguments. They have this format:
24814
24815@table @samp
24816
24817@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
24818@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
24819should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
24820for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
24821the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
24822numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
24823used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
24824hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
24825buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
24826
24827@end table
24828
24829The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
24830
24831@table @samp
24832
24833@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
24834@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
24835non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
24836@var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
24837value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
24838operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
24839binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
24840normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
24841documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
24842@var{attachment}.
24843
24844@item
24845An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
24846
24847@end table
24848
24849These are the supported Host I/O operations:
24850
24851@table @samp
24852@item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
24853Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
24854return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
24855@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
24856(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
24857of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
24858@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
24859
24860@item vFile:close: @var{fd}
24861Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
24862-1 if an error occurs.
24863
24864@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
24865Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
24866@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
24867relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
24868common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
24869condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
24870returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
24871@var{count} was zero.
24872
24873The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
24874If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
24875attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
24876number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
24877some characters were escaped.
24878
24879@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
24880Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
24881to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
24882file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
24883separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
24884packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
24885which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
24886error occurred.
24887
24888@item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
24889Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
24890or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
24891
24892@end table
24893
24894@node Interrupts
24895@section Interrupts
24896@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24897
24898When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24899attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24900control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24901setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24902
24903The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24904mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24905not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24906interfaces.
24907
24908@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24909transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24910@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24911the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24912transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24913and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24914(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24915@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24916
24917Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24918precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24919implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24920running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24921Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24922of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24923program is stopped will be discarded.
24924
24925@node Examples
24926@section Examples
24927
24928Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24929does not get any direct output:
24930
24931@smallexample
24932-> @code{R00}
24933<- @code{+}
24934@emph{target restarts}
24935-> @code{?}
24936<- @code{+}
24937<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24938-> @code{+}
24939@end smallexample
24940
24941Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24942
24943@smallexample
24944-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24945<- @code{+}
24946-> @code{s}
24947<- @code{+}
24948@emph{time passes}
24949<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24950-> @code{+}
24951-> @code{g}
24952<- @code{+}
24953<- @code{1455@dots{}}
24954-> @code{+}
24955@end smallexample
24956
24957@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24958@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24959@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24960
24961@menu
24962* File-I/O Overview::
24963* Protocol Basics::
24964* The F Request Packet::
24965* The F Reply Packet::
24966* The Ctrl-C Message::
24967* Console I/O::
24968* List of Supported Calls::
24969* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24970* Constants::
24971* File-I/O Examples::
24972@end menu
24973
24974@node File-I/O Overview
24975@subsection File-I/O Overview
24976@cindex file-i/o overview
24977
24978The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24979target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24980system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24981remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24982actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24983This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24984
24985The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24986It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24987@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24988translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24989protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24990
24991The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24992@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24993or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24994the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24995memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24996the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24997(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24998
24999The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
25000the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
25001after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
25002previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
25003request from @value{GDBN} is required.
25004
25005@smallexample
25006(@value{GDBP}) continue
25007 <- target requests 'system call X'
25008 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
25009 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
25010 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
25011 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
25012@end smallexample
25013
25014The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
25015the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
25016named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
25017system are not supported by this protocol.
25018
25019@node Protocol Basics
25020@subsection Protocol Basics
25021@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
25022
25023The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
25024as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
25025@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
25026the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
25027of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
25028This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
25029to call the appropriate host system call:
25030
25031@itemize @bullet
25032@item
25033A unique identifier for the requested system call.
25034
25035@item
25036All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
25037in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
25038pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
25039Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
25040
25041@end itemize
25042
25043At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
25044
25045@itemize @bullet
25046@item
25047If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
25048system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
25049standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
25050expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
25051packet.
25052
25053@item
25054@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
25055representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
25056
25057@item
25058@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
25059
25060@item
25061It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
25062
25063@item
25064If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
25065by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
25066target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
25067by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
25068packet.
25069
25070@end itemize
25071
25072Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
25073necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
25074
25075@itemize @bullet
25076@item
25077Return value.
25078
25079@item
25080@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
25081
25082@item
25083``Ctrl-C'' flag.
25084
25085@end itemize
25086
25087After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
25088the latest continue or step action.
25089
25090@node The F Request Packet
25091@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
25092@cindex file-i/o request packet
25093@cindex @code{F} request packet
25094
25095The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
25096
25097@table @samp
25098@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
25099
25100@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
25101This is just the name of the function.
25102
25103@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
25104Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
25105of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
25106datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
25107of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
25108comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
25109string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
25110
25111@end table
25112
25113
25114
25115@node The F Reply Packet
25116@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
25117@cindex file-i/o reply packet
25118@cindex @code{F} reply packet
25119
25120The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
25121
25122@table @samp
25123
25124@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
25125
25126@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
25127
25128@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
25129representation.
25130This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
25131
25132@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
25133case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
25134The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
25135
25136@smallexample
25137F0,0,C
25138@end smallexample
25139
25140@noindent
25141or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
25142
25143@smallexample
25144F-1,4,C
25145@end smallexample
25146
25147@noindent
25148assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
25149
25150@end table
25151
25152
25153@node The Ctrl-C Message
25154@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
25155@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
25156
25157If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
25158reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
25159the target should behave as if it had
25160gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
25161interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
25162(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
25163packet.
25164
25165It's important for the target to know in which
25166state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
25167
25168@itemize @bullet
25169@item
25170The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
25171
25172@item
25173The system call on the host has been finished.
25174
25175@end itemize
25176
25177These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
25178returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
25179call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
25180on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
25181system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
25182as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
25183
25184@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
25185yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
25186@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
25187before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
25188@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
25189The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
25190or the full action has been completed.
25191
25192@node Console I/O
25193@subsection Console I/O
25194@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
25195
25196By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
25197descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
25198on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
25199(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
25200by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
252010 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
25202conditions is met:
25203
25204@itemize @bullet
25205@item
25206The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
25207@code{read}
25208system call is treated as finished.
25209
25210@item
25211The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
25212newline.
25213
25214@item
25215The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
25216character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
25217
25218@end itemize
25219
25220If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
25221the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
25222either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
25223is stopped at the user's request.
25224
25225
25226@node List of Supported Calls
25227@subsection List of Supported Calls
25228@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
25229
25230@menu
25231* open::
25232* close::
25233* read::
25234* write::
25235* lseek::
25236* rename::
25237* unlink::
25238* stat/fstat::
25239* gettimeofday::
25240* isatty::
25241* system::
25242@end menu
25243
25244@node open
25245@unnumberedsubsubsec open
25246@cindex open, file-i/o system call
25247
25248@table @asis
25249@item Synopsis:
25250@smallexample
25251int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
25252int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
25253@end smallexample
25254
25255@item Request:
25256@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
25257
25258@noindent
25259@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25260
25261@table @code
25262@item O_CREAT
25263If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
25264rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
25265are concerned.
25266
25267@item O_EXCL
25268When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
25269an error and open() fails.
25270
25271@item O_TRUNC
25272If the file already exists and the open mode allows
25273writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
25274truncated to zero length.
25275
25276@item O_APPEND
25277The file is opened in append mode.
25278
25279@item O_RDONLY
25280The file is opened for reading only.
25281
25282@item O_WRONLY
25283The file is opened for writing only.
25284
25285@item O_RDWR
25286The file is opened for reading and writing.
25287@end table
25288
25289@noindent
25290Other bits are silently ignored.
25291
25292
25293@noindent
25294@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
25295
25296@table @code
25297@item S_IRUSR
25298User has read permission.
25299
25300@item S_IWUSR
25301User has write permission.
25302
25303@item S_IRGRP
25304Group has read permission.
25305
25306@item S_IWGRP
25307Group has write permission.
25308
25309@item S_IROTH
25310Others have read permission.
25311
25312@item S_IWOTH
25313Others have write permission.
25314@end table
25315
25316@noindent
25317Other bits are silently ignored.
25318
25319
25320@item Return value:
25321@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
25322occurred.
25323
25324@item Errors:
25325
25326@table @code
25327@item EEXIST
25328@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
25329
25330@item EISDIR
25331@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
25332
25333@item EACCES
25334The requested access is not allowed.
25335
25336@item ENAMETOOLONG
25337@var{pathname} was too long.
25338
25339@item ENOENT
25340A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25341
25342@item ENODEV
25343@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
25344
25345@item EROFS
25346@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
25347write access was requested.
25348
25349@item EFAULT
25350@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
25351
25352@item ENOSPC
25353No space on device to create the file.
25354
25355@item EMFILE
25356The process already has the maximum number of files open.
25357
25358@item ENFILE
25359The limit on the total number of files open on the system
25360has been reached.
25361
25362@item EINTR
25363The call was interrupted by the user.
25364@end table
25365
25366@end table
25367
25368@node close
25369@unnumberedsubsubsec close
25370@cindex close, file-i/o system call
25371
25372@table @asis
25373@item Synopsis:
25374@smallexample
25375int close(int fd);
25376@end smallexample
25377
25378@item Request:
25379@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
25380
25381@item Return value:
25382@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
25383
25384@item Errors:
25385
25386@table @code
25387@item EBADF
25388@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
25389
25390@item EINTR
25391The call was interrupted by the user.
25392@end table
25393
25394@end table
25395
25396@node read
25397@unnumberedsubsubsec read
25398@cindex read, file-i/o system call
25399
25400@table @asis
25401@item Synopsis:
25402@smallexample
25403int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
25404@end smallexample
25405
25406@item Request:
25407@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25408
25409@item Return value:
25410On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
25411Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
25412returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
25413
25414@item Errors:
25415
25416@table @code
25417@item EBADF
25418@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25419reading.
25420
25421@item EFAULT
25422@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25423
25424@item EINTR
25425The call was interrupted by the user.
25426@end table
25427
25428@end table
25429
25430@node write
25431@unnumberedsubsubsec write
25432@cindex write, file-i/o system call
25433
25434@table @asis
25435@item Synopsis:
25436@smallexample
25437int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
25438@end smallexample
25439
25440@item Request:
25441@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
25442
25443@item Return value:
25444On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
25445Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
25446is returned.
25447
25448@item Errors:
25449
25450@table @code
25451@item EBADF
25452@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
25453writing.
25454
25455@item EFAULT
25456@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25457
25458@item EFBIG
25459An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
25460host-specific maximum file size allowed.
25461
25462@item ENOSPC
25463No space on device to write the data.
25464
25465@item EINTR
25466The call was interrupted by the user.
25467@end table
25468
25469@end table
25470
25471@node lseek
25472@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
25473@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
25474
25475@table @asis
25476@item Synopsis:
25477@smallexample
25478long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
25479@end smallexample
25480
25481@item Request:
25482@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
25483
25484@var{flag} is one of:
25485
25486@table @code
25487@item SEEK_SET
25488The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
25489
25490@item SEEK_CUR
25491The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
25492bytes.
25493
25494@item SEEK_END
25495The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
25496bytes.
25497@end table
25498
25499@item Return value:
25500On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
25501the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
25502value of -1 is returned.
25503
25504@item Errors:
25505
25506@table @code
25507@item EBADF
25508@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
25509
25510@item ESPIPE
25511@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
25512
25513@item EINVAL
25514@var{flag} is not a proper value.
25515
25516@item EINTR
25517The call was interrupted by the user.
25518@end table
25519
25520@end table
25521
25522@node rename
25523@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
25524@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
25525
25526@table @asis
25527@item Synopsis:
25528@smallexample
25529int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
25530@end smallexample
25531
25532@item Request:
25533@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
25534
25535@item Return value:
25536On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25537
25538@item Errors:
25539
25540@table @code
25541@item EISDIR
25542@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
25543directory.
25544
25545@item EEXIST
25546@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
25547
25548@item EBUSY
25549@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
25550process.
25551
25552@item EINVAL
25553An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
25554of itself.
25555
25556@item ENOTDIR
25557A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
25558path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
25559and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
25560
25561@item EFAULT
25562@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
25563
25564@item EACCES
25565No access to the file or the path of the file.
25566
25567@item ENAMETOOLONG
25568
25569@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
25570
25571@item ENOENT
25572A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
25573
25574@item EROFS
25575The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25576
25577@item ENOSPC
25578The device containing the file has no room for the new
25579directory entry.
25580
25581@item EINTR
25582The call was interrupted by the user.
25583@end table
25584
25585@end table
25586
25587@node unlink
25588@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
25589@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
25590
25591@table @asis
25592@item Synopsis:
25593@smallexample
25594int unlink(const char *pathname);
25595@end smallexample
25596
25597@item Request:
25598@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
25599
25600@item Return value:
25601On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25602
25603@item Errors:
25604
25605@table @code
25606@item EACCES
25607No access to the file or the path of the file.
25608
25609@item EPERM
25610The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
25611
25612@item EBUSY
25613The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
25614being used by another process.
25615
25616@item EFAULT
25617@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25618
25619@item ENAMETOOLONG
25620@var{pathname} was too long.
25621
25622@item ENOENT
25623A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
25624
25625@item ENOTDIR
25626A component of the path is not a directory.
25627
25628@item EROFS
25629The file is on a read-only filesystem.
25630
25631@item EINTR
25632The call was interrupted by the user.
25633@end table
25634
25635@end table
25636
25637@node stat/fstat
25638@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
25639@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
25640@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
25641
25642@table @asis
25643@item Synopsis:
25644@smallexample
25645int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
25646int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
25647@end smallexample
25648
25649@item Request:
25650@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
25651@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
25652
25653@item Return value:
25654On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
25655
25656@item Errors:
25657
25658@table @code
25659@item EBADF
25660@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
25661
25662@item ENOENT
25663A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
25664path is an empty string.
25665
25666@item ENOTDIR
25667A component of the path is not a directory.
25668
25669@item EFAULT
25670@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25671
25672@item EACCES
25673No access to the file or the path of the file.
25674
25675@item ENAMETOOLONG
25676@var{pathname} was too long.
25677
25678@item EINTR
25679The call was interrupted by the user.
25680@end table
25681
25682@end table
25683
25684@node gettimeofday
25685@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
25686@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
25687
25688@table @asis
25689@item Synopsis:
25690@smallexample
25691int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
25692@end smallexample
25693
25694@item Request:
25695@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25696
25697@item Return value:
25698On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25699
25700@item Errors:
25701
25702@table @code
25703@item EINVAL
25704@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25705
25706@item EFAULT
25707@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25708@end table
25709
25710@end table
25711
25712@node isatty
25713@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25714@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25715
25716@table @asis
25717@item Synopsis:
25718@smallexample
25719int isatty(int fd);
25720@end smallexample
25721
25722@item Request:
25723@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25724
25725@item Return value:
25726Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25727
25728@item Errors:
25729
25730@table @code
25731@item EINTR
25732The call was interrupted by the user.
25733@end table
25734
25735@end table
25736
25737Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
257381 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25739to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25740would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25741needed.
25742
25743
25744@node system
25745@unnumberedsubsubsec system
25746@cindex system, file-i/o system call
25747
25748@table @asis
25749@item Synopsis:
25750@smallexample
25751int system(const char *command);
25752@end smallexample
25753
25754@item Request:
25755@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25756
25757@item Return value:
25758If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25759available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25760For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25761return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25762command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25763return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25764@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25765
25766@item Errors:
25767
25768@table @code
25769@item EINTR
25770The call was interrupted by the user.
25771@end table
25772
25773@end table
25774
25775@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25776to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25777the host is simplified before it's returned
25778to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25779is discarded, and the return value consists
25780entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25781
25782Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25783by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25784@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25785
25786@table @code
25787@item set remote system-call-allowed
25788@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25789Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25790protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25791
25792@item show remote system-call-allowed
25793@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25794Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25795protocol.
25796@end table
25797
25798@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25799@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
25800@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25801
25802@menu
25803* Integral Datatypes::
25804* Pointer Values::
25805* Memory Transfer::
25806* struct stat::
25807* struct timeval::
25808@end menu
25809
25810@node Integral Datatypes
25811@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
25812@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25813
25814The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25815@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25816@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25817
25818@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25819implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25820
25821@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25822
25823@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25824in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25825
25826@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25827
25828All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25829structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25830byte order.
25831
25832@node Pointer Values
25833@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
25834@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25835
25836Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25837is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25838transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25839are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25840
25841@smallexample
25842@code{1aaf/12}
25843@end smallexample
25844
25845@noindent
25846which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25847The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25848the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25849at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25850
25851@smallexample
25852@code{123456/d}
25853@end smallexample
25854
25855@node Memory Transfer
25856@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
25857@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25858
25859Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25860example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
25861with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25862this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25863packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25864it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25865data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25866
25867
25868@node struct stat
25869@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25870@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25871
25872The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25873is defined as follows:
25874
25875@smallexample
25876struct stat @{
25877 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25878 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25879 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25880 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25881 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25882 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25883 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25884 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25885 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25886 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25887 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25888 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25889 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25890@};
25891@end smallexample
25892
25893The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25894appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25895structure is of size 64 bytes.
25896
25897The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25898range of values.
25899
25900@table @code
25901
25902@item st_dev
25903A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25904
25905@item st_ino
25906No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25907
25908@item st_mode
25909Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25910bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25911
25912@item st_uid
25913@itemx st_gid
25914@itemx st_rdev
25915No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25916
25917@item st_atime
25918@itemx st_mtime
25919@itemx st_ctime
25920These values have a host and file system dependent
25921accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25922support exact timing values.
25923@end table
25924
25925The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25926responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25927continuing.
25928
25929Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25930representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25931get truncated on the target.
25932
25933@node struct timeval
25934@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25935@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25936
25937The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25938is defined as follows:
25939
25940@smallexample
25941struct timeval @{
25942 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25943 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25944@};
25945@end smallexample
25946
25947The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25948appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25949structure is of size 8 bytes.
25950
25951@node Constants
25952@subsection Constants
25953@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25954
25955The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25956protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25957values before and after the call as needed.
25958
25959@menu
25960* Open Flags::
25961* mode_t Values::
25962* Errno Values::
25963* Lseek Flags::
25964* Limits::
25965@end menu
25966
25967@node Open Flags
25968@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25969@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25970
25971All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25972
25973@smallexample
25974 O_RDONLY 0x0
25975 O_WRONLY 0x1
25976 O_RDWR 0x2
25977 O_APPEND 0x8
25978 O_CREAT 0x200
25979 O_TRUNC 0x400
25980 O_EXCL 0x800
25981@end smallexample
25982
25983@node mode_t Values
25984@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25985@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25986
25987All values are given in octal representation.
25988
25989@smallexample
25990 S_IFREG 0100000
25991 S_IFDIR 040000
25992 S_IRUSR 0400
25993 S_IWUSR 0200
25994 S_IXUSR 0100
25995 S_IRGRP 040
25996 S_IWGRP 020
25997 S_IXGRP 010
25998 S_IROTH 04
25999 S_IWOTH 02
26000 S_IXOTH 01
26001@end smallexample
26002
26003@node Errno Values
26004@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
26005@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
26006
26007All values are given in decimal representation.
26008
26009@smallexample
26010 EPERM 1
26011 ENOENT 2
26012 EINTR 4
26013 EBADF 9
26014 EACCES 13
26015 EFAULT 14
26016 EBUSY 16
26017 EEXIST 17
26018 ENODEV 19
26019 ENOTDIR 20
26020 EISDIR 21
26021 EINVAL 22
26022 ENFILE 23
26023 EMFILE 24
26024 EFBIG 27
26025 ENOSPC 28
26026 ESPIPE 29
26027 EROFS 30
26028 ENAMETOOLONG 91
26029 EUNKNOWN 9999
26030@end smallexample
26031
26032 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
26033 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
26034
26035@node Lseek Flags
26036@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
26037@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
26038
26039@smallexample
26040 SEEK_SET 0
26041 SEEK_CUR 1
26042 SEEK_END 2
26043@end smallexample
26044
26045@node Limits
26046@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
26047@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
26048
26049All values are given in decimal representation.
26050
26051@smallexample
26052 INT_MIN -2147483648
26053 INT_MAX 2147483647
26054 UINT_MAX 4294967295
26055 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
26056 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
26057 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
26058@end smallexample
26059
26060@node File-I/O Examples
26061@subsection File-I/O Examples
26062@cindex file-i/o examples
26063
26064Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26065address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
26066
26067@smallexample
26068<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
26069@emph{request memory read from target}
26070-> @code{m1234,6}
26071<- XXXXXX
26072@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
26073-> @code{F6}
26074@end smallexample
26075
26076Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
26077address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
26078
26079@smallexample
26080<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26081@emph{request memory write to target}
26082-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26083@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
26084-> @code{F6}
26085@end smallexample
26086
26087Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
26088file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
26089
26090@smallexample
26091<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26092-> @code{F-1,9}
26093@end smallexample
26094
26095Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
26096host is called:
26097
26098@smallexample
26099<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26100-> @code{F-1,4,C}
26101<- @code{T02}
26102@end smallexample
26103
26104Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
26105host is called:
26106
26107@smallexample
26108<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
26109-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
26110<- @code{T02}
26111@end smallexample
26112
26113@node Library List Format
26114@section Library List Format
26115@cindex library list format, remote protocol
26116
26117On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
26118same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
26119@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
26120operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
26121platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
26122@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
26123through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26124packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
26125queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
26126are loaded.
26127
26128The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
26129lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
26130associated name and one or more segment base addresses, which report
26131where the library was loaded in memory. The segment bases are start
26132addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not depend on the library's
26133link-time base addresses.
26134
26135@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26136library lists. @xref{Expat}.
26137
26138A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
26139offset, looks like this:
26140
26141@smallexample
26142<library-list>
26143 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
26144 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
26145 </library>
26146</library-list>
26147@end smallexample
26148
26149The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
26150
26151@smallexample
26152<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
26153<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
26154<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
26155<!ELEMENT library (segment)*>
26156<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26157<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
26158<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
26159@end smallexample
26160
26161@node Memory Map Format
26162@section Memory Map Format
26163@cindex memory map format
26164
26165To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
26166memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
26167memory map.
26168
26169The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
26170(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
26171lists memory regions.
26172
26173@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26174memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
26175
26176The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
26177
26178@smallexample
26179<?xml version="1.0"?>
26180<!DOCTYPE memory-map
26181 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
26182 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
26183<memory-map>
26184 region...
26185</memory-map>
26186@end smallexample
26187
26188Each region can be either:
26189
26190@itemize
26191
26192@item
26193A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
26194bytes from there:
26195
26196@smallexample
26197<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26198@end smallexample
26199
26200
26201@item
26202A region of read-only memory:
26203
26204@smallexample
26205<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
26206@end smallexample
26207
26208
26209@item
26210A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
26211bytes in length:
26212
26213@smallexample
26214<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
26215 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
26216</memory>
26217@end smallexample
26218
26219@end itemize
26220
26221Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
26222by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
26223packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
26224
26225The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
26226
26227@smallexample
26228<!-- ................................................... -->
26229<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
26230<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
26231<!-- .................................... .............. -->
26232<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
26233<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
26234<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
26235<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
26236<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
26237<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
26238 and its type, or device. -->
26239<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
26240 start CDATA #REQUIRED
26241 length CDATA #REQUIRED
26242 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
26243<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
26244<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
26245<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
26246@end smallexample
26247
26248@include agentexpr.texi
26249
26250@node Target Descriptions
26251@appendix Target Descriptions
26252@cindex target descriptions
26253
26254@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
26255and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
26256The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
26257
26258One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
26259is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
26260architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
26261a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
26262and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
26263architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
26264vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
26265
26266@itemize @bullet
26267@item
26268With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
26269the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
26270@item
26271Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
26272audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
26273variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
26274@item
26275When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
26276at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
26277@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
26278@end itemize
26279
26280To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
26281target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
26282actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
26283processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
26284descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
26285
26286@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
26287target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
26288
26289@menu
26290* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
26291* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
26292* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
26293 descriptions.
26294* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
26295@end menu
26296
26297@node Retrieving Descriptions
26298@section Retrieving Descriptions
26299
26300Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
26301specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
26302description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
26303protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
26304qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
26305@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
26306XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
26307Format}.
26308
26309Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
26310If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
26311specify a file are:
26312
26313@table @code
26314@cindex set tdesc filename
26315@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
26316Read the target description from @var{path}.
26317
26318@cindex unset tdesc filename
26319@item unset tdesc filename
26320Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
26321will use the description supplied by the current target.
26322
26323@cindex show tdesc filename
26324@item show tdesc filename
26325Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
26326@end table
26327
26328
26329@node Target Description Format
26330@section Target Description Format
26331@cindex target descriptions, XML format
26332
26333A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
26334document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
26335the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
26336means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
26337check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
26338However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
26339their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
26340
26341Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
26342and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
26343sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
26344target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
26345
26346Here is a simple target description:
26347
26348@smallexample
26349<target version="1.0">
26350 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
26351</target>
26352@end smallexample
26353
26354@noindent
26355This minimal description only says that the target uses
26356the x86-64 architecture.
26357
26358A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
26359optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
26360are explained further below.
26361
26362@smallexample
26363<?xml version="1.0"?>
26364<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
26365<target version="1.0">
26366 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
26367 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
26368</target>
26369@end smallexample
26370
26371@noindent
26372The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
26373breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
26374declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
26375(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
26376useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
26377@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
26378including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
26379revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
26380the version mismatch.
26381
26382@subsection Inclusion
26383@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
26384@cindex XInclude
26385@ifnotinfo
26386@cindex <xi:include>
26387@end ifnotinfo
26388
26389It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
26390several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
26391share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
26392divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
26393the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
26394
26395@smallexample
26396<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
26397@end smallexample
26398
26399@noindent
26400When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
26401the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
26402the contents of that document. If the current description was read
26403using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
26404@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
26405current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
26406@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
26407original description.
26408
26409@subsection Architecture
26410@cindex <architecture>
26411
26412An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
26413
26414@smallexample
26415 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
26416@end smallexample
26417
26418@var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
26419accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
26420Debugging Target}).
26421
26422@subsection Features
26423@cindex <feature>
26424
26425Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
26426system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
26427registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
26428has this form:
26429
26430@smallexample
26431<feature name="@var{name}">
26432 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
26433 @var{reg}@dots{}
26434</feature>
26435@end smallexample
26436
26437@noindent
26438Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
26439of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
26440knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
26441should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
26442
26443@subsection Types
26444
26445Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
26446interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
26447but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
26448Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
26449Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
26450
26451Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
26452a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
26453Types must be defined before they are used.
26454
26455@cindex <vector>
26456Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
26457of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
26458specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
26459@var{count}:
26460
26461@smallexample
26462<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
26463@end smallexample
26464
26465@cindex <union>
26466If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
26467with a union type containing the useful representations. The
26468@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
26469each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
26470
26471@smallexample
26472<union id="@var{id}">
26473 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
26474 @dots{}
26475</union>
26476@end smallexample
26477
26478@subsection Registers
26479@cindex <reg>
26480
26481Each register is represented as an element with this form:
26482
26483@smallexample
26484<reg name="@var{name}"
26485 bitsize="@var{size}"
26486 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
26487 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
26488 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
26489 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
26490@end smallexample
26491
26492@noindent
26493The components are as follows:
26494
26495@table @var
26496
26497@item name
26498The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
26499
26500@item bitsize
26501The register's size, in bits.
26502
26503@item regnum
26504The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
26505than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
26506a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
26507defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
26508the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
26509packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
26510in order of increasing register number.
26511
26512@item save-restore
26513Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
26514calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
26515@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
26516some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
26517ABI.
26518
26519@item type
26520The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
26521defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
26522and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
26523for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
26524architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
26525@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
26526
26527@item group
26528The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
26529be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
26530@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
26531in @code{info registers}.
26532
26533@end table
26534
26535@node Predefined Target Types
26536@section Predefined Target Types
26537@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
26538
26539Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
26540from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
26541standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
26542types. The currently supported types are:
26543
26544@table @code
26545
26546@item int8
26547@itemx int16
26548@itemx int32
26549@itemx int64
26550@itemx int128
26551Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26552
26553@item uint8
26554@itemx uint16
26555@itemx uint32
26556@itemx uint64
26557@itemx uint128
26558Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
26559
26560@item code_ptr
26561@itemx data_ptr
26562Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
26563any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
26564pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
26565address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
26566may be marked as data pointers.
26567
26568@item ieee_single
26569Single precision IEEE floating point.
26570
26571@item ieee_double
26572Double precision IEEE floating point.
26573
26574@item arm_fpa_ext
26575The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
26576
26577@end table
26578
26579@node Standard Target Features
26580@section Standard Target Features
26581@cindex target descriptions, standard features
26582
26583A target description must contain either no registers or all the
26584target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
26585@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
26586the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
26587default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
26588described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
26589can recognize them.
26590
26591This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
26592which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
26593with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
26594if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
26595feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
26596description. You can add additional registers to any of the
26597standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
26598they were added to an unrecognized feature.
26599
26600This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
26601Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
26602@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
26603
26604Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
26605company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
26606architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
26607containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
26608
26609The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
26610of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
26611registers using the capitalization used in the description.
26612
26613@menu
26614* ARM Features::
26615* M68K Features::
26616@end menu
26617
26618
26619@node ARM Features
26620@subsection ARM Features
26621@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
26622
26623The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
26624It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
26625@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
26626
26627The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
26628should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
26629
26630The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
26631it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
26632@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
26633@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
26634
26635@subsection MIPS Features
26636@cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
26637
26638The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
26639It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
26640@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
26641on the target.
26642
26643The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
26644contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
26645registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26646
26647The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
26648it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
26649contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
26650@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26651
26652The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
26653contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
26654Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
26655
26656@node M68K Features
26657@subsection M68K Features
26658@cindex target descriptions, M68K features
26659
26660@table @code
26661@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
26662@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
26663@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
26664One of those features must be always present.
26665The feature that is present determines which flavor of m86k is
26666used. The feature that is present should contain registers
26667@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
26668@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
26669
26670@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
26671This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
26672@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
26673@samp{fpiaddr}.
26674@end table
26675
26676@subsection PowerPC Features
26677@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
26678
26679The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
26680targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
26681@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
26682@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
26683
26684The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
26685contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
26686
26687The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
26688contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
26689and @samp{vrsave}.
26690
26691The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
26692contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
26693@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
26694@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
26695@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
26696these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
26697user.
26698
26699@include gpl.texi
26700
26701@raisesections
26702@include fdl.texi
26703@lowersections
26704
26705@node Index
26706@unnumbered Index
26707
26708@printindex cp
26709
26710@tex
26711% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
26712% meantime:
26713\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
26714\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
26715\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
26716\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
26717\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
26718\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
26719\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
26720\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
26721\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
26722\page\colophon
26723% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
26724@end tex
26725
26726@bye
This page took 0.137 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.